| /* Output routines for GCC for Renesas / SuperH SH. |
| Copyright (C) 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, |
| 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011 |
| Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
| Contributed by Steve Chamberlain (sac@cygnus.com). |
| Improved by Jim Wilson (wilson@cygnus.com). |
| |
| This file is part of GCC. |
| |
| GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify |
| it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by |
| the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) |
| any later version. |
| |
| GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, |
| but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of |
| MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the |
| GNU General Public License for more details. |
| |
| You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License |
| along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see |
| <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */ |
| |
| #include "config.h" |
| #include "system.h" |
| #include "coretypes.h" |
| #include "tm.h" |
| #include "insn-config.h" |
| #include "rtl.h" |
| #include "tree.h" |
| #include "flags.h" |
| #include "expr.h" |
| #include "optabs.h" |
| #include "reload.h" |
| #include "function.h" |
| #include "regs.h" |
| #include "hard-reg-set.h" |
| #include "output.h" |
| #include "insn-attr.h" |
| #include "diagnostic-core.h" |
| #include "recog.h" |
| #include "integrate.h" |
| #include "dwarf2.h" |
| #include "tm_p.h" |
| #include "target.h" |
| #include "target-def.h" |
| #include "langhooks.h" |
| #include "basic-block.h" |
| #include "df.h" |
| #include "cfglayout.h" |
| #include "intl.h" |
| #include "sched-int.h" |
| #include "params.h" |
| #include "ggc.h" |
| #include "gimple.h" |
| #include "cfgloop.h" |
| #include "alloc-pool.h" |
| #include "tm-constrs.h" |
| #include "opts.h" |
| |
| |
| int code_for_indirect_jump_scratch = CODE_FOR_indirect_jump_scratch; |
| |
| #define MSW (TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN ? 1 : 0) |
| #define LSW (TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN ? 0 : 1) |
| |
| /* These are some macros to abstract register modes. */ |
| #define CONST_OK_FOR_ADD(size) \ |
| (TARGET_SHMEDIA ? CONST_OK_FOR_I10 (size) : CONST_OK_FOR_I08 (size)) |
| #define GEN_MOV (*(TARGET_SHMEDIA64 ? gen_movdi : gen_movsi)) |
| #define GEN_ADD3 (*(TARGET_SHMEDIA64 ? gen_adddi3 : gen_addsi3)) |
| #define GEN_SUB3 (*(TARGET_SHMEDIA64 ? gen_subdi3 : gen_subsi3)) |
| |
| /* Used to simplify the logic below. Find the attributes wherever |
| they may be. */ |
| #define SH_ATTRIBUTES(decl) \ |
| (TYPE_P (decl)) ? TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (decl) \ |
| : DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl) \ |
| ? (DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)) \ |
| : TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (TREE_TYPE (decl)) |
| |
| /* Set to 1 by expand_prologue() when the function is an interrupt handler. */ |
| int current_function_interrupt; |
| |
| tree sh_deferred_function_attributes; |
| tree *sh_deferred_function_attributes_tail = &sh_deferred_function_attributes; |
| |
| /* Global variables for machine-dependent things. */ |
| |
| /* Which cpu are we scheduling for. */ |
| enum processor_type sh_cpu; |
| |
| /* Definitions used in ready queue reordering for first scheduling pass. */ |
| |
| /* Reg weights arrays for modes SFmode and SImode, indexed by insn LUID. */ |
| static short *regmode_weight[2]; |
| |
| /* Total SFmode and SImode weights of scheduled insns. */ |
| static int curr_regmode_pressure[2]; |
| |
| /* Number of r0 life regions. */ |
| static int r0_life_regions; |
| |
| /* If true, skip cycles for Q -> R movement. */ |
| static int skip_cycles = 0; |
| |
| /* Cached value of can_issue_more. This is cached in sh_variable_issue hook |
| and returned from sh_reorder2. */ |
| static short cached_can_issue_more; |
| |
| /* Unique number for UNSPEC_BBR pattern. */ |
| static unsigned int unspec_bbr_uid = 1; |
| |
| /* Provides the class number of the smallest class containing |
| reg number. */ |
| |
| enum reg_class regno_reg_class[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER] = |
| { |
| R0_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| FP0_REGS,FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, |
| TARGET_REGS, TARGET_REGS, TARGET_REGS, TARGET_REGS, |
| TARGET_REGS, TARGET_REGS, TARGET_REGS, TARGET_REGS, |
| DF_REGS, DF_REGS, DF_REGS, DF_REGS, |
| DF_REGS, DF_REGS, DF_REGS, DF_REGS, |
| NO_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, PR_REGS, T_REGS, |
| MAC_REGS, MAC_REGS, FPUL_REGS, FPSCR_REGS, |
| GENERAL_REGS, GENERAL_REGS, |
| }; |
| |
| char sh_register_names[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER] \ |
| [MAX_REGISTER_NAME_LENGTH + 1] = SH_REGISTER_NAMES_INITIALIZER; |
| |
| char sh_additional_register_names[ADDREGNAMES_SIZE] \ |
| [MAX_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAME_LENGTH + 1] |
| = SH_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES_INITIALIZER; |
| |
| int assembler_dialect; |
| |
| static bool shmedia_space_reserved_for_target_registers; |
| |
| static void split_branches (rtx); |
| static int branch_dest (rtx); |
| static void force_into (rtx, rtx); |
| static void print_slot (rtx); |
| static rtx add_constant (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx); |
| static void dump_table (rtx, rtx); |
| static int hi_const (rtx); |
| static int broken_move (rtx); |
| static int mova_p (rtx); |
| static rtx find_barrier (int, rtx, rtx); |
| static int noncall_uses_reg (rtx, rtx, rtx *); |
| static rtx gen_block_redirect (rtx, int, int); |
| static void sh_reorg (void); |
| static void sh_option_override (void); |
| static void sh_option_default_params (void); |
| static void output_stack_adjust (int, rtx, int, HARD_REG_SET *, bool); |
| static rtx frame_insn (rtx); |
| static rtx push (int); |
| static void pop (int); |
| static void push_regs (HARD_REG_SET *, int); |
| static int calc_live_regs (HARD_REG_SET *); |
| static HOST_WIDE_INT rounded_frame_size (int); |
| static bool sh_frame_pointer_required (void); |
| static rtx mark_constant_pool_use (rtx); |
| static tree sh_handle_interrupt_handler_attribute (tree *, tree, tree, int, bool *); |
| static tree sh_handle_resbank_handler_attribute (tree *, tree, |
| tree, int, bool *); |
| static tree sh2a_handle_function_vector_handler_attribute (tree *, tree, |
| tree, int, bool *); |
| static tree sh_handle_sp_switch_attribute (tree *, tree, tree, int, bool *); |
| static tree sh_handle_trap_exit_attribute (tree *, tree, tree, int, bool *); |
| static tree sh_handle_renesas_attribute (tree *, tree, tree, int, bool *); |
| static void sh_print_operand (FILE *, rtx, int); |
| static void sh_print_operand_address (FILE *, rtx); |
| static bool sh_print_operand_punct_valid_p (unsigned char code); |
| static bool sh_asm_output_addr_const_extra (FILE *file, rtx x); |
| static void sh_output_function_epilogue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT); |
| static void sh_insert_attributes (tree, tree *); |
| static const char *sh_check_pch_target_flags (int); |
| static int sh_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode, reg_class_t, reg_class_t); |
| static int sh_adjust_cost (rtx, rtx, rtx, int); |
| static int sh_issue_rate (void); |
| static int sh_dfa_new_cycle (FILE *, int, rtx, int, int, int *sort_p); |
| static short find_set_regmode_weight (rtx, enum machine_mode); |
| static short find_insn_regmode_weight (rtx, enum machine_mode); |
| static void find_regmode_weight (basic_block, enum machine_mode); |
| static int find_r0_life_regions (basic_block); |
| static void sh_md_init_global (FILE *, int, int); |
| static void sh_md_finish_global (FILE *, int); |
| static int rank_for_reorder (const void *, const void *); |
| static void swap_reorder (rtx *, int); |
| static void ready_reorder (rtx *, int); |
| static short high_pressure (enum machine_mode); |
| static int sh_reorder (FILE *, int, rtx *, int *, int); |
| static int sh_reorder2 (FILE *, int, rtx *, int *, int); |
| static void sh_md_init (FILE *, int, int); |
| static int sh_variable_issue (FILE *, int, rtx, int); |
| |
| static bool sh_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree, tree); |
| |
| static bool sh_cannot_modify_jumps_p (void); |
| static reg_class_t sh_target_reg_class (void); |
| static bool sh_optimize_target_register_callee_saved (bool); |
| static bool sh_ms_bitfield_layout_p (const_tree); |
| |
| static void sh_init_builtins (void); |
| static tree sh_builtin_decl (unsigned, bool); |
| static void sh_media_init_builtins (void); |
| static tree sh_media_builtin_decl (unsigned, bool); |
| static rtx sh_expand_builtin (tree, rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode, int); |
| static void sh_output_mi_thunk (FILE *, tree, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT, tree); |
| static void sh_file_start (void); |
| static int flow_dependent_p (rtx, rtx); |
| static void flow_dependent_p_1 (rtx, const_rtx, void *); |
| static int shiftcosts (rtx); |
| static int andcosts (rtx); |
| static int addsubcosts (rtx); |
| static int multcosts (rtx); |
| static bool unspec_caller_rtx_p (rtx); |
| static bool sh_cannot_copy_insn_p (rtx); |
| static bool sh_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int *, bool); |
| static int sh_address_cost (rtx, bool); |
| static int sh_pr_n_sets (void); |
| static rtx sh_allocate_initial_value (rtx); |
| static reg_class_t sh_preferred_reload_class (rtx, reg_class_t); |
| static reg_class_t sh_secondary_reload (bool, rtx, reg_class_t, |
| enum machine_mode, |
| struct secondary_reload_info *); |
| static bool sh_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode, rtx, bool); |
| static rtx sh_legitimize_address (rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode); |
| static rtx sh_delegitimize_address (rtx); |
| static int shmedia_target_regs_stack_space (HARD_REG_SET *); |
| static int shmedia_reserve_space_for_target_registers_p (int, HARD_REG_SET *); |
| static int shmedia_target_regs_stack_adjust (HARD_REG_SET *); |
| static int scavenge_reg (HARD_REG_SET *s); |
| struct save_schedule_s; |
| static struct save_entry_s *sh5_schedule_saves (HARD_REG_SET *, |
| struct save_schedule_s *, int); |
| |
| static rtx sh_struct_value_rtx (tree, int); |
| static rtx sh_function_value (const_tree, const_tree, bool); |
| static bool sh_function_value_regno_p (const unsigned int); |
| static rtx sh_libcall_value (enum machine_mode, const_rtx); |
| static bool sh_return_in_memory (const_tree, const_tree); |
| static rtx sh_builtin_saveregs (void); |
| static void sh_setup_incoming_varargs (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode, tree, int *, int); |
| static bool sh_strict_argument_naming (cumulative_args_t); |
| static bool sh_pretend_outgoing_varargs_named (cumulative_args_t); |
| static tree sh_build_builtin_va_list (void); |
| static void sh_va_start (tree, rtx); |
| static tree sh_gimplify_va_arg_expr (tree, tree, gimple_seq *, gimple_seq *); |
| static bool sh_promote_prototypes (const_tree); |
| static enum machine_mode sh_promote_function_mode (const_tree type, |
| enum machine_mode, |
| int *punsignedp, |
| const_tree funtype, |
| int for_return); |
| static bool sh_pass_by_reference (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode, |
| const_tree, bool); |
| static bool sh_callee_copies (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode, |
| const_tree, bool); |
| static int sh_arg_partial_bytes (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode, |
| tree, bool); |
| static void sh_function_arg_advance (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode, |
| const_tree, bool); |
| static rtx sh_function_arg (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode, |
| const_tree, bool); |
| static bool sh_scalar_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode); |
| static int sh_dwarf_calling_convention (const_tree); |
| static void sh_encode_section_info (tree, rtx, int); |
| static int sh2a_function_vector_p (tree); |
| static void sh_trampoline_init (rtx, tree, rtx); |
| static rtx sh_trampoline_adjust_address (rtx); |
| static void sh_conditional_register_usage (void); |
| static bool sh_legitimate_constant_p (enum machine_mode, rtx); |
| |
| static const struct attribute_spec sh_attribute_table[] = |
| { |
| /* { name, min_len, max_len, decl_req, type_req, fn_type_req, handler, |
| affects_type_identity } */ |
| { "interrupt_handler", 0, 0, true, false, false, |
| sh_handle_interrupt_handler_attribute, false }, |
| { "sp_switch", 1, 1, true, false, false, |
| sh_handle_sp_switch_attribute, false }, |
| { "trap_exit", 1, 1, true, false, false, |
| sh_handle_trap_exit_attribute, false }, |
| { "renesas", 0, 0, false, true, false, |
| sh_handle_renesas_attribute, false }, |
| { "trapa_handler", 0, 0, true, false, false, |
| sh_handle_interrupt_handler_attribute, false }, |
| { "nosave_low_regs", 0, 0, true, false, false, |
| sh_handle_interrupt_handler_attribute, false }, |
| { "resbank", 0, 0, true, false, false, |
| sh_handle_resbank_handler_attribute, false }, |
| { "function_vector", 1, 1, true, false, false, |
| sh2a_handle_function_vector_handler_attribute, false }, |
| { NULL, 0, 0, false, false, false, NULL, false } |
| }; |
| |
| /* Initialize the GCC target structure. */ |
| #undef TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE |
| #define TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE sh_attribute_table |
| |
| /* The next two are used for debug info when compiling with -gdwarf. */ |
| #undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP |
| #define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP "\t.uaword\t" |
| #undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP |
| #define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP "\t.ualong\t" |
| |
| /* These are NULLed out on non-SH5 in TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE. */ |
| #undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP |
| #define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP "\t.uaquad\t" |
| #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP |
| #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP "\t.quad\t" |
| |
| #undef TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE |
| #define TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE sh_option_override |
| #undef TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS |
| #define TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS sh_option_default_params |
| |
| #undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND |
| #define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND sh_print_operand |
| #undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS |
| #define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS sh_print_operand_address |
| #undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P |
| #define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P sh_print_operand_punct_valid_p |
| #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA |
| #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA sh_asm_output_addr_const_extra |
| |
| #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE |
| #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE sh_output_function_epilogue |
| |
| #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK |
| #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK sh_output_mi_thunk |
| |
| #undef TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK |
| #define TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK hook_bool_const_tree_hwi_hwi_const_tree_true |
| |
| #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START |
| #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START sh_file_start |
| #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE |
| #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE true |
| |
| #undef TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST |
| #define TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST sh_register_move_cost |
| |
| #undef TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES |
| #define TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES sh_insert_attributes |
| |
| #undef TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST |
| #define TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST sh_adjust_cost |
| |
| #undef TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE |
| #define TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE sh_issue_rate |
| |
| /* The next 5 hooks have been implemented for reenabling sched1. With the |
| help of these macros we are limiting the movement of insns in sched1 to |
| reduce the register pressure. The overall idea is to keep count of SImode |
| and SFmode regs required by already scheduled insns. When these counts |
| cross some threshold values; give priority to insns that free registers. |
| The insn that frees registers is most likely to be the insn with lowest |
| LUID (original insn order); but such an insn might be there in the stalled |
| queue (Q) instead of the ready queue (R). To solve this, we skip cycles |
| upto a max of 8 cycles so that such insns may move from Q -> R. |
| |
| The description of the hooks are as below: |
| |
| TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL: Added a new target hook in the generic |
| scheduler; it is called inside the sched_init function just after |
| find_insn_reg_weights function call. It is used to calculate the SImode |
| and SFmode weights of insns of basic blocks; much similar to what |
| find_insn_reg_weights does. |
| TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL: Corresponding cleanup hook. |
| |
| TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE: Skip cycles if high register pressure is |
| indicated by TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2; doing this may move insns from |
| (Q)->(R). |
| |
| TARGET_SCHED_REORDER: If the register pressure for SImode or SFmode is |
| high; reorder the ready queue so that the insn with lowest LUID will be |
| issued next. |
| |
| TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2: If the register pressure is high, indicate to |
| TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE to skip cycles. |
| |
| TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE: Cache the value of can_issue_more so that it |
| can be returned from TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2. |
| |
| TARGET_SCHED_INIT: Reset the register pressure counting variables. */ |
| |
| #undef TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE |
| #define TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE sh_dfa_new_cycle |
| |
| #undef TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL |
| #define TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL sh_md_init_global |
| |
| #undef TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL |
| #define TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL sh_md_finish_global |
| |
| #undef TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE |
| #define TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE sh_variable_issue |
| |
| #undef TARGET_SCHED_REORDER |
| #define TARGET_SCHED_REORDER sh_reorder |
| |
| #undef TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 |
| #define TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 sh_reorder2 |
| |
| #undef TARGET_SCHED_INIT |
| #define TARGET_SCHED_INIT sh_md_init |
| |
| #undef TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS |
| #define TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS sh_delegitimize_address |
| |
| #undef TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS |
| #define TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS sh_legitimize_address |
| |
| #undef TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P |
| #define TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P sh_cannot_modify_jumps_p |
| #undef TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS |
| #define TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS sh_target_reg_class |
| #undef TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED |
| #define TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED \ |
| sh_optimize_target_register_callee_saved |
| |
| #undef TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P |
| #define TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P sh_ms_bitfield_layout_p |
| |
| #undef TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS |
| #define TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS sh_init_builtins |
| #undef TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL |
| #define TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL sh_builtin_decl |
| #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN |
| #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN sh_expand_builtin |
| |
| #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL |
| #define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL sh_function_ok_for_sibcall |
| |
| #undef TARGET_CANNOT_COPY_INSN_P |
| #define TARGET_CANNOT_COPY_INSN_P sh_cannot_copy_insn_p |
| #undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS |
| #define TARGET_RTX_COSTS sh_rtx_costs |
| #undef TARGET_ADDRESS_COST |
| #define TARGET_ADDRESS_COST sh_address_cost |
| #undef TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE |
| #define TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE sh_allocate_initial_value |
| |
| #undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG |
| #define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG sh_reorg |
| |
| #undef TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN |
| #define TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN sh_dwarf_register_span |
| |
| #ifdef HAVE_AS_TLS |
| #undef TARGET_HAVE_TLS |
| #define TARGET_HAVE_TLS true |
| #endif |
| |
| #undef TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES |
| #define TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES sh_promote_prototypes |
| #undef TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE |
| #define TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE sh_promote_function_mode |
| |
| #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE |
| #define TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE sh_function_value |
| #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P |
| #define TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P sh_function_value_regno_p |
| #undef TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE |
| #define TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE sh_libcall_value |
| #undef TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX |
| #define TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX sh_struct_value_rtx |
| #undef TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY |
| #define TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY sh_return_in_memory |
| |
| #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS |
| #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS sh_builtin_saveregs |
| #undef TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS |
| #define TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS sh_setup_incoming_varargs |
| #undef TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING |
| #define TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING sh_strict_argument_naming |
| #undef TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED |
| #define TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED sh_pretend_outgoing_varargs_named |
| #undef TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK |
| #define TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK must_pass_in_stack_var_size |
| #undef TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE |
| #define TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE sh_pass_by_reference |
| #undef TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES |
| #define TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES sh_callee_copies |
| #undef TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES |
| #define TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES sh_arg_partial_bytes |
| #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG |
| #define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG sh_function_arg |
| #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE |
| #define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE sh_function_arg_advance |
| |
| #undef TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST |
| #define TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST sh_build_builtin_va_list |
| #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START |
| #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START sh_va_start |
| #undef TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR |
| #define TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR sh_gimplify_va_arg_expr |
| |
| #undef TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P |
| #define TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P sh_scalar_mode_supported_p |
| #undef TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P |
| #define TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P sh_vector_mode_supported_p |
| |
| #undef TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS |
| #define TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS sh_check_pch_target_flags |
| |
| #undef TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION |
| #define TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION sh_dwarf_calling_convention |
| |
| #undef TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED |
| #define TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED sh_frame_pointer_required |
| |
| /* Return regmode weight for insn. */ |
| #define INSN_REGMODE_WEIGHT(INSN, MODE) regmode_weight[((MODE) == SImode) ? 0 : 1][INSN_UID (INSN)] |
| |
| /* Return current register pressure for regmode. */ |
| #define CURR_REGMODE_PRESSURE(MODE) curr_regmode_pressure[((MODE) == SImode) ? 0 : 1] |
| |
| #undef TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO |
| #define TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO sh_encode_section_info |
| |
| #undef TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD |
| #define TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD sh_secondary_reload |
| |
| #undef TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS |
| #define TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS sh_preferred_reload_class |
| |
| #undef TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE |
| #define TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE sh_conditional_register_usage |
| |
| #undef TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P |
| #define TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P sh_legitimate_address_p |
| |
| #undef TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT |
| #define TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT sh_trampoline_init |
| #undef TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS |
| #define TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS sh_trampoline_adjust_address |
| |
| #undef TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P |
| #define TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P sh_legitimate_constant_p |
| |
| /* Machine-specific symbol_ref flags. */ |
| #define SYMBOL_FLAG_FUNCVEC_FUNCTION (SYMBOL_FLAG_MACH_DEP << 0) |
| |
| struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER; |
| |
| |
| /* Implement TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS. */ |
| static void |
| sh_option_default_params (void) |
| { |
| set_default_param_value (PARAM_SIMULTANEOUS_PREFETCHES, 2); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE macro. Validate and override |
| various options, and do some machine dependent initialization. */ |
| static void |
| sh_option_override (void) |
| { |
| int regno; |
| |
| SUBTARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS; |
| if (optimize > 1 && !optimize_size) |
| target_flags |= MASK_SAVE_ALL_TARGET_REGS; |
| if (flag_finite_math_only == 2) |
| flag_finite_math_only |
| = !flag_signaling_nans && TARGET_SH2E && ! TARGET_IEEE; |
| if (TARGET_SH2E && !flag_finite_math_only) |
| target_flags |= MASK_IEEE; |
| sh_cpu = PROCESSOR_SH1; |
| assembler_dialect = 0; |
| if (TARGET_SH2) |
| sh_cpu = PROCESSOR_SH2; |
| if (TARGET_SH2E) |
| sh_cpu = PROCESSOR_SH2E; |
| if (TARGET_SH2A) |
| sh_cpu = PROCESSOR_SH2A; |
| if (TARGET_SH3) |
| sh_cpu = PROCESSOR_SH3; |
| if (TARGET_SH3E) |
| sh_cpu = PROCESSOR_SH3E; |
| if (TARGET_SH4) |
| { |
| assembler_dialect = 1; |
| sh_cpu = PROCESSOR_SH4; |
| } |
| if (TARGET_SH4A_ARCH) |
| { |
| assembler_dialect = 1; |
| sh_cpu = PROCESSOR_SH4A; |
| } |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| sh_cpu = PROCESSOR_SH5; |
| target_flags |= MASK_ALIGN_DOUBLE; |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA_FPU) |
| target_flags |= MASK_FMOVD; |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| /* There are no delay slots on SHmedia. */ |
| flag_delayed_branch = 0; |
| /* Relaxation isn't yet supported for SHmedia */ |
| target_flags &= ~MASK_RELAX; |
| /* After reload, if conversion does little good but can cause |
| ICEs: |
| - find_if_block doesn't do anything for SH because we don't |
| have conditional execution patterns. (We use conditional |
| move patterns, which are handled differently, and only |
| before reload). |
| - find_cond_trap doesn't do anything for the SH because we |
| don't have conditional traps. |
| - find_if_case_1 uses redirect_edge_and_branch_force in |
| the only path that does an optimization, and this causes |
| an ICE when branch targets are in registers. |
| - find_if_case_2 doesn't do anything for the SHmedia after |
| reload except when it can redirect a tablejump - and |
| that's rather rare. */ |
| flag_if_conversion2 = 0; |
| if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "call")) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_CALL; |
| else if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "call2")) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_CALL2; |
| if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "fp") && TARGET_FPU_ANY) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_FP; |
| else if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "inv")) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_INV; |
| else if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "inv:minlat")) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_INV_MINLAT; |
| else if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "inv20u")) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_INV20U; |
| else if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "inv20l")) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_INV20L; |
| else if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "inv:call2")) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_INV_CALL2; |
| else if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "inv:call")) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_INV_CALL; |
| else if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "inv:fp")) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_FPU_ANY) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_INV_FP; |
| else |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_INV; |
| } |
| TARGET_CBRANCHDI4 = 0; |
| /* Assembler CFI isn't yet fully supported for SHmedia. */ |
| flag_dwarf2_cfi_asm = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Only the sh64-elf assembler fully supports .quad properly. */ |
| targetm.asm_out.aligned_op.di = NULL; |
| targetm.asm_out.unaligned_op.di = NULL; |
| } |
| if (TARGET_SH1) |
| { |
| if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "call-div1")) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_CALL_DIV1; |
| else if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "call-fp") |
| && (TARGET_FPU_DOUBLE |
| || (TARGET_HARD_SH4 && TARGET_SH2E) |
| || (TARGET_SHCOMPACT && TARGET_FPU_ANY))) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_CALL_FP; |
| else if (! strcmp (sh_div_str, "call-table") && TARGET_SH2) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_CALL_TABLE; |
| else |
| /* Pick one that makes most sense for the target in general. |
| It is not much good to use different functions depending |
| on -Os, since then we'll end up with two different functions |
| when some of the code is compiled for size, and some for |
| speed. */ |
| |
| /* SH4 tends to emphasize speed. */ |
| if (TARGET_HARD_SH4) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_CALL_TABLE; |
| /* These have their own way of doing things. */ |
| else if (TARGET_SH2A) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_INTRINSIC; |
| /* ??? Should we use the integer SHmedia function instead? */ |
| else if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT && TARGET_FPU_ANY) |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_CALL_FP; |
| /* SH1 .. SH3 cores often go into small-footprint systems, so |
| default to the smallest implementation available. */ |
| else if (TARGET_SH2) /* ??? EXPERIMENTAL */ |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_CALL_TABLE; |
| else |
| sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_CALL_DIV1; |
| } |
| if (!TARGET_SH1) |
| TARGET_PRETEND_CMOVE = 0; |
| if (sh_divsi3_libfunc[0]) |
| ; /* User supplied - leave it alone. */ |
| else if (TARGET_DIVIDE_CALL_FP) |
| sh_divsi3_libfunc = "__sdivsi3_i4"; |
| else if (TARGET_DIVIDE_CALL_TABLE) |
| sh_divsi3_libfunc = "__sdivsi3_i4i"; |
| else if (TARGET_SH5) |
| sh_divsi3_libfunc = "__sdivsi3_1"; |
| else |
| sh_divsi3_libfunc = "__sdivsi3"; |
| if (sh_branch_cost == -1) |
| sh_branch_cost |
| = TARGET_SH5 ? 1 : ! TARGET_SH2 || TARGET_HARD_SH4 ? 2 : 1; |
| |
| for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++) |
| if (! VALID_REGISTER_P (regno)) |
| sh_register_names[regno][0] = '\0'; |
| |
| for (regno = 0; regno < ADDREGNAMES_SIZE; regno++) |
| if (! VALID_REGISTER_P (ADDREGNAMES_REGNO (regno))) |
| sh_additional_register_names[regno][0] = '\0'; |
| |
| flag_omit_frame_pointer = (PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE == DWARF2_DEBUG); |
| |
| if ((flag_pic && ! TARGET_PREFERGOT) |
| || (TARGET_SHMEDIA && !TARGET_PT_FIXED)) |
| flag_no_function_cse = 1; |
| |
| if (targetm.small_register_classes_for_mode_p (VOIDmode)) \ |
| { |
| /* Never run scheduling before reload, since that can |
| break global alloc, and generates slower code anyway due |
| to the pressure on R0. */ |
| /* Enable sched1 for SH4 if the user explicitly requests. |
| When sched1 is enabled, the ready queue will be reordered by |
| the target hooks if pressure is high. We can not do this for |
| PIC, SH3 and lower as they give spill failures for R0. */ |
| if (!TARGET_HARD_SH4 || flag_pic) |
| flag_schedule_insns = 0; |
| /* ??? Current exception handling places basic block boundaries |
| after call_insns. It causes the high pressure on R0 and gives |
| spill failures for R0 in reload. See PR 22553 and the thread |
| on gcc-patches |
| <http://gcc.gnu.org/ml/gcc-patches/2005-10/msg00816.html>. */ |
| else if (flag_exceptions) |
| { |
| if (flag_schedule_insns && global_options_set.x_flag_schedule_insns) |
| warning (0, "ignoring -fschedule-insns because of exception handling bug"); |
| flag_schedule_insns = 0; |
| } |
| else if (flag_schedule_insns |
| && !global_options_set.x_flag_schedule_insns) |
| flag_schedule_insns = 0; |
| } |
| |
| if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS) == 0) |
| target_flags |= MASK_ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS; |
| |
| /* Unwind info is not correct around the CFG unless either a frame |
| pointer is present or M_A_O_A is set. Fixing this requires rewriting |
| unwind info generation to be aware of the CFG and propagating states |
| around edges. */ |
| if ((flag_unwind_tables || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables |
| || flag_exceptions || flag_non_call_exceptions) |
| && flag_omit_frame_pointer |
| && !(target_flags & MASK_ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)) |
| { |
| if (target_flags_explicit & MASK_ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS) |
| warning (0, "unwind tables currently require either a frame pointer " |
| "or -maccumulate-outgoing-args for correctness"); |
| target_flags |= MASK_ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS; |
| } |
| |
| /* Unwinding with -freorder-blocks-and-partition does not work on this |
| architecture, because it requires far jumps to label crossing between |
| hot/cold sections which are rejected on this architecture. */ |
| if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition) |
| { |
| if (flag_exceptions) |
| { |
| inform (input_location, |
| "-freorder-blocks-and-partition does not work with " |
| "exceptions on this architecture"); |
| flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition = 0; |
| flag_reorder_blocks = 1; |
| } |
| else if (flag_unwind_tables) |
| { |
| inform (input_location, |
| "-freorder-blocks-and-partition does not support unwind " |
| "info on this architecture"); |
| flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition = 0; |
| flag_reorder_blocks = 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (align_loops == 0) |
| align_loops = 1 << (TARGET_SH5 ? 3 : 2); |
| if (align_jumps == 0) |
| align_jumps = 1 << CACHE_LOG; |
| else if (align_jumps < (TARGET_SHMEDIA ? 4 : 2)) |
| align_jumps = TARGET_SHMEDIA ? 4 : 2; |
| |
| /* Allocation boundary (in *bytes*) for the code of a function. |
| SH1: 32 bit alignment is faster, because instructions are always |
| fetched as a pair from a longword boundary. |
| SH2 .. SH5 : align to cache line start. */ |
| if (align_functions == 0) |
| align_functions |
| = optimize_size ? FUNCTION_BOUNDARY/8 : (1 << CACHE_LOG); |
| /* The linker relaxation code breaks when a function contains |
| alignments that are larger than that at the start of a |
| compilation unit. */ |
| if (TARGET_RELAX) |
| { |
| int min_align |
| = align_loops > align_jumps ? align_loops : align_jumps; |
| |
| /* Also take possible .long constants / mova tables int account. */ |
| if (min_align < 4) |
| min_align = 4; |
| if (align_functions < min_align) |
| align_functions = min_align; |
| } |
| |
| if (sh_fixed_range_str) |
| sh_fix_range (sh_fixed_range_str); |
| |
| /* This target defaults to strict volatile bitfields. */ |
| if (flag_strict_volatile_bitfields < 0) |
| flag_strict_volatile_bitfields = 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Print the operand address in x to the stream. */ |
| |
| static void |
| sh_print_operand_address (FILE *stream, rtx x) |
| { |
| switch (GET_CODE (x)) |
| { |
| case REG: |
| case SUBREG: |
| fprintf (stream, "@%s", reg_names[true_regnum (x)]); |
| break; |
| |
| case PLUS: |
| { |
| rtx base = XEXP (x, 0); |
| rtx index = XEXP (x, 1); |
| |
| switch (GET_CODE (index)) |
| { |
| case CONST_INT: |
| fprintf (stream, "@(%d,%s)", (int) INTVAL (index), |
| reg_names[true_regnum (base)]); |
| break; |
| |
| case REG: |
| case SUBREG: |
| { |
| int base_num = true_regnum (base); |
| int index_num = true_regnum (index); |
| |
| fprintf (stream, "@(r0,%s)", |
| reg_names[MAX (base_num, index_num)]); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| default: |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| } |
| break; |
| |
| case PRE_DEC: |
| fprintf (stream, "@-%s", reg_names[true_regnum (XEXP (x, 0))]); |
| break; |
| |
| case POST_INC: |
| fprintf (stream, "@%s+", reg_names[true_regnum (XEXP (x, 0))]); |
| break; |
| |
| default: |
| x = mark_constant_pool_use (x); |
| output_addr_const (stream, x); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Print operand x (an rtx) in assembler syntax to file stream |
| according to modifier code. |
| |
| '.' print a .s if insn needs delay slot |
| ',' print LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX |
| '@' print trap, rte or rts depending upon pragma interruptness |
| '#' output a nop if there is nothing to put in the delay slot |
| ''' print likelihood suffix (/u for unlikely). |
| '>' print branch target if -fverbose-asm |
| 'O' print a constant without the # |
| 'R' print the LSW of a dp value - changes if in little endian |
| 'S' print the MSW of a dp value - changes if in little endian |
| 'T' print the next word of a dp value - same as 'R' in big endian mode. |
| 'M' SHMEDIA: print an `x' if `m' will print `base,index'. |
| otherwise: print .b / .w / .l / .s / .d suffix if operand is a MEM. |
| 'N' print 'r63' if the operand is (const_int 0). |
| 'd' print a V2SF reg as dN instead of fpN. |
| 'm' print a pair `base,offset' or `base,index', for LD and ST. |
| 'U' Likewise for {LD,ST}{HI,LO}. |
| 'V' print the position of a single bit set. |
| 'W' print the position of a single bit cleared. |
| 't' print a memory address which is a register. |
| 'u' prints the lowest 16 bits of CONST_INT, as an unsigned value. |
| 'o' output an operator. */ |
| |
| static void |
| sh_print_operand (FILE *stream, rtx x, int code) |
| { |
| int regno; |
| enum machine_mode mode; |
| |
| switch (code) |
| { |
| tree trapa_attr; |
| |
| case '.': |
| if (final_sequence |
| && ! INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 0)) |
| && get_attr_length (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 1))) |
| fprintf (stream, ASSEMBLER_DIALECT ? "/s" : ".s"); |
| break; |
| case ',': |
| fprintf (stream, "%s", LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX); |
| break; |
| case '@': |
| trapa_attr = lookup_attribute ("trap_exit", |
| DECL_ATTRIBUTES (current_function_decl)); |
| if (trapa_attr) |
| fprintf (stream, "trapa #%ld", |
| (long) TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (trapa_attr)))); |
| else if (sh_cfun_interrupt_handler_p ()) |
| { |
| if (sh_cfun_resbank_handler_p ()) |
| fprintf (stream, "resbank\n"); |
| fprintf (stream, "rte"); |
| } |
| else |
| fprintf (stream, "rts"); |
| break; |
| case '#': |
| /* Output a nop if there's nothing in the delay slot. */ |
| if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0) |
| fprintf (stream, "\n\tnop"); |
| break; |
| case '\'': |
| { |
| rtx note = find_reg_note (current_output_insn, REG_BR_PROB, 0); |
| |
| if (note && INTVAL (XEXP (note, 0)) * 2 < REG_BR_PROB_BASE) |
| fputs ("/u", stream); |
| break; |
| } |
| case '>': |
| if (flag_verbose_asm && JUMP_LABEL (current_output_insn)) |
| { |
| fputs ("\t! target: ", stream); |
| output_addr_const (stream, JUMP_LABEL (current_output_insn)); |
| } |
| break; |
| case 'O': |
| x = mark_constant_pool_use (x); |
| output_addr_const (stream, x); |
| break; |
| /* N.B.: %R / %S / %T adjust memory addresses by four. |
| For SHMEDIA, that means they can be used to access the first and |
| second 32 bit part of a 64 bit (or larger) value that |
| might be held in floating point registers or memory. |
| While they can be used to access 64 bit parts of a larger value |
| held in general purpose registers, that won't work with memory - |
| neither for fp registers, since the frxx names are used. */ |
| case 'R': |
| if (REG_P (x) || GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG) |
| { |
| regno = true_regnum (x); |
| regno += FP_REGISTER_P (regno) ? 1 : LSW; |
| fputs (reg_names[regno], (stream)); |
| } |
| else if (MEM_P (x)) |
| { |
| x = adjust_address (x, SImode, 4 * LSW); |
| sh_print_operand_address (stream, XEXP (x, 0)); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| rtx sub = NULL_RTX; |
| |
| mode = GET_MODE (x); |
| if (mode == VOIDmode) |
| mode = DImode; |
| if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= 8) |
| sub = simplify_subreg (SImode, x, mode, 4 * LSW); |
| if (sub) |
| sh_print_operand (stream, sub, 0); |
| else |
| output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand to %%R"); |
| } |
| break; |
| case 'S': |
| if (REG_P (x) || GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG) |
| { |
| regno = true_regnum (x); |
| regno += FP_REGISTER_P (regno) ? 0 : MSW; |
| fputs (reg_names[regno], (stream)); |
| } |
| else if (MEM_P (x)) |
| { |
| x = adjust_address (x, SImode, 4 * MSW); |
| sh_print_operand_address (stream, XEXP (x, 0)); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| rtx sub = NULL_RTX; |
| |
| mode = GET_MODE (x); |
| if (mode == VOIDmode) |
| mode = DImode; |
| if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= 8) |
| sub = simplify_subreg (SImode, x, mode, 4 * MSW); |
| if (sub) |
| sh_print_operand (stream, sub, 0); |
| else |
| output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand to %%S"); |
| } |
| break; |
| case 'T': |
| /* Next word of a double. */ |
| switch (GET_CODE (x)) |
| { |
| case REG: |
| fputs (reg_names[REGNO (x) + 1], (stream)); |
| break; |
| case MEM: |
| if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != PRE_DEC |
| && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != POST_INC) |
| x = adjust_address (x, SImode, 4); |
| sh_print_operand_address (stream, XEXP (x, 0)); |
| break; |
| default: |
| break; |
| } |
| break; |
| |
| case 't': |
| gcc_assert (MEM_P (x)); |
| x = XEXP (x, 0); |
| switch (GET_CODE (x)) |
| { |
| case REG: |
| case SUBREG: |
| sh_print_operand (stream, x, 0); |
| break; |
| default: |
| break; |
| } |
| break; |
| |
| case 'o': |
| switch (GET_CODE (x)) |
| { |
| case PLUS: fputs ("add", stream); break; |
| case MINUS: fputs ("sub", stream); break; |
| case MULT: fputs ("mul", stream); break; |
| case DIV: fputs ("div", stream); break; |
| case EQ: fputs ("eq", stream); break; |
| case NE: fputs ("ne", stream); break; |
| case GT: case LT: fputs ("gt", stream); break; |
| case GE: case LE: fputs ("ge", stream); break; |
| case GTU: case LTU: fputs ("gtu", stream); break; |
| case GEU: case LEU: fputs ("geu", stream); break; |
| default: |
| break; |
| } |
| break; |
| case 'M': |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| if (MEM_P (x) |
| && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS |
| && (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) |
| || GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == SUBREG)) |
| fputc ('x', stream); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (MEM_P (x)) |
| { |
| switch (GET_MODE (x)) |
| { |
| case QImode: fputs (".b", stream); break; |
| case HImode: fputs (".w", stream); break; |
| case SImode: fputs (".l", stream); break; |
| case SFmode: fputs (".s", stream); break; |
| case DFmode: fputs (".d", stream); break; |
| default: gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| break; |
| |
| case 'm': |
| gcc_assert (MEM_P (x)); |
| x = XEXP (x, 0); |
| /* Fall through. */ |
| case 'U': |
| switch (GET_CODE (x)) |
| { |
| case REG: |
| case SUBREG: |
| sh_print_operand (stream, x, 0); |
| fputs (", 0", stream); |
| break; |
| |
| case PLUS: |
| sh_print_operand (stream, XEXP (x, 0), 0); |
| fputs (", ", stream); |
| sh_print_operand (stream, XEXP (x, 1), 0); |
| break; |
| |
| default: |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| break; |
| |
| case 'V': |
| { |
| int num = exact_log2 (INTVAL (x)); |
| gcc_assert (num >= 0); |
| fprintf (stream, "#%d", num); |
| } |
| break; |
| |
| case 'W': |
| { |
| int num = exact_log2 (~INTVAL (x)); |
| gcc_assert (num >= 0); |
| fprintf (stream, "#%d", num); |
| } |
| break; |
| |
| case 'd': |
| gcc_assert (REG_P (x) && GET_MODE (x) == V2SFmode); |
| |
| fprintf ((stream), "d%s", reg_names[REGNO (x)] + 1); |
| break; |
| |
| case 'N': |
| if (x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x))) |
| { |
| fprintf ((stream), "r63"); |
| break; |
| } |
| goto default_output; |
| case 'u': |
| if (CONST_INT_P (x)) |
| { |
| fprintf ((stream), "%u", (unsigned) INTVAL (x) & (0x10000 - 1)); |
| break; |
| } |
| /* Fall through. */ |
| |
| default_output: |
| default: |
| regno = 0; |
| mode = GET_MODE (x); |
| |
| switch (GET_CODE (x)) |
| { |
| case TRUNCATE: |
| { |
| rtx inner = XEXP (x, 0); |
| int offset = 0; |
| enum machine_mode inner_mode; |
| |
| /* We might see SUBREGs with vector mode registers inside. */ |
| if (GET_CODE (inner) == SUBREG |
| && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)) |
| == GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (inner)))) |
| && subreg_lowpart_p (inner)) |
| inner = SUBREG_REG (inner); |
| if (CONST_INT_P (inner)) |
| { |
| x = GEN_INT (trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (inner), GET_MODE (x))); |
| goto default_output; |
| } |
| inner_mode = GET_MODE (inner); |
| if (GET_CODE (inner) == SUBREG |
| && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)) |
| < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (inner)))) |
| && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (inner))) |
| { |
| offset = subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (inner)), |
| GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (inner)), |
| SUBREG_BYTE (inner), |
| GET_MODE (inner)); |
| inner = SUBREG_REG (inner); |
| } |
| if (!REG_P (inner) || GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) > 8) |
| abort (); |
| /* Floating point register pairs are always big endian; |
| general purpose registers are 64 bit wide. */ |
| regno = REGNO (inner); |
| regno = (HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, inner_mode) |
| - HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode)) |
| + offset; |
| x = inner; |
| goto reg; |
| } |
| case SIGN_EXTEND: |
| x = XEXP (x, 0); |
| goto reg; |
| /* FIXME: We need this on SHmedia32 because reload generates |
| some sign-extended HI or QI loads into DImode registers |
| but, because Pmode is SImode, the address ends up with a |
| subreg:SI of the DImode register. Maybe reload should be |
| fixed so as to apply alter_subreg to such loads? */ |
| case IF_THEN_ELSE: |
| gcc_assert (trapping_target_operand (x, VOIDmode)); |
| x = XEXP (XEXP (x, 2), 0); |
| goto default_output; |
| case SUBREG: |
| gcc_assert (SUBREG_BYTE (x) == 0 |
| && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))); |
| |
| x = SUBREG_REG (x); |
| /* Fall through. */ |
| |
| reg: |
| case REG: |
| regno += REGNO (x); |
| if (FP_REGISTER_P (regno) |
| && mode == V16SFmode) |
| fprintf ((stream), "mtrx%s", reg_names[regno] + 2); |
| else if (FP_REGISTER_P (REGNO (x)) |
| && mode == V4SFmode) |
| fprintf ((stream), "fv%s", reg_names[regno] + 2); |
| else if (REG_P (x) |
| && mode == V2SFmode) |
| fprintf ((stream), "fp%s", reg_names[regno] + 2); |
| else if (FP_REGISTER_P (REGNO (x)) |
| && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > 4) |
| fprintf ((stream), "d%s", reg_names[regno] + 1); |
| else |
| fputs (reg_names[regno], (stream)); |
| break; |
| |
| case MEM: |
| output_address (XEXP (x, 0)); |
| break; |
| |
| default: |
| if (TARGET_SH1) |
| fputc ('#', stream); |
| output_addr_const (stream, x); |
| break; |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_print_operand_punct_valid_p (unsigned char code) |
| { |
| return (code == '.' || code == '#' || code == '@' || code == ',' |
| || code == '$' || code == '\'' || code == '>'); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_asm_output_addr_const_extra (FILE *file, rtx x) |
| { |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC) |
| { |
| switch (XINT (x, 1)) |
| { |
| case UNSPEC_DATALABEL: |
| fputs ("datalabel ", file); |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)); |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_PIC: |
| /* GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE or local symbols, no suffix. */ |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)); |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_GOT: |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)); |
| fputs ("@GOT", file); |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_GOTOFF: |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)); |
| fputs ("@GOTOFF", file); |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_PLT: |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)); |
| fputs ("@PLT", file); |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_GOTPLT: |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)); |
| fputs ("@GOTPLT", file); |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_DTPOFF: |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)); |
| fputs ("@DTPOFF", file); |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_GOTTPOFF: |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)); |
| fputs ("@GOTTPOFF", file); |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_TPOFF: |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)); |
| fputs ("@TPOFF", file); |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_CALLER: |
| { |
| char name[32]; |
| /* LPCS stands for Label for PIC Call Site. */ |
| targetm.asm_out.generate_internal_label (name, "LPCS", |
| INTVAL (XVECEXP (x, 0, 0))); |
| assemble_name (file, name); |
| } |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_EXTRACT_S16: |
| case UNSPEC_EXTRACT_U16: |
| { |
| rtx val, shift; |
| |
| val = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0); |
| shift = XVECEXP (x, 0, 1); |
| fputc ('(', file); |
| if (shift != const0_rtx) |
| fputc ('(', file); |
| if (GET_CODE (val) == CONST |
| || GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (val)) != RTX_OBJ) |
| { |
| fputc ('(', file); |
| output_addr_const (file, val); |
| fputc (')', file); |
| } |
| else |
| output_addr_const (file, val); |
| if (shift != const0_rtx) |
| { |
| fputs (" >> ", file); |
| output_addr_const (file, shift); |
| fputc (')', file); |
| } |
| fputs (" & 65535)", file); |
| } |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_SYMOFF: |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)); |
| fputc ('-', file); |
| if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (x, 0, 1)) == CONST) |
| { |
| fputc ('(', file); |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 1)); |
| fputc (')', file); |
| } |
| else |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 1)); |
| break; |
| case UNSPEC_PCREL_SYMOFF: |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)); |
| fputs ("-(", file); |
| output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (x, 0, 1)); |
| fputs ("-.)", file); |
| break; |
| default: |
| return false; |
| } |
| return true; |
| } |
| else |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Encode symbol attributes of a SYMBOL_REF into its |
| SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS. */ |
| static void |
| sh_encode_section_info (tree decl, rtx rtl, int first) |
| { |
| default_encode_section_info (decl, rtl, first); |
| |
| if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL |
| && sh2a_function_vector_p (decl) && TARGET_SH2A) |
| SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (XEXP (rtl, 0)) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_FUNCVEC_FUNCTION; |
| } |
| |
| /* Like force_operand, but guarantees that VALUE ends up in TARGET. */ |
| static void |
| force_into (rtx value, rtx target) |
| { |
| value = force_operand (value, target); |
| if (! rtx_equal_p (value, target)) |
| emit_insn (gen_move_insn (target, value)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Emit code to perform a block move. Choose the best method. |
| |
| OPERANDS[0] is the destination. |
| OPERANDS[1] is the source. |
| OPERANDS[2] is the size. |
| OPERANDS[3] is the alignment safe to use. */ |
| |
| int |
| expand_block_move (rtx *operands) |
| { |
| int align = INTVAL (operands[3]); |
| int constp = (CONST_INT_P (operands[2])); |
| int bytes = (constp ? INTVAL (operands[2]) : 0); |
| |
| if (! constp) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* If we could use mov.l to move words and dest is word-aligned, we |
| can use movua.l for loads and still generate a relatively short |
| and efficient sequence. */ |
| if (TARGET_SH4A_ARCH && align < 4 |
| && MEM_ALIGN (operands[0]) >= 32 |
| && can_move_by_pieces (bytes, 32)) |
| { |
| rtx dest = copy_rtx (operands[0]); |
| rtx src = copy_rtx (operands[1]); |
| /* We could use different pseudos for each copied word, but |
| since movua can only load into r0, it's kind of |
| pointless. */ |
| rtx temp = gen_reg_rtx (SImode); |
| rtx src_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (src, 0)); |
| int copied = 0; |
| |
| while (copied + 4 <= bytes) |
| { |
| rtx to = adjust_address (dest, SImode, copied); |
| rtx from = adjust_automodify_address (src, BLKmode, |
| src_addr, copied); |
| |
| set_mem_size (from, GEN_INT (4)); |
| emit_insn (gen_movua (temp, from)); |
| emit_move_insn (src_addr, plus_constant (src_addr, 4)); |
| emit_move_insn (to, temp); |
| copied += 4; |
| } |
| |
| if (copied < bytes) |
| move_by_pieces (adjust_address (dest, BLKmode, copied), |
| adjust_automodify_address (src, BLKmode, |
| src_addr, copied), |
| bytes - copied, align, 0); |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* If it isn't a constant number of bytes, or if it doesn't have 4 byte |
| alignment, or if it isn't a multiple of 4 bytes, then fail. */ |
| if (align < 4 || (bytes % 4 != 0)) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (TARGET_HARD_SH4) |
| { |
| if (bytes < 12) |
| return 0; |
| else if (bytes == 12) |
| { |
| rtx func_addr_rtx = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| rtx r4 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 4); |
| rtx r5 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 5); |
| |
| function_symbol (func_addr_rtx, "__movmemSI12_i4", SFUNC_STATIC); |
| force_into (XEXP (operands[0], 0), r4); |
| force_into (XEXP (operands[1], 0), r5); |
| emit_insn (gen_block_move_real_i4 (func_addr_rtx)); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| else if (! optimize_size) |
| { |
| const char *entry_name; |
| rtx func_addr_rtx = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| int dwords; |
| rtx r4 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 4); |
| rtx r5 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 5); |
| rtx r6 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 6); |
| |
| entry_name = (bytes & 4 ? "__movmem_i4_odd" : "__movmem_i4_even"); |
| function_symbol (func_addr_rtx, entry_name, SFUNC_STATIC); |
| force_into (XEXP (operands[0], 0), r4); |
| force_into (XEXP (operands[1], 0), r5); |
| |
| dwords = bytes >> 3; |
| emit_insn (gen_move_insn (r6, GEN_INT (dwords - 1))); |
| emit_insn (gen_block_lump_real_i4 (func_addr_rtx)); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| else |
| return 0; |
| } |
| if (bytes < 64) |
| { |
| char entry[30]; |
| rtx func_addr_rtx = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| rtx r4 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 4); |
| rtx r5 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 5); |
| |
| sprintf (entry, "__movmemSI%d", bytes); |
| function_symbol (func_addr_rtx, entry, SFUNC_STATIC); |
| force_into (XEXP (operands[0], 0), r4); |
| force_into (XEXP (operands[1], 0), r5); |
| emit_insn (gen_block_move_real (func_addr_rtx)); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* This is the same number of bytes as a memcpy call, but to a different |
| less common function name, so this will occasionally use more space. */ |
| if (! optimize_size) |
| { |
| rtx func_addr_rtx = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| int final_switch, while_loop; |
| rtx r4 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 4); |
| rtx r5 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 5); |
| rtx r6 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 6); |
| |
| function_symbol (func_addr_rtx, "__movmem", SFUNC_STATIC); |
| force_into (XEXP (operands[0], 0), r4); |
| force_into (XEXP (operands[1], 0), r5); |
| |
| /* r6 controls the size of the move. 16 is decremented from it |
| for each 64 bytes moved. Then the negative bit left over is used |
| as an index into a list of move instructions. e.g., a 72 byte move |
| would be set up with size(r6) = 14, for one iteration through the |
| big while loop, and a switch of -2 for the last part. */ |
| |
| final_switch = 16 - ((bytes / 4) % 16); |
| while_loop = ((bytes / 4) / 16 - 1) * 16; |
| emit_insn (gen_move_insn (r6, GEN_INT (while_loop + final_switch))); |
| emit_insn (gen_block_lump_real (func_addr_rtx)); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Prepare operands for a move define_expand; specifically, one of the |
| operands must be in a register. */ |
| |
| int |
| prepare_move_operands (rtx operands[], enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| if ((mode == SImode || mode == DImode) |
| && flag_pic |
| && ! ((mode == Pmode || mode == ptr_mode) |
| && tls_symbolic_operand (operands[1], Pmode) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)) |
| { |
| rtx temp; |
| if (SYMBOLIC_CONST_P (operands[1])) |
| { |
| if (MEM_P (operands[0])) |
| operands[1] = force_reg (Pmode, operands[1]); |
| else if (TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && GET_CODE (operands[1]) == LABEL_REF |
| && target_reg_operand (operands[0], mode)) |
| /* It's ok. */; |
| else |
| { |
| temp = (!can_create_pseudo_p () |
| ? operands[0] |
| : gen_reg_rtx (Pmode)); |
| operands[1] = legitimize_pic_address (operands[1], mode, temp); |
| } |
| } |
| else if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST |
| && GET_CODE (XEXP (operands[1], 0)) == PLUS |
| && SYMBOLIC_CONST_P (XEXP (XEXP (operands[1], 0), 0))) |
| { |
| temp = !can_create_pseudo_p () ? operands[0] : gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| temp = legitimize_pic_address (XEXP (XEXP (operands[1], 0), 0), |
| mode, temp); |
| operands[1] = expand_binop (mode, add_optab, temp, |
| XEXP (XEXP (operands[1], 0), 1), |
| (!can_create_pseudo_p () |
| ? temp |
| : gen_reg_rtx (Pmode)), |
| 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (! reload_in_progress && ! reload_completed) |
| { |
| /* Copy the source to a register if both operands aren't registers. */ |
| if (! register_operand (operands[0], mode) |
| && ! sh_register_operand (operands[1], mode)) |
| operands[1] = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, operands[1]); |
| |
| if (MEM_P (operands[0]) && ! memory_operand (operands[0], mode)) |
| { |
| /* This is like change_address_1 (operands[0], mode, 0, 1) , |
| except that we can't use that function because it is static. */ |
| rtx new_rtx = change_address (operands[0], mode, 0); |
| MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (new_rtx, operands[0]); |
| operands[0] = new_rtx; |
| } |
| |
| /* This case can happen while generating code to move the result |
| of a library call to the target. Reject `st r0,@(rX,rY)' because |
| reload will fail to find a spill register for rX, since r0 is already |
| being used for the source. */ |
| else if (TARGET_SH1 |
| && refers_to_regno_p (R0_REG, R0_REG + 1, operands[1], (rtx *)0) |
| && MEM_P (operands[0]) |
| && GET_CODE (XEXP (operands[0], 0)) == PLUS |
| && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (operands[0], 0), 1))) |
| operands[1] = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, operands[1]); |
| } |
| |
| if (mode == Pmode || mode == ptr_mode) |
| { |
| rtx op0, op1, opc; |
| enum tls_model tls_kind; |
| |
| op0 = operands[0]; |
| op1 = operands[1]; |
| if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST |
| && GET_CODE (XEXP (op1, 0)) == PLUS |
| && (tls_symbolic_operand (XEXP (XEXP (op1, 0), 0), Pmode) |
| != TLS_MODEL_NONE)) |
| { |
| opc = XEXP (XEXP (op1, 0), 1); |
| op1 = XEXP (XEXP (op1, 0), 0); |
| } |
| else |
| opc = NULL_RTX; |
| |
| if ((tls_kind = tls_symbolic_operand (op1, Pmode)) != TLS_MODEL_NONE) |
| { |
| rtx tga_op1, tga_ret, tmp, tmp2; |
| |
| if (! flag_pic |
| && (tls_kind == TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC |
| || tls_kind == TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC |
| || tls_kind == TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC)) |
| { |
| /* Don't schedule insns for getting GOT address when |
| the first scheduling is enabled, to avoid spill |
| failures for R0. */ |
| if (flag_schedule_insns) |
| emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); |
| emit_insn (gen_GOTaddr2picreg ()); |
| emit_use (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, PIC_REG)); |
| if (flag_schedule_insns) |
| emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); |
| } |
| |
| switch (tls_kind) |
| { |
| case TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC: |
| tga_ret = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, R0_REG); |
| emit_call_insn (gen_tls_global_dynamic (tga_ret, op1)); |
| tmp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| emit_move_insn (tmp, tga_ret); |
| op1 = tmp; |
| break; |
| |
| case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC: |
| tga_ret = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, R0_REG); |
| emit_call_insn (gen_tls_local_dynamic (tga_ret, op1)); |
| |
| tmp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| emit_move_insn (tmp, tga_ret); |
| |
| if (register_operand (op0, Pmode)) |
| tmp2 = op0; |
| else |
| tmp2 = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| |
| emit_insn (gen_symDTPOFF2reg (tmp2, op1, tmp)); |
| op1 = tmp2; |
| break; |
| |
| case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC: |
| tga_op1 = !can_create_pseudo_p () ? op0 : gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| tmp = gen_sym2GOTTPOFF (op1); |
| emit_insn (gen_tls_initial_exec (tga_op1, tmp)); |
| op1 = tga_op1; |
| break; |
| |
| case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC: |
| tmp2 = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| emit_insn (gen_load_gbr (tmp2)); |
| tmp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| emit_insn (gen_symTPOFF2reg (tmp, op1)); |
| |
| if (register_operand (op0, Pmode)) |
| op1 = op0; |
| else |
| op1 = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| |
| emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (op1, tmp, tmp2)); |
| break; |
| |
| default: |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| if (opc) |
| emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (op1, op1, force_reg (SImode, opc))); |
| operands[1] = op1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| enum rtx_code |
| prepare_cbranch_operands (rtx *operands, enum machine_mode mode, |
| enum rtx_code comparison) |
| { |
| rtx op1; |
| rtx scratch = NULL_RTX; |
| |
| if (comparison == LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE) |
| comparison = GET_CODE (operands[0]); |
| else |
| scratch = operands[4]; |
| if (CONST_INT_P (operands[1]) |
| && !CONST_INT_P (operands[2])) |
| { |
| rtx tmp = operands[1]; |
| |
| operands[1] = operands[2]; |
| operands[2] = tmp; |
| comparison = swap_condition (comparison); |
| } |
| if (CONST_INT_P (operands[2])) |
| { |
| HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (operands[2]); |
| if ((val == -1 || val == -0x81) |
| && (comparison == GT || comparison == LE)) |
| { |
| comparison = (comparison == GT) ? GE : LT; |
| operands[2] = gen_int_mode (val + 1, mode); |
| } |
| else if ((val == 1 || val == 0x80) |
| && (comparison == GE || comparison == LT)) |
| { |
| comparison = (comparison == GE) ? GT : LE; |
| operands[2] = gen_int_mode (val - 1, mode); |
| } |
| else if (val == 1 && (comparison == GEU || comparison == LTU)) |
| { |
| comparison = (comparison == GEU) ? NE : EQ; |
| operands[2] = CONST0_RTX (mode); |
| } |
| else if (val == 0x80 && (comparison == GEU || comparison == LTU)) |
| { |
| comparison = (comparison == GEU) ? GTU : LEU; |
| operands[2] = gen_int_mode (val - 1, mode); |
| } |
| else if (val == 0 && (comparison == GTU || comparison == LEU)) |
| comparison = (comparison == GTU) ? NE : EQ; |
| else if (mode == SImode |
| && ((val == 0x7fffffff |
| && (comparison == GTU || comparison == LEU)) |
| || ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val |
| == (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0x7fffffff + 1 |
| && (comparison == GEU || comparison == LTU)))) |
| { |
| comparison = (comparison == GTU || comparison == GEU) ? LT : GE; |
| operands[2] = CONST0_RTX (mode); |
| } |
| } |
| op1 = operands[1]; |
| if (can_create_pseudo_p ()) |
| operands[1] = force_reg (mode, op1); |
| /* When we are handling DImode comparisons, we want to keep constants so |
| that we can optimize the component comparisons; however, memory loads |
| are better issued as a whole so that they can be scheduled well. |
| SImode equality comparisons allow I08 constants, but only when they |
| compare r0. Hence, if operands[1] has to be loaded from somewhere else |
| into a register, that register might as well be r0, and we allow the |
| constant. If it is already in a register, this is likely to be |
| allocated to a different hard register, thus we load the constant into |
| a register unless it is zero. */ |
| if (!REG_P (operands[2]) |
| && (!CONST_INT_P (operands[2]) |
| || (mode == SImode && operands[2] != CONST0_RTX (SImode) |
| && ((comparison != EQ && comparison != NE) |
| || (REG_P (op1) && REGNO (op1) != R0_REG) |
| || !satisfies_constraint_I08 (operands[2]))))) |
| { |
| if (scratch && GET_MODE (scratch) == mode) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (scratch, operands[2]); |
| operands[2] = scratch; |
| } |
| else if (can_create_pseudo_p ()) |
| operands[2] = force_reg (mode, operands[2]); |
| } |
| return comparison; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| expand_cbranchsi4 (rtx *operands, enum rtx_code comparison, int probability) |
| { |
| rtx (*branch_expander) (rtx) = gen_branch_true; |
| rtx jump; |
| |
| comparison = prepare_cbranch_operands (operands, SImode, comparison); |
| switch (comparison) |
| { |
| case NE: case LT: case LE: case LTU: case LEU: |
| comparison = reverse_condition (comparison); |
| branch_expander = gen_branch_false; |
| default: ; |
| } |
| emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, T_REG), |
| gen_rtx_fmt_ee (comparison, SImode, |
| operands[1], operands[2]))); |
| jump = emit_jump_insn (branch_expander (operands[3])); |
| if (probability >= 0) |
| add_reg_note (jump, REG_BR_PROB, GEN_INT (probability)); |
| |
| } |
| |
| /* ??? How should we distribute probabilities when more than one branch |
| is generated. So far we only have soem ad-hoc observations: |
| - If the operands are random, they are likely to differ in both parts. |
| - If comparing items in a hash chain, the operands are random or equal; |
| operation should be EQ or NE. |
| - If items are searched in an ordered tree from the root, we can expect |
| the highpart to be unequal about half of the time; operation should be |
| an inequality comparison, operands non-constant, and overall probability |
| about 50%. Likewise for quicksort. |
| - Range checks will be often made against constants. Even if we assume for |
| simplicity an even distribution of the non-constant operand over a |
| sub-range here, the same probability could be generated with differently |
| wide sub-ranges - as long as the ratio of the part of the subrange that |
| is before the threshold to the part that comes after the threshold stays |
| the same. Thus, we can't really tell anything here; |
| assuming random distribution is at least simple. |
| */ |
| |
| bool |
| expand_cbranchdi4 (rtx *operands, enum rtx_code comparison) |
| { |
| enum rtx_code msw_taken, msw_skip, lsw_taken; |
| rtx skip_label = NULL_RTX; |
| rtx op1h, op1l, op2h, op2l; |
| int num_branches; |
| int prob, rev_prob; |
| int msw_taken_prob = -1, msw_skip_prob = -1, lsw_taken_prob = -1; |
| rtx scratch = operands[4]; |
| |
| comparison = prepare_cbranch_operands (operands, DImode, comparison); |
| op1h = gen_highpart_mode (SImode, DImode, operands[1]); |
| op2h = gen_highpart_mode (SImode, DImode, operands[2]); |
| op1l = gen_lowpart (SImode, operands[1]); |
| op2l = gen_lowpart (SImode, operands[2]); |
| msw_taken = msw_skip = lsw_taken = LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE; |
| prob = split_branch_probability; |
| rev_prob = REG_BR_PROB_BASE - prob; |
| switch (comparison) |
| { |
| /* ??? Should we use the cmpeqdi_t pattern for equality comparisons? |
| That costs 1 cycle more when the first branch can be predicted taken, |
| but saves us mispredicts because only one branch needs prediction. |
| It also enables generating the cmpeqdi_t-1 pattern. */ |
| case EQ: |
| if (TARGET_CMPEQDI_T) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_cmpeqdi_t (operands[1], operands[2])); |
| emit_jump_insn (gen_branch_true (operands[3])); |
| return true; |
| } |
| msw_skip = NE; |
| lsw_taken = EQ; |
| if (prob >= 0) |
| { |
| /* If we had more precision, we'd use rev_prob - (rev_prob >> 32) . |
| */ |
| msw_skip_prob = rev_prob; |
| if (REG_BR_PROB_BASE <= 65535) |
| lsw_taken_prob = prob ? REG_BR_PROB_BASE : 0; |
| else |
| { |
| gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDEST_INT >= 64); |
| lsw_taken_prob |
| = (prob |
| ? (REG_BR_PROB_BASE |
| - ((HOST_WIDEST_INT) REG_BR_PROB_BASE * rev_prob |
| / ((HOST_WIDEST_INT) prob << 32))) |
| : 0); |
| } |
| } |
| break; |
| case NE: |
| if (TARGET_CMPEQDI_T) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_cmpeqdi_t (operands[1], operands[2])); |
| emit_jump_insn (gen_branch_false (operands[3])); |
| return true; |
| } |
| msw_taken = NE; |
| msw_taken_prob = prob; |
| lsw_taken = NE; |
| lsw_taken_prob = 0; |
| break; |
| case GTU: case GT: |
| msw_taken = comparison; |
| if (CONST_INT_P (op2l) && INTVAL (op2l) == -1) |
| break; |
| if (comparison != GTU || op2h != CONST0_RTX (SImode)) |
| msw_skip = swap_condition (msw_taken); |
| lsw_taken = GTU; |
| break; |
| case GEU: case GE: |
| if (op2l == CONST0_RTX (SImode)) |
| msw_taken = comparison; |
| else |
| { |
| msw_taken = comparison == GE ? GT : GTU; |
| msw_skip = swap_condition (msw_taken); |
| lsw_taken = GEU; |
| } |
| break; |
| case LTU: case LT: |
| msw_taken = comparison; |
| if (op2l == CONST0_RTX (SImode)) |
| break; |
| msw_skip = swap_condition (msw_taken); |
| lsw_taken = LTU; |
| break; |
| case LEU: case LE: |
| if (CONST_INT_P (op2l) && INTVAL (op2l) == -1) |
| msw_taken = comparison; |
| else |
| { |
| lsw_taken = LEU; |
| if (comparison == LE) |
| msw_taken = LT; |
| else if (op2h != CONST0_RTX (SImode)) |
| msw_taken = LTU; |
| else |
| { |
| msw_skip = swap_condition (LTU); |
| break; |
| } |
| msw_skip = swap_condition (msw_taken); |
| } |
| break; |
| default: return false; |
| } |
| num_branches = ((msw_taken != LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE) |
| + (msw_skip != LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE) |
| + (lsw_taken != LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE)); |
| if (comparison != EQ && comparison != NE && num_branches > 1) |
| { |
| if (!CONSTANT_P (operands[2]) |
| && prob >= (int) (REG_BR_PROB_BASE * 3 / 8U) |
| && prob <= (int) (REG_BR_PROB_BASE * 5 / 8U)) |
| { |
| msw_taken_prob = prob / 2U; |
| msw_skip_prob |
| = REG_BR_PROB_BASE * rev_prob / (REG_BR_PROB_BASE + rev_prob); |
| lsw_taken_prob = prob; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| msw_taken_prob = prob; |
| msw_skip_prob = REG_BR_PROB_BASE; |
| /* ??? If we have a constant op2h, should we use that when |
| calculating lsw_taken_prob? */ |
| lsw_taken_prob = prob; |
| } |
| } |
| operands[1] = op1h; |
| operands[2] = op2h; |
| operands[4] = NULL_RTX; |
| if (reload_completed |
| && ! arith_reg_or_0_operand (op2h, SImode) |
| && (true_regnum (op1h) || (comparison != EQ && comparison != NE)) |
| && (msw_taken != LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE |
| || msw_skip != LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE)) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (scratch, operands[2]); |
| operands[2] = scratch; |
| } |
| if (msw_taken != LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE) |
| expand_cbranchsi4 (operands, msw_taken, msw_taken_prob); |
| if (msw_skip != LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE) |
| { |
| rtx taken_label = operands[3]; |
| |
| /* Operands were possibly modified, but msw_skip doesn't expect this. |
| Always use the original ones. */ |
| if (msw_taken != LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE) |
| { |
| operands[1] = op1h; |
| operands[2] = op2h; |
| if (reload_completed |
| && ! arith_reg_or_0_operand (op2h, SImode) |
| && (true_regnum (op1h) || (comparison != EQ && comparison != NE))) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (scratch, operands[2]); |
| operands[2] = scratch; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| operands[3] = skip_label = gen_label_rtx (); |
| expand_cbranchsi4 (operands, msw_skip, msw_skip_prob); |
| operands[3] = taken_label; |
| } |
| operands[1] = op1l; |
| operands[2] = op2l; |
| if (lsw_taken != LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE) |
| { |
| if (reload_completed |
| && ! arith_reg_or_0_operand (op2l, SImode) |
| && (true_regnum (op1l) || (lsw_taken != EQ && lsw_taken != NE))) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (scratch, operands[2]); |
| operands[2] = scratch; |
| } |
| expand_cbranchsi4 (operands, lsw_taken, lsw_taken_prob); |
| } |
| if (msw_skip != LAST_AND_UNUSED_RTX_CODE) |
| emit_label (skip_label); |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* Emit INSN, possibly in a PARALLEL with an USE of fpscr for SH4. */ |
| |
| static void |
| sh_emit_set_t_insn (rtx insn, enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| if ((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A) && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT) |
| { |
| insn = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, |
| gen_rtvec (2, insn, |
| gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, get_fpscr_rtx ()))); |
| (mode == SFmode ? emit_sf_insn : emit_df_insn) (insn); |
| } |
| else |
| emit_insn (insn); |
| } |
| |
| /* Prepare the operands for an scc instruction; make sure that the |
| compare has been done and the result is in T_REG. */ |
| void |
| sh_emit_scc_to_t (enum rtx_code code, rtx op0, rtx op1) |
| { |
| rtx t_reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, T_REG); |
| enum rtx_code oldcode = code; |
| enum machine_mode mode; |
| |
| /* First need a compare insn. */ |
| switch (code) |
| { |
| case NE: |
| /* It isn't possible to handle this case. */ |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| case LT: |
| code = GT; |
| break; |
| case LE: |
| code = GE; |
| break; |
| case LTU: |
| code = GTU; |
| break; |
| case LEU: |
| code = GEU; |
| break; |
| default: |
| break; |
| } |
| if (code != oldcode) |
| { |
| rtx tmp = op0; |
| op0 = op1; |
| op1 = tmp; |
| } |
| |
| mode = GET_MODE (op0); |
| if (mode == VOIDmode) |
| mode = GET_MODE (op1); |
| |
| op0 = force_reg (mode, op0); |
| if ((code != EQ && code != NE |
| && (op1 != const0_rtx |
| || code == GTU || code == GEU || code == LTU || code == LEU)) |
| || (mode == DImode && op1 != const0_rtx) |
| || (TARGET_SH2E && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)) |
| op1 = force_reg (mode, op1); |
| |
| sh_emit_set_t_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, t_reg, |
| gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, SImode, op0, op1)), |
| mode); |
| } |
| |
| rtx |
| sh_emit_cheap_store_flag (enum machine_mode mode, enum rtx_code code, |
| rtx op0, rtx op1) |
| { |
| rtx target = gen_reg_rtx (SImode); |
| rtx tmp; |
| |
| gcc_assert (TARGET_SHMEDIA); |
| switch (code) |
| { |
| case EQ: |
| case GT: |
| case LT: |
| case UNORDERED: |
| case GTU: |
| case LTU: |
| tmp = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, SImode, op0, op1); |
| emit_insn (gen_cstore4_media (target, tmp, op0, op1)); |
| code = NE; |
| break; |
| |
| case NE: |
| case GE: |
| case LE: |
| case ORDERED: |
| case GEU: |
| case LEU: |
| tmp = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (reverse_condition (code), mode, op0, op1); |
| emit_insn (gen_cstore4_media (target, tmp, op0, op1)); |
| code = EQ; |
| break; |
| |
| case UNEQ: |
| case UNGE: |
| case UNGT: |
| case UNLE: |
| case UNLT: |
| case LTGT: |
| return NULL_RTX; |
| |
| default: |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| |
| if (mode == DImode) |
| { |
| rtx t2 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); |
| emit_insn (gen_extendsidi2 (t2, target)); |
| target = t2; |
| } |
| |
| return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, VOIDmode, target, const0_rtx); |
| } |
| |
| /* Called from the md file, set up the operands of a compare instruction. */ |
| |
| void |
| sh_emit_compare_and_branch (rtx *operands, enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (operands[0]); |
| enum rtx_code branch_code; |
| rtx op0 = operands[1]; |
| rtx op1 = operands[2]; |
| rtx insn, tem; |
| bool need_ccmpeq = false; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH2E && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT) |
| { |
| op0 = force_reg (mode, op0); |
| op1 = force_reg (mode, op1); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (code != EQ || mode == DImode) |
| { |
| /* Force args into regs, since we can't use constants here. */ |
| op0 = force_reg (mode, op0); |
| if (op1 != const0_rtx || code == GTU || code == GEU) |
| op1 = force_reg (mode, op1); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT) |
| { |
| if (code == LT |
| || (code == LE && TARGET_IEEE && TARGET_SH2E) |
| || (code == GE && !(TARGET_IEEE && TARGET_SH2E))) |
| { |
| tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem; |
| code = swap_condition (code); |
| } |
| |
| /* GE becomes fcmp/gt+fcmp/eq, for SH2E and TARGET_IEEE only. */ |
| if (code == GE) |
| { |
| gcc_assert (TARGET_IEEE && TARGET_SH2E); |
| need_ccmpeq = true; |
| code = GT; |
| } |
| |
| /* Now we can have EQ, NE, GT, LE. NE and LE are then transformed |
| to EQ/GT respectively. */ |
| gcc_assert (code == EQ || code == GT || code == NE || code == LE); |
| } |
| |
| switch (code) |
| { |
| case EQ: |
| case GT: |
| case GE: |
| case GTU: |
| case GEU: |
| branch_code = code; |
| break; |
| case NE: |
| case LT: |
| case LE: |
| case LTU: |
| case LEU: |
| branch_code = reverse_condition (code); |
| break; |
| default: |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| |
| insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, |
| gen_rtx_REG (SImode, T_REG), |
| gen_rtx_fmt_ee (branch_code, SImode, op0, op1)); |
| |
| sh_emit_set_t_insn (insn, mode); |
| if (need_ccmpeq) |
| sh_emit_set_t_insn (gen_ieee_ccmpeqsf_t (op0, op1), mode); |
| |
| if (branch_code == code) |
| emit_jump_insn (gen_branch_true (operands[3])); |
| else |
| emit_jump_insn (gen_branch_false (operands[3])); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| sh_emit_compare_and_set (rtx *operands, enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (operands[1]); |
| rtx op0 = operands[2]; |
| rtx op1 = operands[3]; |
| rtx lab = NULL_RTX; |
| bool invert = false; |
| rtx tem; |
| |
| op0 = force_reg (mode, op0); |
| if ((code != EQ && code != NE |
| && (op1 != const0_rtx |
| || code == GTU || code == GEU || code == LTU || code == LEU)) |
| || (mode == DImode && op1 != const0_rtx) |
| || (TARGET_SH2E && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)) |
| op1 = force_reg (mode, op1); |
| |
| if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT) |
| { |
| if (code == LT || code == LE) |
| { |
| code = swap_condition (code); |
| tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem; |
| } |
| if (code == GE) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_IEEE) |
| { |
| lab = gen_label_rtx (); |
| sh_emit_scc_to_t (EQ, op0, op1); |
| emit_jump_insn (gen_branch_true (lab)); |
| code = GT; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| code = LT; |
| invert = true; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (code == NE) |
| { |
| code = EQ; |
| invert = true; |
| } |
| |
| sh_emit_scc_to_t (code, op0, op1); |
| if (lab) |
| emit_label (lab); |
| if (invert) |
| emit_insn (gen_movnegt (operands[0])); |
| else |
| emit_move_insn (operands[0], gen_rtx_REG (SImode, T_REG)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Functions to output assembly code. */ |
| |
| /* Return a sequence of instructions to perform DI or DF move. |
| |
| Since the SH cannot move a DI or DF in one instruction, we have |
| to take care when we see overlapping source and dest registers. */ |
| |
| const char * |
| output_movedouble (rtx insn ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx operands[], |
| enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| rtx dst = operands[0]; |
| rtx src = operands[1]; |
| |
| if (MEM_P (dst) |
| && GET_CODE (XEXP (dst, 0)) == PRE_DEC) |
| return "mov.l %T1,%0\n\tmov.l %1,%0"; |
| |
| if (register_operand (dst, mode) |
| && register_operand (src, mode)) |
| { |
| if (REGNO (src) == MACH_REG) |
| return "sts mach,%S0\n\tsts macl,%R0"; |
| |
| /* When mov.d r1,r2 do r2->r3 then r1->r2; |
| when mov.d r1,r0 do r1->r0 then r2->r1. */ |
| |
| if (REGNO (src) + 1 == REGNO (dst)) |
| return "mov %T1,%T0\n\tmov %1,%0"; |
| else |
| return "mov %1,%0\n\tmov %T1,%T0"; |
| } |
| else if (CONST_INT_P (src)) |
| { |
| if (INTVAL (src) < 0) |
| output_asm_insn ("mov #-1,%S0", operands); |
| else |
| output_asm_insn ("mov #0,%S0", operands); |
| |
| return "mov %1,%R0"; |
| } |
| else if (MEM_P (src)) |
| { |
| int ptrreg = -1; |
| int dreg = REGNO (dst); |
| rtx inside = XEXP (src, 0); |
| |
| switch (GET_CODE (inside)) |
| { |
| case REG: |
| ptrreg = REGNO (inside); |
| break; |
| |
| case SUBREG: |
| ptrreg = subreg_regno (inside); |
| break; |
| |
| case PLUS: |
| ptrreg = REGNO (XEXP (inside, 0)); |
| /* ??? A r0+REG address shouldn't be possible here, because it isn't |
| an offsettable address. Unfortunately, offsettable addresses use |
| QImode to check the offset, and a QImode offsettable address |
| requires r0 for the other operand, which is not currently |
| supported, so we can't use the 'o' constraint. |
| Thus we must check for and handle r0+REG addresses here. |
| We punt for now, since this is likely very rare. */ |
| gcc_assert (!REG_P (XEXP (inside, 1))); |
| break; |
| |
| case LABEL_REF: |
| return "mov.l %1,%0\n\tmov.l %1+4,%T0"; |
| case POST_INC: |
| return "mov.l %1,%0\n\tmov.l %1,%T0"; |
| default: |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| |
| /* Work out the safe way to copy. Copy into the second half first. */ |
| if (dreg == ptrreg) |
| return "mov.l %T1,%T0\n\tmov.l %1,%0"; |
| } |
| |
| return "mov.l %1,%0\n\tmov.l %T1,%T0"; |
| } |
| |
| /* Print an instruction which would have gone into a delay slot after |
| another instruction, but couldn't because the other instruction expanded |
| into a sequence where putting the slot insn at the end wouldn't work. */ |
| |
| static void |
| print_slot (rtx insn) |
| { |
| final_scan_insn (XVECEXP (insn, 0, 1), asm_out_file, optimize, 1, NULL); |
| |
| INSN_DELETED_P (XVECEXP (insn, 0, 1)) = 1; |
| } |
| |
| const char * |
| output_far_jump (rtx insn, rtx op) |
| { |
| struct { rtx lab, reg, op; } this_jmp; |
| rtx braf_base_lab = NULL_RTX; |
| const char *jump; |
| int far; |
| int offset = branch_dest (insn) - INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)); |
| rtx prev; |
| |
| this_jmp.lab = gen_label_rtx (); |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH2 |
| && offset >= -32764 |
| && offset - get_attr_length (insn) <= 32766) |
| { |
| far = 0; |
| jump = "mov.w %O0,%1; braf %1"; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| far = 1; |
| if (flag_pic) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SH2) |
| jump = "mov.l %O0,%1; braf %1"; |
| else |
| jump = "mov.l r0,@-r15; mova %O0,r0; mov.l @r0,%1; add r0,%1; mov.l @r15+,r0; jmp @%1"; |
| } |
| else |
| jump = "mov.l %O0,%1; jmp @%1"; |
| } |
| /* If we have a scratch register available, use it. */ |
| if (NONJUMP_INSN_P ((prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn))) |
| && INSN_CODE (prev) == CODE_FOR_indirect_jump_scratch) |
| { |
| this_jmp.reg = SET_DEST (XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0)); |
| if (REGNO (this_jmp.reg) == R0_REG && flag_pic && ! TARGET_SH2) |
| jump = "mov.l r1,@-r15; mova %O0,r0; mov.l @r0,r1; add r1,r0; mov.l @r15+,r1; jmp @%1"; |
| output_asm_insn (jump, &this_jmp.lab); |
| if (dbr_sequence_length ()) |
| print_slot (final_sequence); |
| else |
| output_asm_insn ("nop", 0); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Output the delay slot insn first if any. */ |
| if (dbr_sequence_length ()) |
| print_slot (final_sequence); |
| |
| this_jmp.reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 13); |
| /* We must keep the stack aligned to 8-byte boundaries on SH5. |
| Fortunately, MACL is fixed and call-clobbered, and we never |
| need its value across jumps, so save r13 in it instead of in |
| the stack. */ |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| output_asm_insn ("lds r13, macl", 0); |
| else |
| output_asm_insn ("mov.l r13,@-r15", 0); |
| output_asm_insn (jump, &this_jmp.lab); |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| output_asm_insn ("sts macl, r13", 0); |
| else |
| output_asm_insn ("mov.l @r15+,r13", 0); |
| } |
| if (far && flag_pic && TARGET_SH2) |
| { |
| braf_base_lab = gen_label_rtx (); |
| (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (asm_out_file, "L", |
| CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (braf_base_lab)); |
| } |
| if (far) |
| output_asm_insn (".align 2", 0); |
| (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (asm_out_file, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (this_jmp.lab)); |
| this_jmp.op = op; |
| if (far && flag_pic) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SH2) |
| this_jmp.lab = braf_base_lab; |
| output_asm_insn (".long %O2-%O0", &this_jmp.lab); |
| } |
| else |
| output_asm_insn (far ? ".long %O2" : ".word %O2-%O0", &this_jmp.lab); |
| return ""; |
| } |
| |
| /* Local label counter, used for constants in the pool and inside |
| pattern branches. */ |
| |
| static int lf = 100; |
| |
| /* Output code for ordinary branches. */ |
| |
| const char * |
| output_branch (int logic, rtx insn, rtx *operands) |
| { |
| switch (get_attr_length (insn)) |
| { |
| case 6: |
| /* This can happen if filling the delay slot has caused a forward |
| branch to exceed its range (we could reverse it, but only |
| when we know we won't overextend other branches; this should |
| best be handled by relaxation). |
| It can also happen when other condbranches hoist delay slot insn |
| from their destination, thus leading to code size increase. |
| But the branch will still be in the range -4092..+4098 bytes. */ |
| |
| if (! TARGET_RELAX) |
| { |
| int label = lf++; |
| /* The call to print_slot will clobber the operands. */ |
| rtx op0 = operands[0]; |
| |
| /* If the instruction in the delay slot is annulled (true), then |
| there is no delay slot where we can put it now. The only safe |
| place for it is after the label. final will do that by default. */ |
| |
| if (final_sequence |
| && ! INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 0)) |
| && get_attr_length (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 1))) |
| { |
| asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tb%s%ss\t%LLF%d\n", logic ? "f" : "t", |
| ASSEMBLER_DIALECT ? "/" : ".", label); |
| print_slot (final_sequence); |
| } |
| else |
| asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tb%s\t%LLF%d\n", logic ? "f" : "t", label); |
| |
| output_asm_insn ("bra\t%l0", &op0); |
| fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tnop\n"); |
| (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (asm_out_file, "LF", label); |
| |
| return ""; |
| } |
| /* When relaxing, handle this like a short branch. The linker |
| will fix it up if it still doesn't fit after relaxation. */ |
| case 2: |
| return logic ? "bt%.\t%l0" : "bf%.\t%l0"; |
| |
| /* These are for SH2e, in which we have to account for the |
| extra nop because of the hardware bug in annulled branches. */ |
| case 8: |
| if (! TARGET_RELAX) |
| { |
| int label = lf++; |
| |
| gcc_assert (!final_sequence |
| || !(INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P |
| (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 0)))); |
| asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "b%s%ss\t%LLF%d\n", |
| logic ? "f" : "t", |
| ASSEMBLER_DIALECT ? "/" : ".", label); |
| fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tnop\n"); |
| output_asm_insn ("bra\t%l0", operands); |
| fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tnop\n"); |
| (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (asm_out_file, "LF", label); |
| |
| return ""; |
| } |
| /* When relaxing, fall through. */ |
| case 4: |
| { |
| char buffer[10]; |
| |
| sprintf (buffer, "b%s%ss\t%%l0", |
| logic ? "t" : "f", |
| ASSEMBLER_DIALECT ? "/" : "."); |
| output_asm_insn (buffer, &operands[0]); |
| return "nop"; |
| } |
| |
| default: |
| /* There should be no longer branches now - that would |
| indicate that something has destroyed the branches set |
| up in machine_dependent_reorg. */ |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Output a code sequence for INSN using TEMPL with OPERANDS; but before, |
| fill in operands 9 as a label to the successor insn. |
| We try to use jump threading where possible. |
| IF CODE matches the comparison in the IF_THEN_ELSE of a following jump, |
| we assume the jump is taken. I.e. EQ means follow jmp and bf, NE means |
| follow jmp and bt, if the address is in range. */ |
| const char * |
| output_branchy_insn (enum rtx_code code, const char *templ, |
| rtx insn, rtx *operands) |
| { |
| rtx next_insn = NEXT_INSN (insn); |
| |
| if (next_insn && JUMP_P (next_insn) && condjump_p (next_insn)) |
| { |
| rtx src = SET_SRC (PATTERN (next_insn)); |
| if (GET_CODE (src) == IF_THEN_ELSE && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) != code) |
| { |
| /* Following branch not taken */ |
| operands[9] = gen_label_rtx (); |
| emit_label_after (operands[9], next_insn); |
| INSN_ADDRESSES_NEW (operands[9], |
| INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (next_insn)) |
| + get_attr_length (next_insn)); |
| return templ; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| int offset = (branch_dest (next_insn) |
| - INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (next_insn)) + 4); |
| if (offset >= -252 && offset <= 258) |
| { |
| if (GET_CODE (src) == IF_THEN_ELSE) |
| /* branch_true */ |
| src = XEXP (src, 1); |
| operands[9] = src; |
| return templ; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| operands[9] = gen_label_rtx (); |
| emit_label_after (operands[9], insn); |
| INSN_ADDRESSES_NEW (operands[9], |
| INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)) |
| + get_attr_length (insn)); |
| return templ; |
| } |
| |
| const char * |
| output_ieee_ccmpeq (rtx insn, rtx *operands) |
| { |
| return output_branchy_insn (NE, "bt\t%l9\n\tfcmp/eq\t%1,%0", |
| insn, operands); |
| } |
| |
| /* Output the start of the assembler file. */ |
| |
| static void |
| sh_file_start (void) |
| { |
| default_file_start (); |
| |
| if (TARGET_ELF) |
| /* We need to show the text section with the proper |
| attributes as in TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP, before dwarf2out |
| emits it without attributes in TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP, else GAS |
| will complain. We can teach GAS specifically about the |
| default attributes for our choice of text section, but |
| then we would have to change GAS again if/when we change |
| the text section name. */ |
| fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s\n", TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP); |
| else |
| /* Switch to the data section so that the coffsem symbol |
| isn't in the text section. */ |
| switch_to_section (data_section); |
| |
| if (TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN) |
| fputs ("\t.little\n", asm_out_file); |
| |
| if (!TARGET_ELF) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT) |
| fputs ("\t.mode\tSHcompact\n", asm_out_file); |
| else if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.mode\tSHmedia\n\t.abi\t%i\n", |
| TARGET_SHMEDIA64 ? 64 : 32); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Check if PAT includes UNSPEC_CALLER unspec pattern. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| unspec_caller_rtx_p (rtx pat) |
| { |
| rtx base, offset; |
| int i; |
| |
| split_const (pat, &base, &offset); |
| if (GET_CODE (base) == UNSPEC) |
| { |
| if (XINT (base, 1) == UNSPEC_CALLER) |
| return true; |
| for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (base, 0); i++) |
| if (unspec_caller_rtx_p (XVECEXP (base, 0, i))) |
| return true; |
| } |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* Indicate that INSN cannot be duplicated. This is true for insn |
| that generates a unique label. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_cannot_copy_insn_p (rtx insn) |
| { |
| rtx pat; |
| |
| if (!reload_completed || !flag_pic) |
| return false; |
| |
| if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)) |
| return false; |
| if (asm_noperands (insn) >= 0) |
| return false; |
| |
| pat = PATTERN (insn); |
| if (GET_CODE (pat) != SET) |
| return false; |
| pat = SET_SRC (pat); |
| |
| if (unspec_caller_rtx_p (pat)) |
| return true; |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* Actual number of instructions used to make a shift by N. */ |
| static const char ashiftrt_insns[] = |
| { 0,1,2,3,4,5,8,8,8,8,8,8,8,8,8,8,2,3,4,5,8,8,8,8,8,8,8,8,8,8,8,2}; |
| |
| /* Left shift and logical right shift are the same. */ |
| static const char shift_insns[] = |
| { 0,1,1,2,2,3,3,4,1,2,2,3,3,4,3,3,1,2,2,3,3,4,3,3,2,3,3,4,4,4,3,3}; |
| |
| /* Individual shift amounts needed to get the above length sequences. |
| One bit right shifts clobber the T bit, so when possible, put one bit |
| shifts in the middle of the sequence, so the ends are eligible for |
| branch delay slots. */ |
| static const short shift_amounts[32][5] = { |
| {0}, {1}, {2}, {2, 1}, |
| {2, 2}, {2, 1, 2}, {2, 2, 2}, {2, 2, 1, 2}, |
| {8}, {8, 1}, {8, 2}, {8, 1, 2}, |
| {8, 2, 2}, {8, 2, 1, 2}, {8, -2, 8}, {8, -1, 8}, |
| {16}, {16, 1}, {16, 2}, {16, 1, 2}, |
| {16, 2, 2}, {16, 2, 1, 2}, {16, -2, 8}, {16, -1, 8}, |
| {16, 8}, {16, 1, 8}, {16, 8, 2}, {16, 8, 1, 2}, |
| {16, 8, 2, 2}, {16, -1, -2, 16}, {16, -2, 16}, {16, -1, 16}}; |
| |
| /* Likewise, but for shift amounts < 16, up to three highmost bits |
| might be clobbered. This is typically used when combined with some |
| kind of sign or zero extension. */ |
| |
| static const char ext_shift_insns[] = |
| { 0,1,1,2,2,3,2,2,1,2,2,3,3,3,2,2,1,2,2,3,3,4,3,3,2,3,3,4,4,4,3,3}; |
| |
| static const short ext_shift_amounts[32][4] = { |
| {0}, {1}, {2}, {2, 1}, |
| {2, 2}, {2, 1, 2}, {8, -2}, {8, -1}, |
| {8}, {8, 1}, {8, 2}, {8, 1, 2}, |
| {8, 2, 2}, {16, -2, -1}, {16, -2}, {16, -1}, |
| {16}, {16, 1}, {16, 2}, {16, 1, 2}, |
| {16, 2, 2}, {16, 2, 1, 2}, {16, -2, 8}, {16, -1, 8}, |
| {16, 8}, {16, 1, 8}, {16, 8, 2}, {16, 8, 1, 2}, |
| {16, 8, 2, 2}, {16, -1, -2, 16}, {16, -2, 16}, {16, -1, 16}}; |
| |
| /* Assuming we have a value that has been sign-extended by at least one bit, |
| can we use the ext_shift_amounts with the last shift turned to an arithmetic shift |
| to shift it by N without data loss, and quicker than by other means? */ |
| #define EXT_SHIFT_SIGNED(n) (((n) | 8) == 15) |
| |
| /* This is used in length attributes in sh.md to help compute the length |
| of arbitrary constant shift instructions. */ |
| |
| int |
| shift_insns_rtx (rtx insn) |
| { |
| rtx set_src = SET_SRC (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)); |
| int shift_count = INTVAL (XEXP (set_src, 1)) & 31; |
| enum rtx_code shift_code = GET_CODE (set_src); |
| |
| switch (shift_code) |
| { |
| case ASHIFTRT: |
| return ashiftrt_insns[shift_count]; |
| case LSHIFTRT: |
| case ASHIFT: |
| return shift_insns[shift_count]; |
| default: |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Return the cost of a shift. */ |
| |
| static inline int |
| shiftcosts (rtx x) |
| { |
| int value; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| return 1; |
| |
| if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) > UNITS_PER_WORD) |
| { |
| if (GET_MODE (x) == DImode |
| && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1)) |
| && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == 1) |
| return 2; |
| |
| /* Everything else is invalid, because there is no pattern for it. */ |
| return MAX_COST; |
| } |
| /* If shift by a non constant, then this will be expensive. */ |
| if (!CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1))) |
| return SH_DYNAMIC_SHIFT_COST; |
| |
| /* Otherwise, return the true cost in instructions. Cope with out of range |
| shift counts more or less arbitrarily. */ |
| value = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) & 31; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFTRT) |
| { |
| int cost = ashiftrt_insns[value]; |
| /* If SH3, then we put the constant in a reg and use shad. */ |
| if (cost > 1 + SH_DYNAMIC_SHIFT_COST) |
| cost = 1 + SH_DYNAMIC_SHIFT_COST; |
| return cost; |
| } |
| else |
| return shift_insns[value]; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return the cost of an AND operation. */ |
| |
| static inline int |
| andcosts (rtx x) |
| { |
| int i; |
| |
| /* Anding with a register is a single cycle and instruction. */ |
| if (!CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1))) |
| return 1; |
| |
| i = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)); |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| if (satisfies_constraint_I10 (XEXP (x, 1)) |
| || satisfies_constraint_J16 (XEXP (x, 1))) |
| return 1; |
| else |
| return 1 + rtx_cost (XEXP (x, 1), AND, !optimize_size); |
| } |
| |
| /* These constants are single cycle extu.[bw] instructions. */ |
| if (i == 0xff || i == 0xffff) |
| return 1; |
| /* Constants that can be used in an and immediate instruction in a single |
| cycle, but this requires r0, so make it a little more expensive. */ |
| if (CONST_OK_FOR_K08 (i)) |
| return 2; |
| /* Constants that can be loaded with a mov immediate and an and. |
| This case is probably unnecessary. */ |
| if (CONST_OK_FOR_I08 (i)) |
| return 2; |
| /* Any other constants requires a 2 cycle pc-relative load plus an and. |
| This case is probably unnecessary. */ |
| return 3; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return the cost of an addition or a subtraction. */ |
| |
| static inline int |
| addsubcosts (rtx x) |
| { |
| /* Adding a register is a single cycle insn. */ |
| if (REG_P (XEXP (x, 1)) |
| || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == SUBREG) |
| return 1; |
| |
| /* Likewise for small constants. */ |
| if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1)) |
| && CONST_OK_FOR_ADD (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)))) |
| return 1; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1))) |
| { |
| case CONST: |
| case LABEL_REF: |
| case SYMBOL_REF: |
| return TARGET_SHMEDIA64 ? 5 : 3; |
| |
| case CONST_INT: |
| if (CONST_OK_FOR_I16 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)))) |
| return 2; |
| else if (CONST_OK_FOR_I16 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >> 16)) |
| return 3; |
| else if (CONST_OK_FOR_I16 ((INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >> 16) >> 16)) |
| return 4; |
| |
| /* Fall through. */ |
| default: |
| return 5; |
| } |
| |
| /* Any other constant requires a 2 cycle pc-relative load plus an |
| addition. */ |
| return 3; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return the cost of a multiply. */ |
| static inline int |
| multcosts (rtx x ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| if (sh_multcost >= 0) |
| return sh_multcost; |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| /* ??? We have a mul insn, but it has a latency of three, and doesn't |
| accept constants. Ideally, we would use a cost of one or two and |
| add the cost of the operand, but disregard the latter when inside loops |
| and loop invariant code motion is still to follow. |
| Using a multiply first and splitting it later if it's a loss |
| doesn't work because of different sign / zero extension semantics |
| of multiplies vs. shifts. */ |
| return optimize_size ? 2 : 3; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH2) |
| { |
| /* We have a mul insn, so we can never take more than the mul and the |
| read of the mac reg, but count more because of the latency and extra |
| reg usage. */ |
| if (optimize_size) |
| return 2; |
| return 3; |
| } |
| |
| /* If we're aiming at small code, then just count the number of |
| insns in a multiply call sequence. */ |
| if (optimize_size) |
| return 5; |
| |
| /* Otherwise count all the insns in the routine we'd be calling too. */ |
| return 20; |
| } |
| |
| /* Compute a (partial) cost for rtx X. Return true if the complete |
| cost has been computed, and false if subexpressions should be |
| scanned. In either case, *TOTAL contains the cost result. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int *total, |
| bool speed ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| switch (code) |
| { |
| case CONST_INT: |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| if (INTVAL (x) == 0) |
| *total = 0; |
| else if (outer_code == AND && and_operand ((x), DImode)) |
| *total = 0; |
| else if ((outer_code == IOR || outer_code == XOR |
| || outer_code == PLUS) |
| && CONST_OK_FOR_I10 (INTVAL (x))) |
| *total = 0; |
| else if (CONST_OK_FOR_I16 (INTVAL (x))) |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (outer_code != SET); |
| else if (CONST_OK_FOR_I16 (INTVAL (x) >> 16)) |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS ((outer_code != SET) + 1); |
| else if (CONST_OK_FOR_I16 ((INTVAL (x) >> 16) >> 16)) |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS ((outer_code != SET) + 2); |
| else |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS ((outer_code != SET) + 3); |
| return true; |
| } |
| if (CONST_OK_FOR_I08 (INTVAL (x))) |
| *total = 0; |
| else if ((outer_code == AND || outer_code == IOR || outer_code == XOR) |
| && CONST_OK_FOR_K08 (INTVAL (x))) |
| *total = 1; |
| /* prepare_cmp_insn will force costly constants int registers before |
| the cbranch[sd]i4 patterns can see them, so preserve potentially |
| interesting ones not covered by I08 above. */ |
| else if (outer_code == COMPARE |
| && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (x) |
| == (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0x7fffffff + 1 |
| || INTVAL (x) == 0x7fffffff |
| || INTVAL (x) == 0x80 || INTVAL (x) == -0x81)) |
| *total = 1; |
| else |
| *total = 8; |
| return true; |
| |
| case CONST: |
| case LABEL_REF: |
| case SYMBOL_REF: |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA64) |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4); |
| else if (TARGET_SHMEDIA32) |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2); |
| else |
| *total = 5; |
| return true; |
| |
| case CONST_DOUBLE: |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4); |
| /* prepare_cmp_insn will force costly constants int registers before |
| the cbranchdi4 pattern can see them, so preserve potentially |
| interesting ones. */ |
| else if (outer_code == COMPARE && GET_MODE (x) == DImode) |
| *total = 1; |
| else |
| *total = 10; |
| return true; |
| case CONST_VECTOR: |
| if (x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x))) |
| *total = 0; |
| else if (sh_1el_vec (x, VOIDmode)) |
| *total = outer_code != SET; |
| if (sh_rep_vec (x, VOIDmode)) |
| *total = ((GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) + 3) / 4 |
| + (outer_code != SET)); |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3) + (outer_code != SET); |
| return true; |
| |
| case PLUS: |
| case MINUS: |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (addsubcosts (x)); |
| return true; |
| |
| case AND: |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (andcosts (x)); |
| return true; |
| |
| case MULT: |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (multcosts (x)); |
| return true; |
| |
| case ASHIFT: |
| case ASHIFTRT: |
| case LSHIFTRT: |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (shiftcosts (x)); |
| return true; |
| |
| case DIV: |
| case UDIV: |
| case MOD: |
| case UMOD: |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (20); |
| return true; |
| |
| case PARALLEL: |
| if (sh_1el_vec (x, VOIDmode)) |
| *total = outer_code != SET; |
| if (sh_rep_vec (x, VOIDmode)) |
| *total = ((GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) + 3) / 4 |
| + (outer_code != SET)); |
| *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3) + (outer_code != SET); |
| return true; |
| |
| case FLOAT: |
| case FIX: |
| *total = 100; |
| return true; |
| |
| default: |
| return false; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Compute the cost of an address. For the SH, all valid addresses are |
| the same cost. Use a slightly higher cost for reg + reg addressing, |
| since it increases pressure on r0. */ |
| |
| static int |
| sh_address_cost (rtx X, |
| bool speed ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| return (GET_CODE (X) == PLUS |
| && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (X, 1)) |
| && ! TARGET_SHMEDIA ? 1 : 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* Code to expand a shift. */ |
| |
| void |
| gen_ashift (int type, int n, rtx reg) |
| { |
| /* Negative values here come from the shift_amounts array. */ |
| if (n < 0) |
| { |
| if (type == ASHIFT) |
| type = LSHIFTRT; |
| else |
| type = ASHIFT; |
| n = -n; |
| } |
| |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| case ASHIFTRT: |
| emit_insn (gen_ashrsi3_k (reg, reg, GEN_INT (n))); |
| break; |
| case LSHIFTRT: |
| if (n == 1) |
| emit_insn (gen_lshrsi3_m (reg, reg, GEN_INT (n))); |
| else |
| emit_insn (gen_lshrsi3_k (reg, reg, GEN_INT (n))); |
| break; |
| case ASHIFT: |
| emit_insn (gen_ashlsi3_std (reg, reg, GEN_INT (n))); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Same for HImode */ |
| |
| void |
| gen_ashift_hi (int type, int n, rtx reg) |
| { |
| /* Negative values here come from the shift_amounts array. */ |
| if (n < 0) |
| { |
| if (type == ASHIFT) |
| type = LSHIFTRT; |
| else |
| type = ASHIFT; |
| n = -n; |
| } |
| |
| switch (type) |
| { |
| case ASHIFTRT: |
| case LSHIFTRT: |
| /* We don't have HImode right shift operations because using the |
| ordinary 32 bit shift instructions for that doesn't generate proper |
| zero/sign extension. |
| gen_ashift_hi is only called in contexts where we know that the |
| sign extension works out correctly. */ |
| { |
| int offset = 0; |
| if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG) |
| { |
| offset = SUBREG_BYTE (reg); |
| reg = SUBREG_REG (reg); |
| } |
| gen_ashift (type, n, gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, reg, offset)); |
| break; |
| } |
| case ASHIFT: |
| emit_insn (gen_ashlhi3_k (reg, reg, GEN_INT (n))); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Output RTL to split a constant shift into its component SH constant |
| shift instructions. */ |
| |
| void |
| gen_shifty_op (int code, rtx *operands) |
| { |
| int value = INTVAL (operands[2]); |
| int max, i; |
| |
| /* Truncate the shift count in case it is out of bounds. */ |
| value = value & 31; |
| |
| if (value == 31) |
| { |
| if (code == LSHIFTRT) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_rotlsi3_1 (operands[0], operands[0])); |
| emit_insn (gen_movt (operands[0])); |
| return; |
| } |
| else if (code == ASHIFT) |
| { |
| /* There is a two instruction sequence for 31 bit left shifts, |
| but it requires r0. */ |
| if (REG_P (operands[0]) && REGNO (operands[0]) == 0) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_andsi3 (operands[0], operands[0], const1_rtx)); |
| emit_insn (gen_rotlsi3_31 (operands[0], operands[0])); |
| return; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| else if (value == 0) |
| { |
| /* This can happen even when optimizing, if there were subregs before |
| reload. Don't output a nop here, as this is never optimized away; |
| use a no-op move instead. */ |
| emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, operands[0], operands[0])); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| max = shift_insns[value]; |
| for (i = 0; i < max; i++) |
| gen_ashift (code, shift_amounts[value][i], operands[0]); |
| } |
| |
| /* Same as above, but optimized for values where the topmost bits don't |
| matter. */ |
| |
| void |
| gen_shifty_hi_op (int code, rtx *operands) |
| { |
| int value = INTVAL (operands[2]); |
| int max, i; |
| void (*gen_fun) (int, int, rtx); |
| |
| /* This operation is used by and_shl for SImode values with a few |
| high bits known to be cleared. */ |
| value &= 31; |
| if (value == 0) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_nop ()); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| gen_fun = GET_MODE (operands[0]) == HImode ? gen_ashift_hi : gen_ashift; |
| if (code == ASHIFT) |
| { |
| max = ext_shift_insns[value]; |
| for (i = 0; i < max; i++) |
| gen_fun (code, ext_shift_amounts[value][i], operands[0]); |
| } |
| else |
| /* When shifting right, emit the shifts in reverse order, so that |
| solitary negative values come first. */ |
| for (i = ext_shift_insns[value] - 1; i >= 0; i--) |
| gen_fun (code, ext_shift_amounts[value][i], operands[0]); |
| } |
| |
| /* Output RTL for an arithmetic right shift. */ |
| |
| /* ??? Rewrite to use super-optimizer sequences. */ |
| |
| int |
| expand_ashiftrt (rtx *operands) |
| { |
| rtx wrk; |
| char func[18]; |
| int value; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH3) |
| { |
| if (!CONST_INT_P (operands[2])) |
| { |
| rtx count = copy_to_mode_reg (SImode, operands[2]); |
| emit_insn (gen_negsi2 (count, count)); |
| emit_insn (gen_ashrsi3_d (operands[0], operands[1], count)); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| else if (ashiftrt_insns[INTVAL (operands[2]) & 31] |
| > 1 + SH_DYNAMIC_SHIFT_COST) |
| { |
| rtx count |
| = force_reg (SImode, GEN_INT (- (INTVAL (operands[2]) & 31))); |
| emit_insn (gen_ashrsi3_d (operands[0], operands[1], count)); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| } |
| if (!CONST_INT_P (operands[2])) |
| return 0; |
| |
| value = INTVAL (operands[2]) & 31; |
| |
| if (value == 31) |
| { |
| /* If we are called from abs expansion, arrange things so that we |
| we can use a single MT instruction that doesn't clobber the source, |
| if LICM can hoist out the load of the constant zero. */ |
| if (currently_expanding_to_rtl) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_cmpgtsi_t (force_reg (SImode, CONST0_RTX (SImode)), |
| operands[1])); |
| emit_insn (gen_mov_neg_si_t (operands[0])); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| emit_insn (gen_ashrsi2_31 (operands[0], operands[1])); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| else if (value >= 16 && value <= 19) |
| { |
| wrk = gen_reg_rtx (SImode); |
| emit_insn (gen_ashrsi2_16 (wrk, operands[1])); |
| value -= 16; |
| while (value--) |
| gen_ashift (ASHIFTRT, 1, wrk); |
| emit_move_insn (operands[0], wrk); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| /* Expand a short sequence inline, longer call a magic routine. */ |
| else if (value <= 5) |
| { |
| wrk = gen_reg_rtx (SImode); |
| emit_move_insn (wrk, operands[1]); |
| while (value--) |
| gen_ashift (ASHIFTRT, 1, wrk); |
| emit_move_insn (operands[0], wrk); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| wrk = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| |
| /* Load the value into an arg reg and call a helper. */ |
| emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 4), operands[1]); |
| sprintf (func, "__ashiftrt_r4_%d", value); |
| function_symbol (wrk, func, SFUNC_STATIC); |
| emit_insn (gen_ashrsi3_n (GEN_INT (value), wrk)); |
| emit_move_insn (operands[0], gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 4)); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| sh_dynamicalize_shift_p (rtx count) |
| { |
| return shift_insns[INTVAL (count) & 31] > 1 + SH_DYNAMIC_SHIFT_COST; |
| } |
| |
| /* Try to find a good way to implement the combiner pattern |
| [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "r") |
| (and:SI (ashift:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r") |
| (match_operand:SI 2 "const_int_operand" "n")) |
| (match_operand:SI 3 "const_int_operand" "n"))) . |
| LEFT_RTX is operand 2 in the above pattern, and MASK_RTX is operand 3. |
| return 0 for simple right / left or left/right shift combination. |
| return 1 for a combination of shifts with zero_extend. |
| return 2 for a combination of shifts with an AND that needs r0. |
| return 3 for a combination of shifts with an AND that needs an extra |
| scratch register, when the three highmost bits of the AND mask are clear. |
| return 4 for a combination of shifts with an AND that needs an extra |
| scratch register, when any of the three highmost bits of the AND mask |
| is set. |
| If ATTRP is set, store an initial right shift width in ATTRP[0], |
| and the instruction length in ATTRP[1] . These values are not valid |
| when returning 0. |
| When ATTRP is set and returning 1, ATTRP[2] gets set to the index into |
| shift_amounts for the last shift value that is to be used before the |
| sign extend. */ |
| int |
| shl_and_kind (rtx left_rtx, rtx mask_rtx, int *attrp) |
| { |
| unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask, lsb, mask2, lsb2; |
| int left = INTVAL (left_rtx), right; |
| int best = 0; |
| int cost, best_cost = 10000; |
| int best_right = 0, best_len = 0; |
| int i; |
| int can_ext; |
| |
| if (left < 0 || left > 31) |
| return 0; |
| if (CONST_INT_P (mask_rtx)) |
| mask = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (mask_rtx) >> left; |
| else |
| mask = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_MASK (SImode) >> left; |
| /* Can this be expressed as a right shift / left shift pair? */ |
| lsb = ((mask ^ (mask - 1)) >> 1) + 1; |
| right = exact_log2 (lsb); |
| mask2 = ~(mask + lsb - 1); |
| lsb2 = ((mask2 ^ (mask2 - 1)) >> 1) + 1; |
| /* mask has no zeroes but trailing zeroes <==> ! mask2 */ |
| if (! mask2) |
| best_cost = shift_insns[right] + shift_insns[right + left]; |
| /* mask has no trailing zeroes <==> ! right */ |
| else if (! right && mask2 == ~(lsb2 - 1)) |
| { |
| int late_right = exact_log2 (lsb2); |
| best_cost = shift_insns[left + late_right] + shift_insns[late_right]; |
| } |
| /* Try to use zero extend. */ |
| if (mask2 == ~(lsb2 - 1)) |
| { |
| int width, first; |
| |
| for (width = 8; width <= 16; width += 8) |
| { |
| /* Can we zero-extend right away? */ |
| if (lsb2 == (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) |
| { |
| cost |
| = 1 + ext_shift_insns[right] + ext_shift_insns[left + right]; |
| if (cost < best_cost) |
| { |
| best = 1; |
| best_cost = cost; |
| best_right = right; |
| best_len = cost; |
| if (attrp) |
| attrp[2] = -1; |
| } |
| continue; |
| } |
| /* ??? Could try to put zero extend into initial right shift, |
| or even shift a bit left before the right shift. */ |
| /* Determine value of first part of left shift, to get to the |
| zero extend cut-off point. */ |
| first = width - exact_log2 (lsb2) + right; |
| if (first >= 0 && right + left - first >= 0) |
| { |
| cost = ext_shift_insns[right] + ext_shift_insns[first] + 1 |
| + ext_shift_insns[right + left - first]; |
| if (cost < best_cost) |
| { |
| best = 1; |
| best_cost = cost; |
| best_right = right; |
| best_len = cost; |
| if (attrp) |
| attrp[2] = first; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| /* Try to use r0 AND pattern */ |
| for (i = 0; i <= 2; i++) |
| { |
| if (i > right) |
| break; |
| if (! CONST_OK_FOR_K08 (mask >> i)) |
| continue; |
| cost = (i != 0) + 2 + ext_shift_insns[left + i]; |
| if (cost < best_cost) |
| { |
| best = 2; |
| best_cost = cost; |
| best_right = i; |
| best_len = cost - 1; |
| } |
| } |
| /* Try to use a scratch register to hold the AND operand. */ |
| can_ext = ((mask << left) & ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 3 << 30)) == 0; |
| for (i = 0; i <= 2; i++) |
| { |
| if (i > right) |
| break; |
| cost = (i != 0) + (CONST_OK_FOR_I08 (mask >> i) ? 2 : 3) |
| + (can_ext ? ext_shift_insns : shift_insns)[left + i]; |
| if (cost < best_cost) |
| { |
| best = 4 - can_ext; |
| best_cost = cost; |
| best_right = i; |
| best_len = cost - 1 - ! CONST_OK_FOR_I08 (mask >> i); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (attrp) |
| { |
| attrp[0] = best_right; |
| attrp[1] = best_len; |
| } |
| return best; |
| } |
| |
| /* This is used in length attributes of the unnamed instructions |
| corresponding to shl_and_kind return values of 1 and 2. */ |
| int |
| shl_and_length (rtx insn) |
| { |
| rtx set_src, left_rtx, mask_rtx; |
| int attributes[3]; |
| |
| set_src = SET_SRC (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)); |
| left_rtx = XEXP (XEXP (set_src, 0), 1); |
| mask_rtx = XEXP (set_src, 1); |
| shl_and_kind (left_rtx, mask_rtx, attributes); |
| return attributes[1]; |
| } |
| |
| /* This is used in length attribute of the and_shl_scratch instruction. */ |
| |
| int |
| shl_and_scr_length (rtx insn) |
| { |
| rtx set_src = SET_SRC (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)); |
| int len = shift_insns[INTVAL (XEXP (set_src, 1)) & 31]; |
| rtx op = XEXP (set_src, 0); |
| len += shift_insns[INTVAL (XEXP (op, 1)) & 31] + 1; |
| op = XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0); |
| return len + shift_insns[INTVAL (XEXP (op, 1)) & 31]; |
| } |
| |
| /* Generate rtl for instructions for which shl_and_kind advised a particular |
| method of generating them, i.e. returned zero. */ |
| |
| int |
| gen_shl_and (rtx dest, rtx left_rtx, rtx mask_rtx, rtx source) |
| { |
| int attributes[3]; |
| unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask; |
| int kind = shl_and_kind (left_rtx, mask_rtx, attributes); |
| int right, total_shift; |
| void (*shift_gen_fun) (int, rtx *) = gen_shifty_hi_op; |
| |
| right = attributes[0]; |
| total_shift = INTVAL (left_rtx) + right; |
| mask = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (mask_rtx) >> total_shift; |
| switch (kind) |
| { |
| default: |
| return -1; |
| case 1: |
| { |
| int first = attributes[2]; |
| rtx operands[3]; |
| |
| if (first < 0) |
| { |
| emit_insn ((mask << right) <= 0xff |
| ? gen_zero_extendqisi2 (dest, |
| gen_lowpart (QImode, source)) |
| : gen_zero_extendhisi2 (dest, |
| gen_lowpart (HImode, source))); |
| source = dest; |
| } |
| if (source != dest) |
| emit_insn (gen_movsi (dest, source)); |
| operands[0] = dest; |
| if (right) |
| { |
| operands[2] = GEN_INT (right); |
| gen_shifty_hi_op (LSHIFTRT, operands); |
| } |
| if (first > 0) |
| { |
| operands[2] = GEN_INT (first); |
| gen_shifty_hi_op (ASHIFT, operands); |
| total_shift -= first; |
| mask <<= first; |
| } |
| if (first >= 0) |
| emit_insn (mask <= 0xff |
| ? gen_zero_extendqisi2 (dest, gen_lowpart (QImode, dest)) |
| : gen_zero_extendhisi2 (dest, gen_lowpart (HImode, dest))); |
| if (total_shift > 0) |
| { |
| operands[2] = GEN_INT (total_shift); |
| gen_shifty_hi_op (ASHIFT, operands); |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| case 4: |
| shift_gen_fun = gen_shifty_op; |
| case 3: |
| /* If the topmost bit that matters is set, set the topmost bits |
| that don't matter. This way, we might be able to get a shorter |
| signed constant. */ |
| if (mask & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (31 - total_shift))) |
| mask |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) ~0 << (31 - total_shift); |
| case 2: |
| /* Don't expand fine-grained when combining, because that will |
| make the pattern fail. */ |
| if (currently_expanding_to_rtl |
| || reload_in_progress || reload_completed) |
| { |
| rtx operands[3]; |
| |
| /* Cases 3 and 4 should be handled by this split |
| only while combining */ |
| gcc_assert (kind <= 2); |
| if (right) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_lshrsi3 (dest, source, GEN_INT (right))); |
| source = dest; |
| } |
| emit_insn (gen_andsi3 (dest, source, GEN_INT (mask))); |
| if (total_shift) |
| { |
| operands[0] = dest; |
| operands[1] = dest; |
| operands[2] = GEN_INT (total_shift); |
| shift_gen_fun (ASHIFT, operands); |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| int neg = 0; |
| if (kind != 4 && total_shift < 16) |
| { |
| neg = -ext_shift_amounts[total_shift][1]; |
| if (neg > 0) |
| neg -= ext_shift_amounts[total_shift][2]; |
| else |
| neg = 0; |
| } |
| emit_insn (gen_and_shl_scratch (dest, source, |
| GEN_INT (right), |
| GEN_INT (mask), |
| GEN_INT (total_shift + neg), |
| GEN_INT (neg))); |
| emit_insn (gen_movsi (dest, dest)); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Try to find a good way to implement the combiner pattern |
| [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r") |
| (sign_extract:SI (ashift:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r") |
| (match_operand:SI 2 "const_int_operand" "n") |
| (match_operand:SI 3 "const_int_operand" "n") |
| (const_int 0))) |
| (clobber (reg:SI T_REG))] |
| LEFT_RTX is operand 2 in the above pattern, and SIZE_RTX is operand 3. |
| return 0 for simple left / right shift combination. |
| return 1 for left shift / 8 bit sign extend / left shift. |
| return 2 for left shift / 16 bit sign extend / left shift. |
| return 3 for left shift / 8 bit sign extend / shift / sign extend. |
| return 4 for left shift / 16 bit sign extend / shift / sign extend. |
| return 5 for left shift / 16 bit sign extend / right shift |
| return 6 for < 8 bit sign extend / left shift. |
| return 7 for < 8 bit sign extend / left shift / single right shift. |
| If COSTP is nonzero, assign the calculated cost to *COSTP. */ |
| |
| int |
| shl_sext_kind (rtx left_rtx, rtx size_rtx, int *costp) |
| { |
| int left, size, insize, ext; |
| int cost = 0, best_cost; |
| int kind; |
| |
| left = INTVAL (left_rtx); |
| size = INTVAL (size_rtx); |
| insize = size - left; |
| gcc_assert (insize > 0); |
| /* Default to left / right shift. */ |
| kind = 0; |
| best_cost = shift_insns[32 - insize] + ashiftrt_insns[32 - size]; |
| if (size <= 16) |
| { |
| /* 16 bit shift / sign extend / 16 bit shift */ |
| cost = shift_insns[16 - insize] + 1 + ashiftrt_insns[16 - size]; |
| /* If ashiftrt_insns[16 - size] is 8, this choice will be overridden |
| below, by alternative 3 or something even better. */ |
| if (cost < best_cost) |
| { |
| kind = 5; |
| best_cost = cost; |
| } |
| } |
| /* Try a plain sign extend between two shifts. */ |
| for (ext = 16; ext >= insize; ext -= 8) |
| { |
| if (ext <= size) |
| { |
| cost = ext_shift_insns[ext - insize] + 1 + shift_insns[size - ext]; |
| if (cost < best_cost) |
| { |
| kind = ext / (unsigned) 8; |
| best_cost = cost; |
| } |
| } |
| /* Check if we can do a sloppy shift with a final signed shift |
| restoring the sign. */ |
| if (EXT_SHIFT_SIGNED (size - ext)) |
| cost = ext_shift_insns[ext - insize] + ext_shift_insns[size - ext] + 1; |
| /* If not, maybe it's still cheaper to do the second shift sloppy, |
| and do a final sign extend? */ |
| else if (size <= 16) |
| cost = ext_shift_insns[ext - insize] + 1 |
| + ext_shift_insns[size > ext ? size - ext : ext - size] + 1; |
| else |
| continue; |
| if (cost < best_cost) |
| { |
| kind = ext / (unsigned) 8 + 2; |
| best_cost = cost; |
| } |
| } |
| /* Check if we can sign extend in r0 */ |
| if (insize < 8) |
| { |
| cost = 3 + shift_insns[left]; |
| if (cost < best_cost) |
| { |
| kind = 6; |
| best_cost = cost; |
| } |
| /* Try the same with a final signed shift. */ |
| if (left < 31) |
| { |
| cost = 3 + ext_shift_insns[left + 1] + 1; |
| if (cost < best_cost) |
| { |
| kind = 7; |
| best_cost = cost; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| if (TARGET_SH3) |
| { |
| /* Try to use a dynamic shift. */ |
| cost = shift_insns[32 - insize] + 1 + SH_DYNAMIC_SHIFT_COST; |
| if (cost < best_cost) |
| { |
| kind = 0; |
| best_cost = cost; |
| } |
| } |
| if (costp) |
| *costp = cost; |
| return kind; |
| } |
| |
| /* Function to be used in the length attribute of the instructions |
| implementing this pattern. */ |
| |
| int |
| shl_sext_length (rtx insn) |
| { |
| rtx set_src, left_rtx, size_rtx; |
| int cost; |
| |
| set_src = SET_SRC (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)); |
| left_rtx = XEXP (XEXP (set_src, 0), 1); |
| size_rtx = XEXP (set_src, 1); |
| shl_sext_kind (left_rtx, size_rtx, &cost); |
| return cost; |
| } |
| |
| /* Generate rtl for this pattern */ |
| |
| int |
| gen_shl_sext (rtx dest, rtx left_rtx, rtx size_rtx, rtx source) |
| { |
| int kind; |
| int left, size, insize, cost; |
| rtx operands[3]; |
| |
| kind = shl_sext_kind (left_rtx, size_rtx, &cost); |
| left = INTVAL (left_rtx); |
| size = INTVAL (size_rtx); |
| insize = size - left; |
| switch (kind) |
| { |
| case 1: |
| case 2: |
| case 3: |
| case 4: |
| { |
| int ext = kind & 1 ? 8 : 16; |
| int shift2 = size - ext; |
| |
| /* Don't expand fine-grained when combining, because that will |
| make the pattern fail. */ |
| if (! currently_expanding_to_rtl |
| && ! reload_in_progress && ! reload_completed) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_shl_sext_ext (dest, source, left_rtx, size_rtx)); |
| emit_insn (gen_movsi (dest, source)); |
| break; |
| } |
| if (dest != source) |
| emit_insn (gen_movsi (dest, source)); |
| operands[0] = dest; |
| if (ext - insize) |
| { |
| operands[2] = GEN_INT (ext - insize); |
| gen_shifty_hi_op (ASHIFT, operands); |
| } |
| emit_insn (kind & 1 |
| ? gen_extendqisi2 (dest, gen_lowpart (QImode, dest)) |
| : gen_extendhisi2 (dest, gen_lowpart (HImode, dest))); |
| if (kind <= 2) |
| { |
| if (shift2) |
| { |
| operands[2] = GEN_INT (shift2); |
| gen_shifty_op (ASHIFT, operands); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (shift2 > 0) |
| { |
| if (EXT_SHIFT_SIGNED (shift2)) |
| { |
| operands[2] = GEN_INT (shift2 + 1); |
| gen_shifty_op (ASHIFT, operands); |
| operands[2] = const1_rtx; |
| gen_shifty_op (ASHIFTRT, operands); |
| break; |
| } |
| operands[2] = GEN_INT (shift2); |
| gen_shifty_hi_op (ASHIFT, operands); |
| } |
| else if (shift2) |
| { |
| operands[2] = GEN_INT (-shift2); |
| gen_shifty_hi_op (LSHIFTRT, operands); |
| } |
| emit_insn (size <= 8 |
| ? gen_extendqisi2 (dest, gen_lowpart (QImode, dest)) |
| : gen_extendhisi2 (dest, gen_lowpart (HImode, dest))); |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| case 5: |
| { |
| int i = 16 - size; |
| if (! currently_expanding_to_rtl |
| && ! reload_in_progress && ! reload_completed) |
| emit_insn (gen_shl_sext_ext (dest, source, left_rtx, size_rtx)); |
| else |
| { |
| operands[0] = dest; |
| operands[2] = GEN_INT (16 - insize); |
| gen_shifty_hi_op (ASHIFT, operands); |
| emit_insn (gen_extendhisi2 (dest, gen_lowpart (HImode, dest))); |
| } |
| /* Don't use gen_ashrsi3 because it generates new pseudos. */ |
| while (--i >= 0) |
| gen_ashift (ASHIFTRT, 1, dest); |
| break; |
| } |
| case 6: |
| case 7: |
| /* Don't expand fine-grained when combining, because that will |
| make the pattern fail. */ |
| if (! currently_expanding_to_rtl |
| && ! reload_in_progress && ! reload_completed) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_shl_sext_ext (dest, source, left_rtx, size_rtx)); |
| emit_insn (gen_movsi (dest, source)); |
| break; |
| } |
| emit_insn (gen_andsi3 (dest, source, GEN_INT ((1 << insize) - 1))); |
| emit_insn (gen_xorsi3 (dest, dest, GEN_INT (1 << (insize - 1)))); |
| emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (dest, dest, GEN_INT (-1 << (insize - 1)))); |
| operands[0] = dest; |
| operands[2] = kind == 7 ? GEN_INT (left + 1) : left_rtx; |
| gen_shifty_op (ASHIFT, operands); |
| if (kind == 7) |
| emit_insn (gen_ashrsi3_k (dest, dest, const1_rtx)); |
| break; |
| default: |
| return -1; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Prefix a symbol_ref name with "datalabel". */ |
| |
| rtx |
| gen_datalabel_ref (rtx sym) |
| { |
| const char *str; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (sym) == LABEL_REF) |
| return gen_rtx_CONST (GET_MODE (sym), |
| gen_rtx_UNSPEC (GET_MODE (sym), |
| gen_rtvec (1, sym), |
| UNSPEC_DATALABEL)); |
| |
| gcc_assert (GET_CODE (sym) == SYMBOL_REF); |
| |
| str = XSTR (sym, 0); |
| /* Share all SYMBOL_REF strings with the same value - that is important |
| for cse. */ |
| str = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (get_identifier (str)); |
| XSTR (sym, 0) = str; |
| |
| return sym; |
| } |
| |
| |
| static alloc_pool label_ref_list_pool; |
| |
| typedef struct label_ref_list_d |
| { |
| rtx label; |
| struct label_ref_list_d *next; |
| } *label_ref_list_t; |
| |
| /* The SH cannot load a large constant into a register, constants have to |
| come from a pc relative load. The reference of a pc relative load |
| instruction must be less than 1k in front of the instruction. This |
| means that we often have to dump a constant inside a function, and |
| generate code to branch around it. |
| |
| It is important to minimize this, since the branches will slow things |
| down and make things bigger. |
| |
| Worst case code looks like: |
| |
| mov.l L1,rn |
| bra L2 |
| nop |
| align |
| L1: .long value |
| L2: |
| .. |
| |
| mov.l L3,rn |
| bra L4 |
| nop |
| align |
| L3: .long value |
| L4: |
| .. |
| |
| We fix this by performing a scan before scheduling, which notices which |
| instructions need to have their operands fetched from the constant table |
| and builds the table. |
| |
| The algorithm is: |
| |
| scan, find an instruction which needs a pcrel move. Look forward, find the |
| last barrier which is within MAX_COUNT bytes of the requirement. |
| If there isn't one, make one. Process all the instructions between |
| the find and the barrier. |
| |
| In the above example, we can tell that L3 is within 1k of L1, so |
| the first move can be shrunk from the 3 insn+constant sequence into |
| just 1 insn, and the constant moved to L3 to make: |
| |
| mov.l L1,rn |
| .. |
| mov.l L3,rn |
| bra L4 |
| nop |
| align |
| L3:.long value |
| L4:.long value |
| |
| Then the second move becomes the target for the shortening process. */ |
| |
| typedef struct |
| { |
| rtx value; /* Value in table. */ |
| rtx label; /* Label of value. */ |
| label_ref_list_t wend; /* End of window. */ |
| enum machine_mode mode; /* Mode of value. */ |
| |
| /* True if this constant is accessed as part of a post-increment |
| sequence. Note that HImode constants are never accessed in this way. */ |
| bool part_of_sequence_p; |
| } pool_node; |
| |
| /* The maximum number of constants that can fit into one pool, since |
| constants in the range 0..510 are at least 2 bytes long, and in the |
| range from there to 1018 at least 4 bytes. */ |
| |
| #define MAX_POOL_SIZE 372 |
| static pool_node pool_vector[MAX_POOL_SIZE]; |
| static int pool_size; |
| static rtx pool_window_label; |
| static int pool_window_last; |
| |
| static int max_labelno_before_reorg; |
| |
| /* ??? If we need a constant in HImode which is the truncated value of a |
| constant we need in SImode, we could combine the two entries thus saving |
| two bytes. Is this common enough to be worth the effort of implementing |
| it? */ |
| |
| /* ??? This stuff should be done at the same time that we shorten branches. |
| As it is now, we must assume that all branches are the maximum size, and |
| this causes us to almost always output constant pools sooner than |
| necessary. */ |
| |
| /* Add a constant to the pool and return its label. */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| add_constant (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, rtx last_value) |
| { |
| int i; |
| rtx lab, new_rtx; |
| label_ref_list_t ref, newref; |
| |
| /* First see if we've already got it. */ |
| for (i = 0; i < pool_size; i++) |
| { |
| if (x->code == pool_vector[i].value->code |
| && mode == pool_vector[i].mode) |
| { |
| if (x->code == CODE_LABEL) |
| { |
| if (XINT (x, 3) != XINT (pool_vector[i].value, 3)) |
| continue; |
| } |
| if (rtx_equal_p (x, pool_vector[i].value)) |
| { |
| lab = new_rtx = 0; |
| if (! last_value |
| || ! i |
| || ! rtx_equal_p (last_value, pool_vector[i-1].value)) |
| { |
| new_rtx = gen_label_rtx (); |
| LABEL_REFS (new_rtx) = pool_vector[i].label; |
| pool_vector[i].label = lab = new_rtx; |
| } |
| if (lab && pool_window_label) |
| { |
| newref = (label_ref_list_t) pool_alloc (label_ref_list_pool); |
| newref->label = pool_window_label; |
| ref = pool_vector[pool_window_last].wend; |
| newref->next = ref; |
| pool_vector[pool_window_last].wend = newref; |
| } |
| if (new_rtx) |
| pool_window_label = new_rtx; |
| pool_window_last = i; |
| return lab; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Need a new one. */ |
| pool_vector[pool_size].value = x; |
| if (last_value && rtx_equal_p (last_value, pool_vector[pool_size - 1].value)) |
| { |
| lab = 0; |
| pool_vector[pool_size - 1].part_of_sequence_p = true; |
| } |
| else |
| lab = gen_label_rtx (); |
| pool_vector[pool_size].mode = mode; |
| pool_vector[pool_size].label = lab; |
| pool_vector[pool_size].wend = NULL; |
| pool_vector[pool_size].part_of_sequence_p = (lab == 0); |
| if (lab && pool_window_label) |
| { |
| newref = (label_ref_list_t) pool_alloc (label_ref_list_pool); |
| newref->label = pool_window_label; |
| ref = pool_vector[pool_window_last].wend; |
| newref->next = ref; |
| pool_vector[pool_window_last].wend = newref; |
| } |
| if (lab) |
| pool_window_label = lab; |
| pool_window_last = pool_size; |
| pool_size++; |
| return lab; |
| } |
| |
| /* Output the literal table. START, if nonzero, is the first instruction |
| this table is needed for, and also indicates that there is at least one |
| casesi_worker_2 instruction; We have to emit the operand3 labels from |
| these insns at a 4-byte aligned position. BARRIER is the barrier |
| after which we are to place the table. */ |
| |
| static void |
| dump_table (rtx start, rtx barrier) |
| { |
| rtx scan = barrier; |
| int i; |
| int need_align = 1; |
| rtx lab; |
| label_ref_list_t ref; |
| int have_df = 0; |
| |
| /* Do two passes, first time dump out the HI sized constants. */ |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < pool_size; i++) |
| { |
| pool_node *p = &pool_vector[i]; |
| |
| if (p->mode == HImode) |
| { |
| if (need_align) |
| { |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_align_2 (), scan); |
| need_align = 0; |
| } |
| for (lab = p->label; lab; lab = LABEL_REFS (lab)) |
| scan = emit_label_after (lab, scan); |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_2 (p->value, const0_rtx), |
| scan); |
| for (ref = p->wend; ref; ref = ref->next) |
| { |
| lab = ref->label; |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_window_end (lab), scan); |
| } |
| } |
| else if (p->mode == DFmode) |
| have_df = 1; |
| } |
| |
| need_align = 1; |
| |
| if (start) |
| { |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_align_4 (), scan); |
| need_align = 0; |
| for (; start != barrier; start = NEXT_INSN (start)) |
| if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (start) |
| && recog_memoized (start) == CODE_FOR_casesi_worker_2) |
| { |
| rtx src = SET_SRC (XVECEXP (PATTERN (start), 0, 0)); |
| rtx lab = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 3), 0); |
| |
| scan = emit_label_after (lab, scan); |
| } |
| } |
| if (TARGET_FMOVD && TARGET_ALIGN_DOUBLE && have_df) |
| { |
| rtx align_insn = NULL_RTX; |
| |
| scan = emit_label_after (gen_label_rtx (), scan); |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_align_log (GEN_INT (3)), scan); |
| need_align = 0; |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < pool_size; i++) |
| { |
| pool_node *p = &pool_vector[i]; |
| |
| switch (p->mode) |
| { |
| case HImode: |
| break; |
| case SImode: |
| case SFmode: |
| if (align_insn && !p->part_of_sequence_p) |
| { |
| for (lab = p->label; lab; lab = LABEL_REFS (lab)) |
| emit_label_before (lab, align_insn); |
| emit_insn_before (gen_consttable_4 (p->value, const0_rtx), |
| align_insn); |
| for (ref = p->wend; ref; ref = ref->next) |
| { |
| lab = ref->label; |
| emit_insn_before (gen_consttable_window_end (lab), |
| align_insn); |
| } |
| delete_insn (align_insn); |
| align_insn = NULL_RTX; |
| continue; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| for (lab = p->label; lab; lab = LABEL_REFS (lab)) |
| scan = emit_label_after (lab, scan); |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_4 (p->value, |
| const0_rtx), scan); |
| need_align = ! need_align; |
| } |
| break; |
| case DFmode: |
| if (need_align) |
| { |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_align_log (GEN_INT (3)), scan); |
| align_insn = scan; |
| need_align = 0; |
| } |
| case DImode: |
| for (lab = p->label; lab; lab = LABEL_REFS (lab)) |
| scan = emit_label_after (lab, scan); |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_8 (p->value, const0_rtx), |
| scan); |
| break; |
| default: |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| |
| if (p->mode != HImode) |
| { |
| for (ref = p->wend; ref; ref = ref->next) |
| { |
| lab = ref->label; |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_window_end (lab), |
| scan); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| pool_size = 0; |
| } |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < pool_size; i++) |
| { |
| pool_node *p = &pool_vector[i]; |
| |
| switch (p->mode) |
| { |
| case HImode: |
| break; |
| case SImode: |
| case SFmode: |
| if (need_align) |
| { |
| need_align = 0; |
| scan = emit_label_after (gen_label_rtx (), scan); |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_align_4 (), scan); |
| } |
| for (lab = p->label; lab; lab = LABEL_REFS (lab)) |
| scan = emit_label_after (lab, scan); |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_4 (p->value, const0_rtx), |
| scan); |
| break; |
| case DFmode: |
| case DImode: |
| if (need_align) |
| { |
| need_align = 0; |
| scan = emit_label_after (gen_label_rtx (), scan); |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_align_4 (), scan); |
| } |
| for (lab = p->label; lab; lab = LABEL_REFS (lab)) |
| scan = emit_label_after (lab, scan); |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_8 (p->value, const0_rtx), |
| scan); |
| break; |
| default: |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| |
| if (p->mode != HImode) |
| { |
| for (ref = p->wend; ref; ref = ref->next) |
| { |
| lab = ref->label; |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_window_end (lab), scan); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_end (), scan); |
| scan = emit_barrier_after (scan); |
| pool_size = 0; |
| pool_window_label = NULL_RTX; |
| pool_window_last = 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return nonzero if constant would be an ok source for a |
| mov.w instead of a mov.l. */ |
| |
| static int |
| hi_const (rtx src) |
| { |
| return (CONST_INT_P (src) |
| && INTVAL (src) >= -32768 |
| && INTVAL (src) <= 32767); |
| } |
| |
| #define MOVA_LABELREF(mova) XVECEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (mova)), 0, 0) |
| |
| /* Nonzero if the insn is a move instruction which needs to be fixed. */ |
| |
| /* ??? For a DImode/DFmode moves, we don't need to fix it if each half of the |
| CONST_DOUBLE input value is CONST_OK_FOR_I08. For a SFmode move, we don't |
| need to fix it if the input value is CONST_OK_FOR_I08. */ |
| |
| static int |
| broken_move (rtx insn) |
| { |
| if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)) |
| { |
| rtx pat = PATTERN (insn); |
| if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL) |
| pat = XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0); |
| if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET |
| /* We can load any 8-bit value if we don't care what the high |
| order bits end up as. */ |
| && GET_MODE (SET_DEST (pat)) != QImode |
| && (CONSTANT_P (SET_SRC (pat)) |
| /* Match mova_const. */ |
| || (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (pat)) == UNSPEC |
| && XINT (SET_SRC (pat), 1) == UNSPEC_MOVA |
| && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (SET_SRC (pat), 0, 0)) == CONST)) |
| && ! (TARGET_SH2E |
| && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (pat)) == CONST_DOUBLE |
| && (fp_zero_operand (SET_SRC (pat)) |
| || fp_one_operand (SET_SRC (pat))) |
| /* In general we don't know the current setting of fpscr, so disable fldi. |
| There is an exception if this was a register-register move |
| before reload - and hence it was ascertained that we have |
| single precision setting - and in a post-reload optimization |
| we changed this to do a constant load. In that case |
| we don't have an r0 clobber, hence we must use fldi. */ |
| && (TARGET_FMOVD |
| || (GET_CODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 2), 0)) |
| == SCRATCH)) |
| && REG_P (SET_DEST (pat)) |
| && FP_REGISTER_P (REGNO (SET_DEST (pat)))) |
| && ! (TARGET_SH2A |
| && GET_MODE (SET_DEST (pat)) == SImode |
| && (satisfies_constraint_I20 (SET_SRC (pat)) |
| || satisfies_constraint_I28 (SET_SRC (pat)))) |
| && ! satisfies_constraint_I08 (SET_SRC (pat))) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| mova_p (rtx insn) |
| { |
| return (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET |
| && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn))) == UNSPEC |
| && XINT (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)), 1) == UNSPEC_MOVA |
| /* Don't match mova_const. */ |
| && GET_CODE (MOVA_LABELREF (insn)) == LABEL_REF); |
| } |
| |
| /* Fix up a mova from a switch that went out of range. */ |
| static void |
| fixup_mova (rtx mova) |
| { |
| PUT_MODE (XEXP (MOVA_LABELREF (mova), 0), QImode); |
| if (! flag_pic) |
| { |
| SET_SRC (PATTERN (mova)) = MOVA_LABELREF (mova); |
| INSN_CODE (mova) = -1; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| rtx worker = mova; |
| rtx lab = gen_label_rtx (); |
| rtx wpat, wpat0, wpat1, wsrc, target, base, diff; |
| |
| do |
| { |
| worker = NEXT_INSN (worker); |
| gcc_assert (worker |
| && !LABEL_P (worker) |
| && !JUMP_P (worker)); |
| } while (NOTE_P (worker) |
| || recog_memoized (worker) != CODE_FOR_casesi_worker_1); |
| wpat = PATTERN (worker); |
| wpat0 = XVECEXP (wpat, 0, 0); |
| wpat1 = XVECEXP (wpat, 0, 1); |
| wsrc = SET_SRC (wpat0); |
| PATTERN (worker) = (gen_casesi_worker_2 |
| (SET_DEST (wpat0), XVECEXP (wsrc, 0, 1), |
| XEXP (XVECEXP (wsrc, 0, 2), 0), lab, |
| XEXP (wpat1, 0))); |
| INSN_CODE (worker) = -1; |
| target = XVECEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (mova)), 0, 0); |
| base = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, lab); |
| diff = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (2, target, base), UNSPEC_SYMOFF); |
| SET_SRC (PATTERN (mova)) = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, diff); |
| INSN_CODE (mova) = -1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* NEW_MOVA is a mova we've just encountered while scanning forward. Update |
| *num_mova, and check if the new mova is not nested within the first one. |
| return 0 if *first_mova was replaced, 1 if new_mova was replaced, |
| 2 if new_mova has been assigned to *first_mova, -1 otherwise.. */ |
| static int |
| untangle_mova (int *num_mova, rtx *first_mova, rtx new_mova) |
| { |
| int n_addr = 0; /* Initialization to shut up spurious warning. */ |
| int f_target, n_target = 0; /* Likewise. */ |
| |
| if (optimize) |
| { |
| /* If NEW_MOVA has no address yet, it will be handled later. */ |
| if (INSN_ADDRESSES_SIZE() <= (unsigned) INSN_UID (new_mova)) |
| return -1; |
| |
| n_addr = INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (new_mova)); |
| n_target = INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (XEXP (MOVA_LABELREF (new_mova), 0))); |
| if (n_addr > n_target || n_addr + 1022 < n_target) |
| { |
| /* Change the mova into a load. |
| broken_move will then return true for it. */ |
| fixup_mova (new_mova); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| } |
| if (!(*num_mova)++) |
| { |
| *first_mova = new_mova; |
| return 2; |
| } |
| if (!optimize |
| || ((f_target |
| = INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (XEXP (MOVA_LABELREF (*first_mova), 0)))) |
| >= n_target)) |
| return -1; |
| |
| (*num_mova)--; |
| if (f_target - INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (*first_mova)) |
| > n_target - n_addr) |
| { |
| fixup_mova (*first_mova); |
| return 0; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| fixup_mova (new_mova); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Find the last barrier from insn FROM which is close enough to hold the |
| constant pool. If we can't find one, then create one near the end of |
| the range. */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| find_barrier (int num_mova, rtx mova, rtx from) |
| { |
| int count_si = 0; |
| int count_hi = 0; |
| int found_hi = 0; |
| int found_si = 0; |
| int found_di = 0; |
| int hi_align = 2; |
| int si_align = 2; |
| int leading_mova = num_mova; |
| rtx barrier_before_mova = 0, found_barrier = 0, good_barrier = 0; |
| int si_limit; |
| int hi_limit; |
| rtx orig = from; |
| rtx last_got = NULL_RTX; |
| rtx last_symoff = NULL_RTX; |
| |
| /* For HImode: range is 510, add 4 because pc counts from address of |
| second instruction after this one, subtract 2 for the jump instruction |
| that we may need to emit before the table, subtract 2 for the instruction |
| that fills the jump delay slot (in very rare cases, reorg will take an |
| instruction from after the constant pool or will leave the delay slot |
| empty). This gives 510. |
| For SImode: range is 1020, add 4 because pc counts from address of |
| second instruction after this one, subtract 2 in case pc is 2 byte |
| aligned, subtract 2 for the jump instruction that we may need to emit |
| before the table, subtract 2 for the instruction that fills the jump |
| delay slot. This gives 1018. */ |
| |
| /* The branch will always be shortened now that the reference address for |
| forward branches is the successor address, thus we need no longer make |
| adjustments to the [sh]i_limit for -O0. */ |
| |
| si_limit = 1018; |
| hi_limit = 510; |
| |
| while (from && count_si < si_limit && count_hi < hi_limit) |
| { |
| int inc = get_attr_length (from); |
| int new_align = 1; |
| |
| /* If this is a label that existed at the time of the compute_alignments |
| call, determine the alignment. N.B. When find_barrier recurses for |
| an out-of-reach mova, we might see labels at the start of previously |
| inserted constant tables. */ |
| if (LABEL_P (from) |
| && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (from) <= max_labelno_before_reorg) |
| { |
| if (optimize) |
| new_align = 1 << label_to_alignment (from); |
| else if (BARRIER_P (prev_nonnote_insn (from))) |
| new_align = 1 << barrier_align (from); |
| else |
| new_align = 1; |
| inc = 0; |
| } |
| /* In case we are scanning a constant table because of recursion, check |
| for explicit alignments. If the table is long, we might be forced |
| to emit the new table in front of it; the length of the alignment |
| might be the last straw. */ |
| else if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (from) |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (from)) == UNSPEC_VOLATILE |
| && XINT (PATTERN (from), 1) == UNSPECV_ALIGN) |
| new_align = INTVAL (XVECEXP (PATTERN (from), 0, 0)); |
| /* When we find the end of a constant table, paste the new constant |
| at the end. That is better than putting it in front because |
| this way, we don't need extra alignment for adding a 4-byte-aligned |
| mov(a) label to a 2/4 or 8/4 byte aligned table. */ |
| else if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (from) |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (from)) == UNSPEC_VOLATILE |
| && XINT (PATTERN (from), 1) == UNSPECV_CONST_END) |
| return from; |
| |
| if (BARRIER_P (from)) |
| { |
| rtx next; |
| |
| found_barrier = from; |
| |
| /* If we are at the end of the function, or in front of an alignment |
| instruction, we need not insert an extra alignment. We prefer |
| this kind of barrier. */ |
| if (barrier_align (from) > 2) |
| good_barrier = from; |
| |
| /* If we are at the end of a hot/cold block, dump the constants |
| here. */ |
| next = NEXT_INSN (from); |
| if (next |
| && NOTE_P (next) |
| && NOTE_KIND (next) == NOTE_INSN_SWITCH_TEXT_SECTIONS) |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| if (broken_move (from)) |
| { |
| rtx pat, src, dst; |
| enum machine_mode mode; |
| |
| pat = PATTERN (from); |
| if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL) |
| pat = XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0); |
| src = SET_SRC (pat); |
| dst = SET_DEST (pat); |
| mode = GET_MODE (dst); |
| |
| /* GOT pcrelat setting comes in pair of |
| mova .L8,r0 |
| mov.l .L8,r12 |
| instructions. (plus add r0,r12). |
| Remember if we see one without the other. */ |
| if (GET_CODE (src) == UNSPEC && PIC_ADDR_P (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0))) |
| last_got = last_got ? NULL_RTX : from; |
| else if (PIC_ADDR_P (src)) |
| last_got = last_got ? NULL_RTX : from; |
| |
| /* We must explicitly check the mode, because sometimes the |
| front end will generate code to load unsigned constants into |
| HImode targets without properly sign extending them. */ |
| if (mode == HImode |
| || (mode == SImode && hi_const (src) && REGNO (dst) != FPUL_REG)) |
| { |
| found_hi += 2; |
| /* We put the short constants before the long constants, so |
| we must count the length of short constants in the range |
| for the long constants. */ |
| /* ??? This isn't optimal, but is easy to do. */ |
| si_limit -= 2; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* We dump DF/DI constants before SF/SI ones, because |
| the limit is the same, but the alignment requirements |
| are higher. We may waste up to 4 additional bytes |
| for alignment, and the DF/DI constant may have |
| another SF/SI constant placed before it. */ |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && ! found_di |
| && (mode == DFmode || mode == DImode)) |
| { |
| found_di = 1; |
| si_limit -= 8; |
| } |
| while (si_align > 2 && found_si + si_align - 2 > count_si) |
| si_align >>= 1; |
| if (found_si > count_si) |
| count_si = found_si; |
| found_si += GET_MODE_SIZE (mode); |
| if (num_mova) |
| si_limit -= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (mova_p (from)) |
| { |
| switch (untangle_mova (&num_mova, &mova, from)) |
| { |
| case 1: |
| if (flag_pic) |
| { |
| rtx src = SET_SRC (PATTERN (from)); |
| if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST |
| && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == UNSPEC |
| && XINT (XEXP (src, 0), 1) == UNSPEC_SYMOFF) |
| last_symoff = from; |
| } |
| break; |
| case 0: return find_barrier (0, 0, mova); |
| case 2: |
| { |
| leading_mova = 0; |
| barrier_before_mova |
| = good_barrier ? good_barrier : found_barrier; |
| } |
| default: break; |
| } |
| if (found_si > count_si) |
| count_si = found_si; |
| } |
| else if (JUMP_TABLE_DATA_P (from)) |
| { |
| if ((num_mova > 1 && GET_MODE (prev_nonnote_insn (from)) == VOIDmode) |
| || (num_mova |
| && (prev_nonnote_insn (from) |
| == XEXP (MOVA_LABELREF (mova), 0)))) |
| num_mova--; |
| if (barrier_align (next_real_insn (from)) == align_jumps_log) |
| { |
| /* We have just passed the barrier in front of the |
| ADDR_DIFF_VEC, which is stored in found_barrier. Since |
| the ADDR_DIFF_VEC is accessed as data, just like our pool |
| constants, this is a good opportunity to accommodate what |
| we have gathered so far. |
| If we waited any longer, we could end up at a barrier in |
| front of code, which gives worse cache usage for separated |
| instruction / data caches. */ |
| good_barrier = found_barrier; |
| break; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| rtx body = PATTERN (from); |
| inc = XVECLEN (body, 1) * GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (body)); |
| } |
| } |
| /* For the SH1, we generate alignments even after jumps-around-jumps. */ |
| else if (JUMP_P (from) |
| && ! TARGET_SH2 |
| && ! optimize_size) |
| new_align = 4; |
| |
| /* There is a possibility that a bf is transformed into a bf/s by the |
| delay slot scheduler. */ |
| if (JUMP_P (from) && !JUMP_TABLE_DATA_P (from) |
| && get_attr_type (from) == TYPE_CBRANCH |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (from)))) != SEQUENCE) |
| inc += 2; |
| |
| if (found_si) |
| { |
| count_si += inc; |
| if (new_align > si_align) |
| { |
| si_limit -= (count_si - 1) & (new_align - si_align); |
| si_align = new_align; |
| } |
| count_si = (count_si + new_align - 1) & -new_align; |
| } |
| if (found_hi) |
| { |
| count_hi += inc; |
| if (new_align > hi_align) |
| { |
| hi_limit -= (count_hi - 1) & (new_align - hi_align); |
| hi_align = new_align; |
| } |
| count_hi = (count_hi + new_align - 1) & -new_align; |
| } |
| from = NEXT_INSN (from); |
| } |
| |
| if (num_mova) |
| { |
| if (leading_mova) |
| { |
| /* Try as we might, the leading mova is out of range. Change |
| it into a load (which will become a pcload) and retry. */ |
| fixup_mova (mova); |
| return find_barrier (0, 0, mova); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Insert the constant pool table before the mova instruction, |
| to prevent the mova label reference from going out of range. */ |
| from = mova; |
| good_barrier = found_barrier = barrier_before_mova; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (found_barrier) |
| { |
| if (good_barrier && next_real_insn (found_barrier)) |
| found_barrier = good_barrier; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* We didn't find a barrier in time to dump our stuff, |
| so we'll make one. */ |
| rtx label = gen_label_rtx (); |
| |
| /* Don't emit a constant table in the middle of insns for |
| casesi_worker_2. This is a bit overkill but is enough |
| because casesi_worker_2 wouldn't appear so frequently. */ |
| if (last_symoff) |
| from = last_symoff; |
| |
| /* If we exceeded the range, then we must back up over the last |
| instruction we looked at. Otherwise, we just need to undo the |
| NEXT_INSN at the end of the loop. */ |
| if (PREV_INSN (from) != orig |
| && (count_hi > hi_limit || count_si > si_limit)) |
| from = PREV_INSN (PREV_INSN (from)); |
| else |
| from = PREV_INSN (from); |
| |
| /* Don't emit a constant table int the middle of global pointer setting, |
| since that that would move the addressing base GOT into another table. |
| We need the first mov instruction before the _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ |
| in the pool anyway, so just move up the whole constant pool. */ |
| if (last_got) |
| from = PREV_INSN (last_got); |
| |
| /* Don't insert the constant pool table at the position which |
| may be the landing pad. */ |
| if (flag_exceptions |
| && CALL_P (from) |
| && find_reg_note (from, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX)) |
| from = PREV_INSN (from); |
| |
| /* Walk back to be just before any jump or label. |
| Putting it before a label reduces the number of times the branch |
| around the constant pool table will be hit. Putting it before |
| a jump makes it more likely that the bra delay slot will be |
| filled. */ |
| while (NOTE_P (from) || JUMP_P (from) |
| || LABEL_P (from)) |
| from = PREV_INSN (from); |
| |
| /* Make sure we do not split between a call and its corresponding |
| CALL_ARG_LOCATION note. */ |
| if (CALL_P (from)) |
| { |
| rtx next = NEXT_INSN (from); |
| if (next && NOTE_P (next) |
| && NOTE_KIND (next) == NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION) |
| from = next; |
| } |
| |
| from = emit_jump_insn_after (gen_jump (label), from); |
| JUMP_LABEL (from) = label; |
| LABEL_NUSES (label) = 1; |
| found_barrier = emit_barrier_after (from); |
| emit_label_after (label, found_barrier); |
| } |
| |
| return found_barrier; |
| } |
| |
| /* If the instruction INSN is implemented by a special function, and we can |
| positively find the register that is used to call the sfunc, and this |
| register is not used anywhere else in this instruction - except as the |
| destination of a set, return this register; else, return 0. */ |
| rtx |
| sfunc_uses_reg (rtx insn) |
| { |
| int i; |
| rtx pattern, part, reg_part, reg; |
| |
| if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)) |
| return 0; |
| pattern = PATTERN (insn); |
| if (GET_CODE (pattern) != PARALLEL || get_attr_type (insn) != TYPE_SFUNC) |
| return 0; |
| |
| for (reg_part = 0, i = XVECLEN (pattern, 0) - 1; i >= 1; i--) |
| { |
| part = XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i); |
| if (GET_CODE (part) == USE && GET_MODE (XEXP (part, 0)) == SImode) |
| reg_part = part; |
| } |
| if (! reg_part) |
| return 0; |
| reg = XEXP (reg_part, 0); |
| for (i = XVECLEN (pattern, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--) |
| { |
| part = XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i); |
| if (part == reg_part || GET_CODE (part) == CLOBBER) |
| continue; |
| if (reg_mentioned_p (reg, ((GET_CODE (part) == SET |
| && REG_P (SET_DEST (part))) |
| ? SET_SRC (part) : part))) |
| return 0; |
| } |
| return reg; |
| } |
| |
| /* See if the only way in which INSN uses REG is by calling it, or by |
| setting it while calling it. Set *SET to a SET rtx if the register |
| is set by INSN. */ |
| |
| static int |
| noncall_uses_reg (rtx reg, rtx insn, rtx *set) |
| { |
| rtx pattern, reg2; |
| |
| *set = NULL_RTX; |
| |
| reg2 = sfunc_uses_reg (insn); |
| if (reg2 && REGNO (reg2) == REGNO (reg)) |
| { |
| pattern = single_set (insn); |
| if (pattern |
| && REG_P (SET_DEST (pattern)) |
| && REGNO (reg) == REGNO (SET_DEST (pattern))) |
| *set = pattern; |
| return 0; |
| } |
| if (!CALL_P (insn)) |
| { |
| /* We don't use rtx_equal_p because we don't care if the mode is |
| different. */ |
| pattern = single_set (insn); |
| if (pattern |
| && REG_P (SET_DEST (pattern)) |
| && REGNO (reg) == REGNO (SET_DEST (pattern))) |
| { |
| rtx par, part; |
| int i; |
| |
| *set = pattern; |
| par = PATTERN (insn); |
| if (GET_CODE (par) == PARALLEL) |
| for (i = XVECLEN (par, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--) |
| { |
| part = XVECEXP (par, 0, i); |
| if (GET_CODE (part) != SET && reg_mentioned_p (reg, part)) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| return reg_mentioned_p (reg, SET_SRC (pattern)); |
| } |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| pattern = PATTERN (insn); |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL) |
| { |
| int i; |
| |
| for (i = XVECLEN (pattern, 0) - 1; i >= 1; i--) |
| if (reg_mentioned_p (reg, XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i))) |
| return 1; |
| pattern = XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 0); |
| } |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (pattern) == SET) |
| { |
| if (reg_mentioned_p (reg, SET_DEST (pattern))) |
| { |
| /* We don't use rtx_equal_p, because we don't care if the |
| mode is different. */ |
| if (!REG_P (SET_DEST (pattern)) |
| || REGNO (reg) != REGNO (SET_DEST (pattern))) |
| return 1; |
| |
| *set = pattern; |
| } |
| |
| pattern = SET_SRC (pattern); |
| } |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (pattern) != CALL |
| || !MEM_P (XEXP (pattern, 0)) |
| || ! rtx_equal_p (reg, XEXP (XEXP (pattern, 0), 0))) |
| return 1; |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Given a X, a pattern of an insn or a part of it, return a mask of used |
| general registers. Bits 0..15 mean that the respective registers |
| are used as inputs in the instruction. Bits 16..31 mean that the |
| registers 0..15, respectively, are used as outputs, or are clobbered. |
| IS_DEST should be set to 16 if X is the destination of a SET, else to 0. */ |
| int |
| regs_used (rtx x, int is_dest) |
| { |
| enum rtx_code code; |
| const char *fmt; |
| int i, used = 0; |
| |
| if (! x) |
| return used; |
| code = GET_CODE (x); |
| switch (code) |
| { |
| case REG: |
| if (REGNO (x) < 16) |
| return (((1 << HARD_REGNO_NREGS (0, GET_MODE (x))) - 1) |
| << (REGNO (x) + is_dest)); |
| return 0; |
| case SUBREG: |
| { |
| rtx y = SUBREG_REG (x); |
| |
| if (!REG_P (y)) |
| break; |
| if (REGNO (y) < 16) |
| return (((1 << HARD_REGNO_NREGS (0, GET_MODE (x))) - 1) |
| << (REGNO (y) + |
| subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (y), |
| GET_MODE (y), |
| SUBREG_BYTE (x), |
| GET_MODE (x)) + is_dest)); |
| return 0; |
| } |
| case SET: |
| return regs_used (SET_SRC (x), 0) | regs_used (SET_DEST (x), 16); |
| case RETURN: |
| /* If there was a return value, it must have been indicated with USE. */ |
| return 0x00ffff00; |
| case CLOBBER: |
| is_dest = 1; |
| break; |
| case MEM: |
| is_dest = 0; |
| break; |
| case CALL: |
| used |= 0x00ff00f0; |
| break; |
| default: |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code); |
| |
| for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--) |
| { |
| if (fmt[i] == 'E') |
| { |
| register int j; |
| for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--) |
| used |= regs_used (XVECEXP (x, i, j), is_dest); |
| } |
| else if (fmt[i] == 'e') |
| used |= regs_used (XEXP (x, i), is_dest); |
| } |
| return used; |
| } |
| |
| /* Create an instruction that prevents redirection of a conditional branch |
| to the destination of the JUMP with address ADDR. |
| If the branch needs to be implemented as an indirect jump, try to find |
| a scratch register for it. |
| If NEED_BLOCK is 0, don't do anything unless we need a scratch register. |
| If any preceding insn that doesn't fit into a delay slot is good enough, |
| pass 1. Pass 2 if a definite blocking insn is needed. |
| -1 is used internally to avoid deep recursion. |
| If a blocking instruction is made or recognized, return it. */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| gen_block_redirect (rtx jump, int addr, int need_block) |
| { |
| int dead = 0; |
| rtx prev = prev_nonnote_insn (jump); |
| rtx dest; |
| |
| /* First, check if we already have an instruction that satisfies our need. */ |
| if (prev && NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev) && ! INSN_DELETED_P (prev)) |
| { |
| if (INSN_CODE (prev) == CODE_FOR_indirect_jump_scratch) |
| return prev; |
| if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == USE |
| || GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == CLOBBER |
| || get_attr_in_delay_slot (prev) == IN_DELAY_SLOT_YES) |
| prev = jump; |
| else if ((need_block &= ~1) < 0) |
| return prev; |
| else if (recog_memoized (prev) == CODE_FOR_block_branch_redirect) |
| need_block = 0; |
| } |
| if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (jump)) == RETURN) |
| { |
| if (! need_block) |
| return prev; |
| /* Reorg even does nasty things with return insns that cause branches |
| to go out of range - see find_end_label and callers. */ |
| return emit_insn_before (gen_block_branch_redirect (const0_rtx) , jump); |
| } |
| /* We can't use JUMP_LABEL here because it might be undefined |
| when not optimizing. */ |
| dest = XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (jump)), 0); |
| /* If the branch is out of range, try to find a scratch register for it. */ |
| if (optimize |
| && (INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (dest)) - addr + (unsigned) 4092 |
| > 4092 + 4098)) |
| { |
| rtx scan; |
| /* Don't look for the stack pointer as a scratch register, |
| it would cause trouble if an interrupt occurred. */ |
| unsigned attempt = 0x7fff, used; |
| int jump_left = flag_expensive_optimizations + 1; |
| |
| /* It is likely that the most recent eligible instruction is wanted for |
| the delay slot. Therefore, find out which registers it uses, and |
| try to avoid using them. */ |
| |
| for (scan = jump; (scan = PREV_INSN (scan)); ) |
| { |
| enum rtx_code code; |
| |
| if (INSN_DELETED_P (scan)) |
| continue; |
| code = GET_CODE (scan); |
| if (code == CODE_LABEL || code == JUMP_INSN) |
| break; |
| if (code == INSN |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (scan)) != USE |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (scan)) != CLOBBER |
| && get_attr_in_delay_slot (scan) == IN_DELAY_SLOT_YES) |
| { |
| attempt &= ~regs_used (PATTERN (scan), 0); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| for (used = dead = 0, scan = JUMP_LABEL (jump); |
| (scan = NEXT_INSN (scan)); ) |
| { |
| enum rtx_code code; |
| |
| if (INSN_DELETED_P (scan)) |
| continue; |
| code = GET_CODE (scan); |
| if (INSN_P (scan)) |
| { |
| used |= regs_used (PATTERN (scan), 0); |
| if (code == CALL_INSN) |
| used |= regs_used (CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (scan), 0); |
| dead |= (used >> 16) & ~used; |
| if (dead & attempt) |
| { |
| dead &= attempt; |
| break; |
| } |
| if (code == JUMP_INSN) |
| { |
| if (jump_left-- && simplejump_p (scan)) |
| scan = JUMP_LABEL (scan); |
| else |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| /* Mask out the stack pointer again, in case it was |
| the only 'free' register we have found. */ |
| dead &= 0x7fff; |
| } |
| /* If the immediate destination is still in range, check for possible |
| threading with a jump beyond the delay slot insn. |
| Don't check if we are called recursively; the jump has been or will be |
| checked in a different invocation then. */ |
| |
| else if (optimize && need_block >= 0) |
| { |
| rtx next = next_active_insn (next_active_insn (dest)); |
| if (next && JUMP_P (next) |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (next)) == SET |
| && recog_memoized (next) == CODE_FOR_jump_compact) |
| { |
| dest = JUMP_LABEL (next); |
| if (dest |
| && (INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (dest)) - addr + (unsigned) 4092 |
| > 4092 + 4098)) |
| gen_block_redirect (next, INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (next)), -1); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (dead) |
| { |
| rtx reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, exact_log2 (dead & -dead)); |
| |
| /* It would be nice if we could convert the jump into an indirect |
| jump / far branch right now, and thus exposing all constituent |
| instructions to further optimization. However, reorg uses |
| simplejump_p to determine if there is an unconditional jump where |
| it should try to schedule instructions from the target of the |
| branch; simplejump_p fails for indirect jumps even if they have |
| a JUMP_LABEL. */ |
| rtx insn = emit_insn_before (gen_indirect_jump_scratch |
| (reg, GEN_INT (unspec_bbr_uid++)), |
| jump); |
| /* ??? We would like this to have the scope of the jump, but that |
| scope will change when a delay slot insn of an inner scope is added. |
| Hence, after delay slot scheduling, we'll have to expect |
| NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_END notes between the indirect_jump_scratch and |
| the jump. */ |
| |
| INSN_LOCATOR (insn) = INSN_LOCATOR (jump); |
| INSN_CODE (insn) = CODE_FOR_indirect_jump_scratch; |
| return insn; |
| } |
| else if (need_block) |
| /* We can't use JUMP_LABEL here because it might be undefined |
| when not optimizing. */ |
| return emit_insn_before (gen_block_branch_redirect |
| (GEN_INT (unspec_bbr_uid++)), |
| jump); |
| return prev; |
| } |
| |
| #define CONDJUMP_MIN -252 |
| #define CONDJUMP_MAX 262 |
| struct far_branch |
| { |
| /* A label (to be placed) in front of the jump |
| that jumps to our ultimate destination. */ |
| rtx near_label; |
| /* Where we are going to insert it if we cannot move the jump any farther, |
| or the jump itself if we have picked up an existing jump. */ |
| rtx insert_place; |
| /* The ultimate destination. */ |
| rtx far_label; |
| struct far_branch *prev; |
| /* If the branch has already been created, its address; |
| else the address of its first prospective user. */ |
| int address; |
| }; |
| |
| static void gen_far_branch (struct far_branch *); |
| enum mdep_reorg_phase_e mdep_reorg_phase; |
| static void |
| gen_far_branch (struct far_branch *bp) |
| { |
| rtx insn = bp->insert_place; |
| rtx jump; |
| rtx label = gen_label_rtx (); |
| int ok; |
| |
| emit_label_after (label, insn); |
| if (bp->far_label) |
| { |
| jump = emit_jump_insn_after (gen_jump (bp->far_label), insn); |
| LABEL_NUSES (bp->far_label)++; |
| } |
| else |
| jump = emit_jump_insn_after (gen_return (), insn); |
| /* Emit a barrier so that reorg knows that any following instructions |
| are not reachable via a fall-through path. |
| But don't do this when not optimizing, since we wouldn't suppress the |
| alignment for the barrier then, and could end up with out-of-range |
| pc-relative loads. */ |
| if (optimize) |
| emit_barrier_after (jump); |
| emit_label_after (bp->near_label, insn); |
| JUMP_LABEL (jump) = bp->far_label; |
| ok = invert_jump (insn, label, 1); |
| gcc_assert (ok); |
| |
| /* If we are branching around a jump (rather than a return), prevent |
| reorg from using an insn from the jump target as the delay slot insn - |
| when reorg did this, it pessimized code (we rather hide the delay slot) |
| and it could cause branches to go out of range. */ |
| if (bp->far_label) |
| (emit_insn_after |
| (gen_stuff_delay_slot |
| (GEN_INT (unspec_bbr_uid++), |
| GEN_INT (recog_memoized (insn) == CODE_FOR_branch_false)), |
| insn)); |
| /* Prevent reorg from undoing our splits. */ |
| gen_block_redirect (jump, bp->address += 2, 2); |
| } |
| |
| /* Fix up ADDR_DIFF_VECs. */ |
| void |
| fixup_addr_diff_vecs (rtx first) |
| { |
| rtx insn; |
| |
| for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) |
| { |
| rtx vec_lab, pat, prev, prevpat, x, braf_label; |
| |
| if (!JUMP_P (insn) |
| || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_DIFF_VEC) |
| continue; |
| pat = PATTERN (insn); |
| vec_lab = XEXP (XEXP (pat, 0), 0); |
| |
| /* Search the matching casesi_jump_2. */ |
| for (prev = vec_lab; ; prev = PREV_INSN (prev)) |
| { |
| if (!JUMP_P (prev)) |
| continue; |
| prevpat = PATTERN (prev); |
| if (GET_CODE (prevpat) != PARALLEL || XVECLEN (prevpat, 0) != 2) |
| continue; |
| x = XVECEXP (prevpat, 0, 1); |
| if (GET_CODE (x) != USE) |
| continue; |
| x = XEXP (x, 0); |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF && XEXP (x, 0) == vec_lab) |
| break; |
| } |
| /* FIXME: This is a bug in the optimizer, but it seems harmless |
| to just avoid panicing. */ |
| if (!prev) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Emit the reference label of the braf where it belongs, right after |
| the casesi_jump_2 (i.e. braf). */ |
| braf_label = XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (prevpat, 0, 0)), 1), 0); |
| emit_label_after (braf_label, prev); |
| |
| /* Fix up the ADDR_DIF_VEC to be relative |
| to the reference address of the braf. */ |
| XEXP (XEXP (pat, 0), 0) = braf_label; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* BARRIER_OR_LABEL is either a BARRIER or a CODE_LABEL immediately following |
| a barrier. Return the base 2 logarithm of the desired alignment. */ |
| int |
| barrier_align (rtx barrier_or_label) |
| { |
| rtx next = next_real_insn (barrier_or_label), pat, prev; |
| int slot, credit, jump_to_next = 0; |
| |
| if (! next) |
| return 0; |
| |
| pat = PATTERN (next); |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (pat) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC) |
| return 2; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (pat) == UNSPEC_VOLATILE && XINT (pat, 1) == UNSPECV_ALIGN) |
| /* This is a barrier in front of a constant table. */ |
| return 0; |
| |
| prev = prev_real_insn (barrier_or_label); |
| if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC) |
| { |
| pat = PATTERN (prev); |
| /* If this is a very small table, we want to keep the alignment after |
| the table to the minimum for proper code alignment. */ |
| return ((optimize_size |
| || ((unsigned) XVECLEN (pat, 1) * GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (pat)) |
| <= (unsigned) 1 << (CACHE_LOG - 2))) |
| ? 1 << TARGET_SHMEDIA : align_jumps_log); |
| } |
| |
| if (optimize_size) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (! TARGET_SH2 || ! optimize) |
| return align_jumps_log; |
| |
| /* When fixing up pcloads, a constant table might be inserted just before |
| the basic block that ends with the barrier. Thus, we can't trust the |
| instruction lengths before that. */ |
| if (mdep_reorg_phase > SH_FIXUP_PCLOAD) |
| { |
| /* Check if there is an immediately preceding branch to the insn beyond |
| the barrier. We must weight the cost of discarding useful information |
| from the current cache line when executing this branch and there is |
| an alignment, against that of fetching unneeded insn in front of the |
| branch target when there is no alignment. */ |
| |
| /* There are two delay_slot cases to consider. One is the simple case |
| where the preceding branch is to the insn beyond the barrier (simple |
| delay slot filling), and the other is where the preceding branch has |
| a delay slot that is a duplicate of the insn after the barrier |
| (fill_eager_delay_slots) and the branch is to the insn after the insn |
| after the barrier. */ |
| |
| /* PREV is presumed to be the JUMP_INSN for the barrier under |
| investigation. Skip to the insn before it. */ |
| prev = prev_real_insn (prev); |
| |
| for (slot = 2, credit = (1 << (CACHE_LOG - 2)) + 2; |
| credit >= 0 && prev && NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev); |
| prev = prev_real_insn (prev)) |
| { |
| jump_to_next = 0; |
| if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == USE |
| || GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == CLOBBER) |
| continue; |
| if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SEQUENCE) |
| { |
| prev = XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 1); |
| if (INSN_UID (prev) == INSN_UID (next)) |
| { |
| /* Delay slot was filled with insn at jump target. */ |
| jump_to_next = 1; |
| continue; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (slot && |
| get_attr_in_delay_slot (prev) == IN_DELAY_SLOT_YES) |
| slot = 0; |
| credit -= get_attr_length (prev); |
| } |
| if (prev |
| && JUMP_P (prev) |
| && JUMP_LABEL (prev)) |
| { |
| rtx x; |
| if (jump_to_next |
| || next_real_insn (JUMP_LABEL (prev)) == next |
| /* If relax_delay_slots() decides NEXT was redundant |
| with some previous instruction, it will have |
| redirected PREV's jump to the following insn. */ |
| || JUMP_LABEL (prev) == next_nonnote_insn (next) |
| /* There is no upper bound on redundant instructions |
| that might have been skipped, but we must not put an |
| alignment where none had been before. */ |
| || (x = (NEXT_INSN (NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (prev)))), |
| (INSN_P (x) |
| && (INSN_CODE (x) == CODE_FOR_block_branch_redirect |
| || INSN_CODE (x) == CODE_FOR_indirect_jump_scratch |
| || INSN_CODE (x) == CODE_FOR_stuff_delay_slot)))) |
| { |
| rtx pat = PATTERN (prev); |
| if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL) |
| pat = XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0); |
| if (credit - slot >= (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (pat)) == PC ? 2 : 0)) |
| return 0; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return align_jumps_log; |
| } |
| |
| /* If we are inside a phony loop, almost any kind of label can turn up as the |
| first one in the loop. Aligning a braf label causes incorrect switch |
| destination addresses; we can detect braf labels because they are |
| followed by a BARRIER. |
| Applying loop alignment to small constant or switch tables is a waste |
| of space, so we suppress this too. */ |
| int |
| sh_loop_align (rtx label) |
| { |
| rtx next = label; |
| |
| do |
| next = next_nonnote_insn (next); |
| while (next && LABEL_P (next)); |
| |
| if (! next |
| || ! INSN_P (next) |
| || GET_CODE (PATTERN (next)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC |
| || recog_memoized (next) == CODE_FOR_consttable_2) |
| return 0; |
| |
| return align_loops_log; |
| } |
| |
| /* Do a final pass over the function, just before delayed branch |
| scheduling. */ |
| |
| static void |
| sh_reorg (void) |
| { |
| rtx first, insn, mova = NULL_RTX; |
| int num_mova; |
| rtx r0_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0); |
| rtx r0_inc_rtx = gen_rtx_POST_INC (Pmode, r0_rtx); |
| |
| first = get_insns (); |
| max_labelno_before_reorg = max_label_num (); |
| |
| /* We must split call insns before introducing `mova's. If we're |
| optimizing, they'll have already been split. Otherwise, make |
| sure we don't split them too late. */ |
| if (! optimize) |
| split_all_insns_noflow (); |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| return; |
| |
| /* If relaxing, generate pseudo-ops to associate function calls with |
| the symbols they call. It does no harm to not generate these |
| pseudo-ops. However, when we can generate them, it enables to |
| linker to potentially relax the jsr to a bsr, and eliminate the |
| register load and, possibly, the constant pool entry. */ |
| |
| mdep_reorg_phase = SH_INSERT_USES_LABELS; |
| if (TARGET_RELAX) |
| { |
| /* Remove all REG_LABEL_OPERAND notes. We want to use them for our |
| own purposes. This works because none of the remaining passes |
| need to look at them. |
| |
| ??? But it may break in the future. We should use a machine |
| dependent REG_NOTE, or some other approach entirely. */ |
| for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) |
| { |
| if (INSN_P (insn)) |
| { |
| rtx note; |
| |
| while ((note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_LABEL_OPERAND, |
| NULL_RTX)) != 0) |
| remove_note (insn, note); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) |
| { |
| rtx pattern, reg, link, set, scan, dies, label; |
| int rescan = 0, foundinsn = 0; |
| |
| if (CALL_P (insn)) |
| { |
| pattern = PATTERN (insn); |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL) |
| pattern = XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 0); |
| if (GET_CODE (pattern) == SET) |
| pattern = SET_SRC (pattern); |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (pattern) != CALL |
| || !MEM_P (XEXP (pattern, 0))) |
| continue; |
| |
| reg = XEXP (XEXP (pattern, 0), 0); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| reg = sfunc_uses_reg (insn); |
| if (! reg) |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| if (!REG_P (reg)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Try scanning backward to find where the register is set. */ |
| link = NULL; |
| for (scan = PREV_INSN (insn); |
| scan && !LABEL_P (scan); |
| scan = PREV_INSN (scan)) |
| { |
| if (! INSN_P (scan)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (! reg_mentioned_p (reg, scan)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (noncall_uses_reg (reg, scan, &set)) |
| break; |
| |
| if (set) |
| { |
| link = scan; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (! link) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* The register is set at LINK. */ |
| |
| /* We can only optimize the function call if the register is |
| being set to a symbol. In theory, we could sometimes |
| optimize calls to a constant location, but the assembler |
| and linker do not support that at present. */ |
| if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != SYMBOL_REF |
| && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != LABEL_REF) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Scan forward from LINK to the place where REG dies, and |
| make sure that the only insns which use REG are |
| themselves function calls. */ |
| |
| /* ??? This doesn't work for call targets that were allocated |
| by reload, since there may not be a REG_DEAD note for the |
| register. */ |
| |
| dies = NULL_RTX; |
| for (scan = NEXT_INSN (link); scan; scan = NEXT_INSN (scan)) |
| { |
| rtx scanset; |
| |
| /* Don't try to trace forward past a CODE_LABEL if we haven't |
| seen INSN yet. Ordinarily, we will only find the setting insn |
| if it is in the same basic block. However, |
| cross-jumping can insert code labels in between the load and |
| the call, and can result in situations where a single call |
| insn may have two targets depending on where we came from. */ |
| |
| if (LABEL_P (scan) && ! foundinsn) |
| break; |
| |
| if (! INSN_P (scan)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Don't try to trace forward past a JUMP. To optimize |
| safely, we would have to check that all the |
| instructions at the jump destination did not use REG. */ |
| |
| if (JUMP_P (scan)) |
| break; |
| |
| if (! reg_mentioned_p (reg, scan)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (noncall_uses_reg (reg, scan, &scanset)) |
| break; |
| |
| if (scan == insn) |
| foundinsn = 1; |
| |
| if (scan != insn |
| && (CALL_P (scan) || sfunc_uses_reg (scan))) |
| { |
| /* There is a function call to this register other |
| than the one we are checking. If we optimize |
| this call, we need to rescan again below. */ |
| rescan = 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* ??? We shouldn't have to worry about SCANSET here. |
| We should just be able to check for a REG_DEAD note |
| on a function call. However, the REG_DEAD notes are |
| apparently not dependable around libcalls; c-torture |
| execute/920501-2 is a test case. If SCANSET is set, |
| then this insn sets the register, so it must have |
| died earlier. Unfortunately, this will only handle |
| the cases in which the register is, in fact, set in a |
| later insn. */ |
| |
| /* ??? We shouldn't have to use FOUNDINSN here. |
| This dates back to when we used LOG_LINKS to find |
| the most recent insn which sets the register. */ |
| |
| if (foundinsn |
| && (scanset |
| || find_reg_note (scan, REG_DEAD, reg))) |
| { |
| dies = scan; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (! dies) |
| { |
| /* Either there was a branch, or some insn used REG |
| other than as a function call address. */ |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* Create a code label, and put it in a REG_LABEL_OPERAND note |
| on the insn which sets the register, and on each call insn |
| which uses the register. In final_prescan_insn we look for |
| the REG_LABEL_OPERAND notes, and output the appropriate label |
| or pseudo-op. */ |
| |
| label = gen_label_rtx (); |
| add_reg_note (link, REG_LABEL_OPERAND, label); |
| add_reg_note (insn, REG_LABEL_OPERAND, label); |
| if (rescan) |
| { |
| scan = link; |
| do |
| { |
| rtx reg2; |
| |
| scan = NEXT_INSN (scan); |
| if (scan != insn |
| && ((CALL_P (scan) |
| && reg_mentioned_p (reg, scan)) |
| || ((reg2 = sfunc_uses_reg (scan)) |
| && REGNO (reg2) == REGNO (reg)))) |
| add_reg_note (scan, REG_LABEL_OPERAND, label); |
| } |
| while (scan != dies); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH2) |
| fixup_addr_diff_vecs (first); |
| |
| if (optimize) |
| { |
| mdep_reorg_phase = SH_SHORTEN_BRANCHES0; |
| shorten_branches (first); |
| } |
| |
| /* Scan the function looking for move instructions which have to be |
| changed to pc-relative loads and insert the literal tables. */ |
| label_ref_list_pool = create_alloc_pool ("label references list", |
| sizeof (struct label_ref_list_d), |
| 30); |
| mdep_reorg_phase = SH_FIXUP_PCLOAD; |
| for (insn = first, num_mova = 0; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) |
| { |
| if (mova_p (insn)) |
| { |
| /* ??? basic block reordering can move a switch table dispatch |
| below the switch table. Check if that has happened. |
| We only have the addresses available when optimizing; but then, |
| this check shouldn't be needed when not optimizing. */ |
| if (!untangle_mova (&num_mova, &mova, insn)) |
| { |
| insn = mova; |
| num_mova = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| else if (JUMP_P (insn) |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC |
| && num_mova |
| /* ??? loop invariant motion can also move a mova out of a |
| loop. Since loop does this code motion anyway, maybe we |
| should wrap UNSPEC_MOVA into a CONST, so that reload can |
| move it back. */ |
| && ((num_mova > 1 |
| && GET_MODE (prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) == VOIDmode) |
| || (prev_nonnote_insn (insn) |
| == XEXP (MOVA_LABELREF (mova), 0)))) |
| { |
| rtx scan; |
| int total; |
| |
| num_mova--; |
| |
| /* Some code might have been inserted between the mova and |
| its ADDR_DIFF_VEC. Check if the mova is still in range. */ |
| for (scan = mova, total = 0; scan != insn; scan = NEXT_INSN (scan)) |
| total += get_attr_length (scan); |
| |
| /* range of mova is 1020, add 4 because pc counts from address of |
| second instruction after this one, subtract 2 in case pc is 2 |
| byte aligned. Possible alignment needed for the ADDR_DIFF_VEC |
| cancels out with alignment effects of the mova itself. */ |
| if (total > 1022) |
| { |
| /* Change the mova into a load, and restart scanning |
| there. broken_move will then return true for mova. */ |
| fixup_mova (mova); |
| insn = mova; |
| } |
| } |
| if (broken_move (insn) |
| || (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) |
| && recog_memoized (insn) == CODE_FOR_casesi_worker_2)) |
| { |
| rtx scan; |
| /* Scan ahead looking for a barrier to stick the constant table |
| behind. */ |
| rtx barrier = find_barrier (num_mova, mova, insn); |
| rtx last_float_move = NULL_RTX, last_float = 0, *last_float_addr = NULL; |
| int need_aligned_label = 0; |
| |
| if (num_mova && ! mova_p (mova)) |
| { |
| /* find_barrier had to change the first mova into a |
| pcload; thus, we have to start with this new pcload. */ |
| insn = mova; |
| num_mova = 0; |
| } |
| /* Now find all the moves between the points and modify them. */ |
| for (scan = insn; scan != barrier; scan = NEXT_INSN (scan)) |
| { |
| if (LABEL_P (scan)) |
| last_float = 0; |
| if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (scan) |
| && recog_memoized (scan) == CODE_FOR_casesi_worker_2) |
| need_aligned_label = 1; |
| if (broken_move (scan)) |
| { |
| rtx *patp = &PATTERN (scan), pat = *patp; |
| rtx src, dst; |
| rtx lab; |
| rtx newsrc; |
| enum machine_mode mode; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL) |
| patp = &XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0), pat = *patp; |
| src = SET_SRC (pat); |
| dst = SET_DEST (pat); |
| mode = GET_MODE (dst); |
| |
| if (mode == SImode && hi_const (src) |
| && REGNO (dst) != FPUL_REG) |
| { |
| int offset = 0; |
| |
| mode = HImode; |
| while (GET_CODE (dst) == SUBREG) |
| { |
| offset += subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (dst)), |
| GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dst)), |
| SUBREG_BYTE (dst), |
| GET_MODE (dst)); |
| dst = SUBREG_REG (dst); |
| } |
| dst = gen_rtx_REG (HImode, REGNO (dst) + offset); |
| } |
| if (REG_P (dst) && FP_ANY_REGISTER_P (REGNO (dst))) |
| { |
| /* This must be an insn that clobbers r0. */ |
| rtx *clobberp = &XVECEXP (PATTERN (scan), 0, |
| XVECLEN (PATTERN (scan), 0) |
| - 1); |
| rtx clobber = *clobberp; |
| |
| gcc_assert (GET_CODE (clobber) == CLOBBER |
| && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (clobber, 0), r0_rtx)); |
| |
| if (last_float |
| && reg_set_between_p (r0_rtx, last_float_move, scan)) |
| last_float = 0; |
| if (last_float |
| && TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 4 |
| && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (last_float)) == 4) |
| last_float = 0; |
| lab = add_constant (src, mode, last_float); |
| if (lab) |
| emit_insn_before (gen_mova (lab), scan); |
| else |
| { |
| /* There will be a REG_UNUSED note for r0 on |
| LAST_FLOAT_MOVE; we have to change it to REG_INC, |
| lest reorg:mark_target_live_regs will not |
| consider r0 to be used, and we end up with delay |
| slot insn in front of SCAN that clobbers r0. */ |
| rtx note |
| = find_regno_note (last_float_move, REG_UNUSED, 0); |
| |
| /* If we are not optimizing, then there may not be |
| a note. */ |
| if (note) |
| PUT_REG_NOTE_KIND (note, REG_INC); |
| |
| *last_float_addr = r0_inc_rtx; |
| } |
| last_float_move = scan; |
| last_float = src; |
| newsrc = gen_const_mem (mode, |
| (((TARGET_SH4 && ! TARGET_FMOVD) |
| || REGNO (dst) == FPUL_REG) |
| ? r0_inc_rtx |
| : r0_rtx)); |
| last_float_addr = &XEXP (newsrc, 0); |
| |
| /* Remove the clobber of r0. */ |
| *clobberp = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (GET_MODE (clobber), |
| gen_rtx_SCRATCH (Pmode)); |
| } |
| /* This is a mova needing a label. Create it. */ |
| else if (GET_CODE (src) == UNSPEC |
| && XINT (src, 1) == UNSPEC_MOVA |
| && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0)) == CONST) |
| { |
| lab = add_constant (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), mode, 0); |
| newsrc = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, lab); |
| newsrc = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (SImode, |
| gen_rtvec (1, newsrc), |
| UNSPEC_MOVA); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| lab = add_constant (src, mode, 0); |
| newsrc = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, lab); |
| newsrc = gen_const_mem (mode, newsrc); |
| } |
| *patp = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dst, newsrc); |
| INSN_CODE (scan) = -1; |
| } |
| } |
| dump_table (need_aligned_label ? insn : 0, barrier); |
| insn = barrier; |
| } |
| } |
| free_alloc_pool (label_ref_list_pool); |
| for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) |
| PUT_MODE (insn, VOIDmode); |
| |
| mdep_reorg_phase = SH_SHORTEN_BRANCHES1; |
| INSN_ADDRESSES_FREE (); |
| split_branches (first); |
| |
| /* The INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED in sh.h is problematic because it |
| also has an effect on the register that holds the address of the sfunc. |
| Insert an extra dummy insn in front of each sfunc that pretends to |
| use this register. */ |
| if (flag_delayed_branch) |
| { |
| for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) |
| { |
| rtx reg = sfunc_uses_reg (insn); |
| |
| if (! reg) |
| continue; |
| emit_insn_before (gen_use_sfunc_addr (reg), insn); |
| } |
| } |
| #if 0 |
| /* fpscr is not actually a user variable, but we pretend it is for the |
| sake of the previous optimization passes, since we want it handled like |
| one. However, we don't have any debugging information for it, so turn |
| it into a non-user variable now. */ |
| if (TARGET_SH4) |
| REG_USERVAR_P (get_fpscr_rtx ()) = 0; |
| #endif |
| mdep_reorg_phase = SH_AFTER_MDEP_REORG; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| get_dest_uid (rtx label, int max_uid) |
| { |
| rtx dest = next_real_insn (label); |
| int dest_uid; |
| if (! dest) |
| /* This can happen for an undefined label. */ |
| return 0; |
| dest_uid = INSN_UID (dest); |
| /* If this is a newly created branch redirection blocking instruction, |
| we cannot index the branch_uid or insn_addresses arrays with its |
| uid. But then, we won't need to, because the actual destination is |
| the following branch. */ |
| while (dest_uid >= max_uid) |
| { |
| dest = NEXT_INSN (dest); |
| dest_uid = INSN_UID (dest); |
| } |
| if (JUMP_P (dest) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (dest)) == RETURN) |
| return 0; |
| return dest_uid; |
| } |
| |
| /* Split condbranches that are out of range. Also add clobbers for |
| scratch registers that are needed in far jumps. |
| We do this before delay slot scheduling, so that it can take our |
| newly created instructions into account. It also allows us to |
| find branches with common targets more easily. */ |
| |
| static void |
| split_branches (rtx first) |
| { |
| rtx insn; |
| struct far_branch **uid_branch, *far_branch_list = 0; |
| int max_uid = get_max_uid (); |
| int ok; |
| |
| /* Find out which branches are out of range. */ |
| shorten_branches (first); |
| |
| uid_branch = (struct far_branch **) alloca (max_uid * sizeof *uid_branch); |
| memset ((char *) uid_branch, 0, max_uid * sizeof *uid_branch); |
| |
| for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) |
| if (! INSN_P (insn)) |
| continue; |
| else if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn)) |
| { |
| /* Shorten_branches would split this instruction again, |
| so transform it into a note. */ |
| SET_INSN_DELETED (insn); |
| } |
| else if (JUMP_P (insn) |
| /* Don't mess with ADDR_DIFF_VEC */ |
| && (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET |
| || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == RETURN)) |
| { |
| enum attr_type type = get_attr_type (insn); |
| if (type == TYPE_CBRANCH) |
| { |
| rtx next, beyond; |
| |
| if (get_attr_length (insn) > 4) |
| { |
| rtx src = SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)); |
| rtx olabel = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 0); |
| int addr = INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)); |
| rtx label = 0; |
| int dest_uid = get_dest_uid (olabel, max_uid); |
| struct far_branch *bp = uid_branch[dest_uid]; |
| |
| /* redirect_jump needs a valid JUMP_LABEL, and it might delete |
| the label if the LABEL_NUSES count drops to zero. There is |
| always a jump_optimize pass that sets these values, but it |
| proceeds to delete unreferenced code, and then if not |
| optimizing, to un-delete the deleted instructions, thus |
| leaving labels with too low uses counts. */ |
| if (! optimize) |
| { |
| JUMP_LABEL (insn) = olabel; |
| LABEL_NUSES (olabel)++; |
| } |
| if (! bp) |
| { |
| bp = (struct far_branch *) alloca (sizeof *bp); |
| uid_branch[dest_uid] = bp; |
| bp->prev = far_branch_list; |
| far_branch_list = bp; |
| bp->far_label |
| = XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)), 1), 0); |
| LABEL_NUSES (bp->far_label)++; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| label = bp->near_label; |
| if (! label && bp->address - addr >= CONDJUMP_MIN) |
| { |
| rtx block = bp->insert_place; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (block)) == RETURN) |
| block = PREV_INSN (block); |
| else |
| block = gen_block_redirect (block, |
| bp->address, 2); |
| label = emit_label_after (gen_label_rtx (), |
| PREV_INSN (block)); |
| bp->near_label = label; |
| } |
| else if (label && ! NEXT_INSN (label)) |
| { |
| if (addr + 2 - bp->address <= CONDJUMP_MAX) |
| bp->insert_place = insn; |
| else |
| gen_far_branch (bp); |
| } |
| } |
| if (! label |
| || (NEXT_INSN (label) && bp->address - addr < CONDJUMP_MIN)) |
| { |
| bp->near_label = label = gen_label_rtx (); |
| bp->insert_place = insn; |
| bp->address = addr; |
| } |
| ok = redirect_jump (insn, label, 0); |
| gcc_assert (ok); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* get_attr_length (insn) == 2 */ |
| /* Check if we have a pattern where reorg wants to redirect |
| the branch to a label from an unconditional branch that |
| is too far away. */ |
| /* We can't use JUMP_LABEL here because it might be undefined |
| when not optimizing. */ |
| /* A syntax error might cause beyond to be NULL_RTX. */ |
| beyond |
| = next_active_insn (XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)), 1), |
| 0)); |
| |
| if (beyond |
| && (JUMP_P (beyond) |
| || ((beyond = next_active_insn (beyond)) |
| && JUMP_P (beyond))) |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (beyond)) == SET |
| && recog_memoized (beyond) == CODE_FOR_jump_compact |
| && ((INSN_ADDRESSES |
| (INSN_UID (XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (beyond)), 0))) |
| - INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)) + (unsigned) 252) |
| > 252 + 258 + 2)) |
| gen_block_redirect (beyond, |
| INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (beyond)), 1); |
| } |
| |
| next = next_active_insn (insn); |
| |
| if (next |
| && (JUMP_P (next) |
| || ((next = next_active_insn (next)) |
| && JUMP_P (next))) |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (next)) == SET |
| && recog_memoized (next) == CODE_FOR_jump_compact |
| && ((INSN_ADDRESSES |
| (INSN_UID (XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (next)), 0))) |
| - INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)) + (unsigned) 252) |
| > 252 + 258 + 2)) |
| gen_block_redirect (next, INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (next)), 1); |
| } |
| else if (type == TYPE_JUMP || type == TYPE_RETURN) |
| { |
| int addr = INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)); |
| rtx far_label = 0; |
| int dest_uid = 0; |
| struct far_branch *bp; |
| |
| if (type == TYPE_JUMP) |
| { |
| far_label = XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)), 0); |
| dest_uid = get_dest_uid (far_label, max_uid); |
| if (! dest_uid) |
| { |
| /* Parse errors can lead to labels outside |
| the insn stream. */ |
| if (! NEXT_INSN (far_label)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (! optimize) |
| { |
| JUMP_LABEL (insn) = far_label; |
| LABEL_NUSES (far_label)++; |
| } |
| redirect_jump (insn, NULL_RTX, 1); |
| far_label = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| bp = uid_branch[dest_uid]; |
| if (! bp) |
| { |
| bp = (struct far_branch *) alloca (sizeof *bp); |
| uid_branch[dest_uid] = bp; |
| bp->prev = far_branch_list; |
| far_branch_list = bp; |
| bp->near_label = 0; |
| bp->far_label = far_label; |
| if (far_label) |
| LABEL_NUSES (far_label)++; |
| } |
| else if (bp->near_label && ! NEXT_INSN (bp->near_label)) |
| if (addr - bp->address <= CONDJUMP_MAX) |
| emit_label_after (bp->near_label, PREV_INSN (insn)); |
| else |
| { |
| gen_far_branch (bp); |
| bp->near_label = 0; |
| } |
| else |
| bp->near_label = 0; |
| bp->address = addr; |
| bp->insert_place = insn; |
| if (! far_label) |
| emit_insn_before (gen_block_branch_redirect (const0_rtx), insn); |
| else |
| gen_block_redirect (insn, addr, bp->near_label ? 2 : 0); |
| } |
| } |
| /* Generate all pending far branches, |
| and free our references to the far labels. */ |
| while (far_branch_list) |
| { |
| if (far_branch_list->near_label |
| && ! NEXT_INSN (far_branch_list->near_label)) |
| gen_far_branch (far_branch_list); |
| if (optimize |
| && far_branch_list->far_label |
| && ! --LABEL_NUSES (far_branch_list->far_label)) |
| delete_insn (far_branch_list->far_label); |
| far_branch_list = far_branch_list->prev; |
| } |
| |
| /* Instruction length information is no longer valid due to the new |
| instructions that have been generated. */ |
| init_insn_lengths (); |
| } |
| |
| /* Dump out instruction addresses, which is useful for debugging the |
| constant pool table stuff. |
| |
| If relaxing, output the label and pseudo-ops used to link together |
| calls and the instruction which set the registers. */ |
| |
| /* ??? The addresses printed by this routine for insns are nonsense for |
| insns which are inside of a sequence where none of the inner insns have |
| variable length. This is because the second pass of shorten_branches |
| does not bother to update them. */ |
| |
| void |
| final_prescan_insn (rtx insn, rtx *opvec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int noperands ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_DUMPISIZE) |
| fprintf (asm_out_file, "\n! at %04x\n", INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn))); |
| |
| if (TARGET_RELAX) |
| { |
| rtx note; |
| |
| note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_LABEL_OPERAND, NULL_RTX); |
| if (note) |
| { |
| rtx pattern; |
| |
| pattern = PATTERN (insn); |
| if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL) |
| pattern = XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 0); |
| switch (GET_CODE (pattern)) |
| { |
| case SET: |
| if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (pattern)) != CALL |
| && get_attr_type (insn) != TYPE_SFUNC) |
| { |
| targetm.asm_out.internal_label |
| (asm_out_file, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (XEXP (note, 0))); |
| break; |
| } |
| /* else FALLTHROUGH */ |
| case CALL: |
| asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.uses %LL%d\n", |
| CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (XEXP (note, 0))); |
| break; |
| |
| default: |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Dump out any constants accumulated in the final pass. These will |
| only be labels. */ |
| |
| const char * |
| output_jump_label_table (void) |
| { |
| int i; |
| |
| if (pool_size) |
| { |
| fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.align 2\n"); |
| for (i = 0; i < pool_size; i++) |
| { |
| pool_node *p = &pool_vector[i]; |
| |
| (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (asm_out_file, "L", |
| CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (p->label)); |
| output_asm_insn (".long %O0", &p->value); |
| } |
| pool_size = 0; |
| } |
| |
| return ""; |
| } |
| |
| /* A full frame looks like: |
| |
| arg-5 |
| arg-4 |
| [ if current_function_anonymous_args |
| arg-3 |
| arg-2 |
| arg-1 |
| arg-0 ] |
| saved-fp |
| saved-r10 |
| saved-r11 |
| saved-r12 |
| saved-pr |
| local-n |
| .. |
| local-1 |
| local-0 <- fp points here. */ |
| |
| /* Number of bytes pushed for anonymous args, used to pass information |
| between expand_prologue and expand_epilogue. */ |
| |
| /* Adjust the stack by SIZE bytes. REG holds the rtl of the register to be |
| adjusted. If epilogue_p is zero, this is for a prologue; otherwise, it's |
| for an epilogue and a negative value means that it's for a sibcall |
| epilogue. If LIVE_REGS_MASK is nonzero, it points to a HARD_REG_SET of |
| all the registers that are about to be restored, and hence dead. */ |
| |
| static void |
| output_stack_adjust (int size, rtx reg, int epilogue_p, |
| HARD_REG_SET *live_regs_mask, bool frame_p) |
| { |
| rtx (*emit_fn) (rtx) = frame_p ? &frame_insn : &emit_insn; |
| if (size) |
| { |
| HOST_WIDE_INT align = STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT; |
| |
| /* This test is bogus, as output_stack_adjust is used to re-align the |
| stack. */ |
| #if 0 |
| gcc_assert (!(size % align)); |
| #endif |
| |
| if (CONST_OK_FOR_ADD (size)) |
| emit_fn (GEN_ADD3 (reg, reg, GEN_INT (size))); |
| /* Try to do it with two partial adjustments; however, we must make |
| sure that the stack is properly aligned at all times, in case |
| an interrupt occurs between the two partial adjustments. */ |
| else if (CONST_OK_FOR_ADD (size / 2 & -align) |
| && CONST_OK_FOR_ADD (size - (size / 2 & -align))) |
| { |
| emit_fn (GEN_ADD3 (reg, reg, GEN_INT (size / 2 & -align))); |
| emit_fn (GEN_ADD3 (reg, reg, GEN_INT (size - (size / 2 & -align)))); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| rtx const_reg; |
| rtx insn; |
| int temp = epilogue_p ? 7 : (TARGET_SH5 ? 0 : 1); |
| int i; |
| |
| /* If TEMP is invalid, we could temporarily save a general |
| register to MACL. However, there is currently no need |
| to handle this case, so just die when we see it. */ |
| if (epilogue_p < 0 |
| || current_function_interrupt |
| || ! call_really_used_regs[temp] || fixed_regs[temp]) |
| temp = -1; |
| if (temp < 0 && ! current_function_interrupt |
| && (TARGET_SHMEDIA || epilogue_p >= 0)) |
| { |
| HARD_REG_SET temps; |
| COPY_HARD_REG_SET (temps, call_used_reg_set); |
| AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (temps, call_fixed_reg_set); |
| if (epilogue_p > 0) |
| { |
| int nreg = 0; |
| if (crtl->return_rtx) |
| { |
| enum machine_mode mode; |
| mode = GET_MODE (crtl->return_rtx); |
| if (BASE_RETURN_VALUE_REG (mode) == FIRST_RET_REG) |
| nreg = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (FIRST_RET_REG, mode); |
| } |
| for (i = 0; i < nreg; i++) |
| CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (temps, FIRST_RET_REG + i); |
| if (crtl->calls_eh_return) |
| { |
| CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (temps, EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_REGNO); |
| for (i = 0; i <= 3; i++) |
| CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (temps, EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i)); |
| } |
| } |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA && epilogue_p < 0) |
| for (i = FIRST_TARGET_REG; i <= LAST_TARGET_REG; i++) |
| CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (temps, i); |
| if (epilogue_p <= 0) |
| { |
| for (i = FIRST_PARM_REG; |
| i < FIRST_PARM_REG + NPARM_REGS (SImode); i++) |
| CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (temps, i); |
| if (cfun->static_chain_decl != NULL) |
| CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (temps, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM); |
| } |
| temp = scavenge_reg (&temps); |
| } |
| if (temp < 0 && live_regs_mask) |
| { |
| HARD_REG_SET temps; |
| |
| COPY_HARD_REG_SET (temps, *live_regs_mask); |
| CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (temps, REGNO (reg)); |
| temp = scavenge_reg (&temps); |
| } |
| if (temp < 0) |
| { |
| rtx adj_reg, tmp_reg, mem; |
| |
| /* If we reached here, the most likely case is the (sibcall) |
| epilogue for non SHmedia. Put a special push/pop sequence |
| for such case as the last resort. This looks lengthy but |
| would not be problem because it seems to be very |
| rare. */ |
| |
| gcc_assert (!TARGET_SHMEDIA && epilogue_p); |
| |
| |
| /* ??? There is still the slight possibility that r4 or |
| r5 have been reserved as fixed registers or assigned |
| as global registers, and they change during an |
| interrupt. There are possible ways to handle this: |
| |
| - If we are adjusting the frame pointer (r14), we can do |
| with a single temp register and an ordinary push / pop |
| on the stack. |
| - Grab any call-used or call-saved registers (i.e. not |
| fixed or globals) for the temps we need. We might |
| also grab r14 if we are adjusting the stack pointer. |
| If we can't find enough available registers, issue |
| a diagnostic and die - the user must have reserved |
| way too many registers. |
| But since all this is rather unlikely to happen and |
| would require extra testing, we just die if r4 / r5 |
| are not available. */ |
| gcc_assert (!fixed_regs[4] && !fixed_regs[5] |
| && !global_regs[4] && !global_regs[5]); |
| |
| adj_reg = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (reg), 4); |
| tmp_reg = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (reg), 5); |
| emit_move_insn (gen_tmp_stack_mem (Pmode, reg), adj_reg); |
| emit_insn (GEN_MOV (adj_reg, GEN_INT (size))); |
| emit_insn (GEN_ADD3 (adj_reg, adj_reg, reg)); |
| mem = gen_tmp_stack_mem (Pmode, gen_rtx_PRE_DEC (Pmode, adj_reg)); |
| emit_move_insn (mem, tmp_reg); |
| emit_move_insn (tmp_reg, gen_tmp_stack_mem (Pmode, reg)); |
| mem = gen_tmp_stack_mem (Pmode, gen_rtx_PRE_DEC (Pmode, adj_reg)); |
| emit_move_insn (mem, tmp_reg); |
| emit_move_insn (reg, adj_reg); |
| mem = gen_tmp_stack_mem (Pmode, gen_rtx_POST_INC (Pmode, reg)); |
| emit_move_insn (adj_reg, mem); |
| mem = gen_tmp_stack_mem (Pmode, gen_rtx_POST_INC (Pmode, reg)); |
| emit_move_insn (tmp_reg, mem); |
| /* Tell flow the insns that pop r4/r5 aren't dead. */ |
| emit_use (tmp_reg); |
| emit_use (adj_reg); |
| return; |
| } |
| const_reg = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (reg), temp); |
| |
| /* If SIZE is negative, subtract the positive value. |
| This sometimes allows a constant pool entry to be shared |
| between prologue and epilogue code. */ |
| if (size < 0) |
| { |
| emit_insn (GEN_MOV (const_reg, GEN_INT (-size))); |
| insn = emit_fn (GEN_SUB3 (reg, reg, const_reg)); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| emit_insn (GEN_MOV (const_reg, GEN_INT (size))); |
| insn = emit_fn (GEN_ADD3 (reg, reg, const_reg)); |
| } |
| if (! epilogue_p) |
| add_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, |
| gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, |
| gen_rtx_PLUS (SImode, reg, |
| GEN_INT (size)))); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static rtx |
| frame_insn (rtx x) |
| { |
| x = emit_insn (x); |
| RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (x) = 1; |
| return x; |
| } |
| |
| /* Output RTL to push register RN onto the stack. */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| push (int rn) |
| { |
| rtx x; |
| if (rn == FPUL_REG) |
| x = gen_push_fpul (); |
| else if (rn == FPSCR_REG) |
| x = gen_push_fpscr (); |
| else if ((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE) && TARGET_FMOVD && ! TARGET_FPU_SINGLE |
| && FP_OR_XD_REGISTER_P (rn)) |
| { |
| if (FP_REGISTER_P (rn) && (rn - FIRST_FP_REG) & 1) |
| return NULL_RTX; |
| x = gen_push_4 (gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, rn)); |
| } |
| else if (TARGET_SH2E && FP_REGISTER_P (rn)) |
| x = gen_push_e (gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, rn)); |
| else |
| x = gen_push (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, rn)); |
| |
| x = frame_insn (x); |
| add_reg_note (x, REG_INC, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)); |
| return x; |
| } |
| |
| /* Output RTL to pop register RN from the stack. */ |
| |
| static void |
| pop (int rn) |
| { |
| rtx x; |
| if (rn == FPUL_REG) |
| x = gen_pop_fpul (); |
| else if (rn == FPSCR_REG) |
| x = gen_pop_fpscr (); |
| else if ((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE) && TARGET_FMOVD && ! TARGET_FPU_SINGLE |
| && FP_OR_XD_REGISTER_P (rn)) |
| { |
| if (FP_REGISTER_P (rn) && (rn - FIRST_FP_REG) & 1) |
| return; |
| x = gen_pop_4 (gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, rn)); |
| } |
| else if (TARGET_SH2E && FP_REGISTER_P (rn)) |
| x = gen_pop_e (gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, rn)); |
| else |
| x = gen_pop (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, rn)); |
| |
| x = emit_insn (x); |
| add_reg_note (x, REG_INC, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Generate code to push the regs specified in the mask. */ |
| |
| static void |
| push_regs (HARD_REG_SET *mask, int interrupt_handler) |
| { |
| int i = interrupt_handler ? LAST_BANKED_REG + 1 : 0; |
| int skip_fpscr = 0; |
| |
| /* Push PR last; this gives better latencies after the prologue, and |
| candidates for the return delay slot when there are no general |
| registers pushed. */ |
| for (; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++) |
| { |
| /* If this is an interrupt handler, and the SZ bit varies, |
| and we have to push any floating point register, we need |
| to switch to the correct precision first. */ |
| if (i == FIRST_FP_REG && interrupt_handler && TARGET_FMOVD |
| && hard_reg_set_intersect_p (*mask, reg_class_contents[DF_REGS])) |
| { |
| HARD_REG_SET unsaved; |
| |
| push (FPSCR_REG); |
| COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (unsaved, *mask); |
| fpscr_set_from_mem (NORMAL_MODE (FP_MODE), unsaved); |
| skip_fpscr = 1; |
| } |
| if (i != PR_REG |
| && (i != FPSCR_REG || ! skip_fpscr) |
| && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*mask, i)) |
| { |
| /* If the ISR has RESBANK attribute assigned, don't push any of |
| the following registers - R0-R14, MACH, MACL and GBR. */ |
| if (! (sh_cfun_resbank_handler_p () |
| && ((i >= FIRST_GENERAL_REG && i < LAST_GENERAL_REG) |
| || i == MACH_REG |
| || i == MACL_REG |
| || i == GBR_REG))) |
| push (i); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Push banked registers last to improve delay slot opportunities. */ |
| if (interrupt_handler) |
| { |
| bool use_movml = false; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH2A) |
| { |
| unsigned int count = 0; |
| |
| for (i = FIRST_BANKED_REG; i <= LAST_BANKED_REG; i++) |
| if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*mask, i)) |
| count++; |
| else |
| break; |
| |
| /* Use movml when all banked registers are pushed. */ |
| if (count == LAST_BANKED_REG - FIRST_BANKED_REG + 1) |
| use_movml = true; |
| } |
| |
| if (use_movml) |
| { |
| rtx x, mem, reg, set; |
| rtx sp_reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM); |
| |
| /* We must avoid scheduling multiple store insn with another |
| insns. */ |
| emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); |
| x = gen_movml_push_banked (sp_reg); |
| x = frame_insn (x); |
| for (i = FIRST_BANKED_REG; i <= LAST_BANKED_REG; i++) |
| { |
| mem = gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, plus_constant (sp_reg, i * 4)); |
| reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, i); |
| add_reg_note (x, REG_CFA_OFFSET, gen_rtx_SET (SImode, mem, reg)); |
| } |
| |
| set = gen_rtx_SET (SImode, sp_reg, plus_constant (sp_reg, - 32)); |
| add_reg_note (x, REG_CFA_ADJUST_CFA, set); |
| emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); |
| } |
| else |
| for (i = FIRST_BANKED_REG; i <= LAST_BANKED_REG; i++) |
| if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*mask, i)) |
| push (i); |
| } |
| |
| /* Don't push PR register for an ISR with RESBANK attribute assigned. */ |
| if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*mask, PR_REG) && !sh_cfun_resbank_handler_p ()) |
| push (PR_REG); |
| } |
| |
| /* Calculate how much extra space is needed to save all callee-saved |
| target registers. |
| LIVE_REGS_MASK is the register mask calculated by calc_live_regs. */ |
| |
| static int |
| shmedia_target_regs_stack_space (HARD_REG_SET *live_regs_mask) |
| { |
| int reg; |
| int stack_space = 0; |
| int interrupt_handler = sh_cfun_interrupt_handler_p (); |
| |
| for (reg = LAST_TARGET_REG; reg >= FIRST_TARGET_REG; reg--) |
| if ((! call_really_used_regs[reg] || interrupt_handler) |
| && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*live_regs_mask, reg)) |
| /* Leave space to save this target register on the stack, |
| in case target register allocation wants to use it. */ |
| stack_space += GET_MODE_SIZE (REGISTER_NATURAL_MODE (reg)); |
| return stack_space; |
| } |
| |
| /* Decide whether we should reserve space for callee-save target registers, |
| in case target register allocation wants to use them. REGS_SAVED is |
| the space, in bytes, that is already required for register saves. |
| LIVE_REGS_MASK is the register mask calculated by calc_live_regs. */ |
| |
| static int |
| shmedia_reserve_space_for_target_registers_p (int regs_saved, |
| HARD_REG_SET *live_regs_mask) |
| { |
| if (optimize_size) |
| return 0; |
| return shmedia_target_regs_stack_space (live_regs_mask) <= regs_saved; |
| } |
| |
| /* Decide how much space to reserve for callee-save target registers |
| in case target register allocation wants to use them. |
| LIVE_REGS_MASK is the register mask calculated by calc_live_regs. */ |
| |
| static int |
| shmedia_target_regs_stack_adjust (HARD_REG_SET *live_regs_mask) |
| { |
| if (shmedia_space_reserved_for_target_registers) |
| return shmedia_target_regs_stack_space (live_regs_mask); |
| else |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Work out the registers which need to be saved, both as a mask and a |
| count of saved words. Return the count. |
| |
| If doing a pragma interrupt function, then push all regs used by the |
| function, and if we call another function (we can tell by looking at PR), |
| make sure that all the regs it clobbers are safe too. */ |
| |
| static int |
| calc_live_regs (HARD_REG_SET *live_regs_mask) |
| { |
| unsigned int reg; |
| int count; |
| tree attrs; |
| bool interrupt_or_trapa_handler, trapa_handler, interrupt_handler; |
| bool nosave_low_regs; |
| int pr_live, has_call; |
| |
| attrs = DECL_ATTRIBUTES (current_function_decl); |
| interrupt_or_trapa_handler = sh_cfun_interrupt_handler_p (); |
| trapa_handler = lookup_attribute ("trapa_handler", attrs) != NULL_TREE; |
| interrupt_handler = interrupt_or_trapa_handler && ! trapa_handler; |
| nosave_low_regs = lookup_attribute ("nosave_low_regs", attrs) != NULL_TREE; |
| |
| CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (*live_regs_mask); |
| if ((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE) && TARGET_FMOVD && interrupt_handler |
| && df_regs_ever_live_p (FPSCR_REG)) |
| target_flags &= ~MASK_FPU_SINGLE; |
| /* If we can save a lot of saves by switching to double mode, do that. */ |
| else if ((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE) && TARGET_FMOVD && TARGET_FPU_SINGLE) |
| for (count = 0, reg = FIRST_FP_REG; reg <= LAST_FP_REG; reg += 2) |
| if (df_regs_ever_live_p (reg) && df_regs_ever_live_p (reg+1) |
| && (! call_really_used_regs[reg] |
| || interrupt_handler) |
| && ++count > 2) |
| { |
| target_flags &= ~MASK_FPU_SINGLE; |
| break; |
| } |
| /* PR_MEDIA_REG is a general purpose register, thus global_alloc already |
| knows how to use it. That means the pseudo originally allocated for |
| the initial value can become the PR_MEDIA_REG hard register, as seen for |
| execute/20010122-1.c:test9. */ |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| /* ??? this function is called from initial_elimination_offset, hence we |
| can't use the result of sh_media_register_for_return here. */ |
| pr_live = sh_pr_n_sets (); |
| else |
| { |
| rtx pr_initial = has_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, PR_REG); |
| pr_live = (pr_initial |
| ? (!REG_P (pr_initial) |
| || REGNO (pr_initial) != (PR_REG)) |
| : df_regs_ever_live_p (PR_REG)); |
| /* For Shcompact, if not optimizing, we end up with a memory reference |
| using the return address pointer for __builtin_return_address even |
| though there is no actual need to put the PR register on the stack. */ |
| pr_live |= df_regs_ever_live_p (RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM); |
| } |
| /* Force PR to be live if the prologue has to call the SHmedia |
| argument decoder or register saver. */ |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && ((crtl->args.info.call_cookie |
| & ~ CALL_COOKIE_RET_TRAMP (1)) |
| || crtl->saves_all_registers)) |
| pr_live = 1; |
| has_call = TARGET_SHMEDIA ? ! leaf_function_p () : pr_live; |
| for (count = 0, reg = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; reg-- != 0; ) |
| { |
| if (reg == (TARGET_SHMEDIA ? PR_MEDIA_REG : PR_REG) |
| ? pr_live |
| : interrupt_handler |
| ? (/* Need to save all the regs ever live. */ |
| (df_regs_ever_live_p (reg) |
| || (call_really_used_regs[reg] |
| && (! fixed_regs[reg] || reg == MACH_REG || reg == MACL_REG |
| || reg == PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM) |
| && has_call) |
| || (TARGET_SHMEDIA && has_call |
| && REGISTER_NATURAL_MODE (reg) == SImode |
| && (GENERAL_REGISTER_P (reg) || TARGET_REGISTER_P (reg)))) |
| && reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && reg != ARG_POINTER_REGNUM |
| && reg != RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM |
| && reg != T_REG && reg != GBR_REG |
| /* Push fpscr only on targets which have FPU */ |
| && (reg != FPSCR_REG || TARGET_FPU_ANY)) |
| : (/* Only push those regs which are used and need to be saved. */ |
| (TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && flag_pic |
| && crtl->args.info.call_cookie |
| && reg == PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM) |
| || (df_regs_ever_live_p (reg) |
| && ((!call_really_used_regs[reg] |
| && !(reg != PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM |
| && fixed_regs[reg] && call_used_regs[reg])) |
| || (trapa_handler && reg == FPSCR_REG && TARGET_FPU_ANY))) |
| || (crtl->calls_eh_return |
| && (reg == EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (0) |
| || reg == EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (1) |
| || reg == EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (2) |
| || reg == EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (3))) |
| || ((reg == MACL_REG || reg == MACH_REG) |
| && df_regs_ever_live_p (reg) |
| && sh_cfun_attr_renesas_p ()) |
| )) |
| { |
| SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*live_regs_mask, reg); |
| count += GET_MODE_SIZE (REGISTER_NATURAL_MODE (reg)); |
| |
| if ((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE || TARGET_SH5) && TARGET_FMOVD |
| && GET_MODE_CLASS (REGISTER_NATURAL_MODE (reg)) == MODE_FLOAT) |
| { |
| if (FP_REGISTER_P (reg)) |
| { |
| if (! TARGET_FPU_SINGLE && ! df_regs_ever_live_p (reg ^ 1)) |
| { |
| SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*live_regs_mask, (reg ^ 1)); |
| count += GET_MODE_SIZE (REGISTER_NATURAL_MODE (reg ^ 1)); |
| } |
| } |
| else if (XD_REGISTER_P (reg)) |
| { |
| /* Must switch to double mode to access these registers. */ |
| target_flags &= ~MASK_FPU_SINGLE; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| if (nosave_low_regs && reg == R8_REG) |
| break; |
| } |
| /* If we have a target register optimization pass after prologue / epilogue |
| threading, we need to assume all target registers will be live even if |
| they aren't now. */ |
| if (flag_branch_target_load_optimize2 |
| && TARGET_SAVE_ALL_TARGET_REGS |
| && shmedia_space_reserved_for_target_registers) |
| for (reg = LAST_TARGET_REG; reg >= FIRST_TARGET_REG; reg--) |
| if ((! call_really_used_regs[reg] || interrupt_handler) |
| && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*live_regs_mask, reg)) |
| { |
| SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*live_regs_mask, reg); |
| count += GET_MODE_SIZE (REGISTER_NATURAL_MODE (reg)); |
| } |
| /* If this is an interrupt handler, we don't have any call-clobbered |
| registers we can conveniently use for target register save/restore. |
| Make sure we save at least one general purpose register when we need |
| to save target registers. */ |
| if (interrupt_handler |
| && hard_reg_set_intersect_p (*live_regs_mask, |
| reg_class_contents[TARGET_REGS]) |
| && ! hard_reg_set_intersect_p (*live_regs_mask, |
| reg_class_contents[GENERAL_REGS])) |
| { |
| SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*live_regs_mask, R0_REG); |
| count += GET_MODE_SIZE (REGISTER_NATURAL_MODE (R0_REG)); |
| } |
| |
| return count; |
| } |
| |
| /* Code to generate prologue and epilogue sequences */ |
| |
| /* PUSHED is the number of bytes that are being pushed on the |
| stack for register saves. Return the frame size, padded |
| appropriately so that the stack stays properly aligned. */ |
| static HOST_WIDE_INT |
| rounded_frame_size (int pushed) |
| { |
| HOST_WIDE_INT size = get_frame_size (); |
| HOST_WIDE_INT align = STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT; |
| |
| if (ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS) |
| size += crtl->outgoing_args_size; |
| |
| return ((size + pushed + align - 1) & -align) - pushed; |
| } |
| |
| /* Choose a call-clobbered target-branch register that remains |
| unchanged along the whole function. We set it up as the return |
| value in the prologue. */ |
| int |
| sh_media_register_for_return (void) |
| { |
| int regno; |
| int tr0_used; |
| |
| if (! current_function_is_leaf) |
| return -1; |
| if (lookup_attribute ("interrupt_handler", |
| DECL_ATTRIBUTES (current_function_decl))) |
| return -1; |
| if (sh_cfun_interrupt_handler_p ()) |
| return -1; |
| |
| tr0_used = flag_pic && df_regs_ever_live_p (PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM); |
| |
| for (regno = FIRST_TARGET_REG + tr0_used; regno <= LAST_TARGET_REG; regno++) |
| if (call_really_used_regs[regno] && ! df_regs_ever_live_p (regno)) |
| return regno; |
| |
| return -1; |
| } |
| |
| /* The maximum registers we need to save are: |
| - 62 general purpose registers (r15 is stack pointer, r63 is zero) |
| - 32 floating point registers (for each pair, we save none, |
| one single precision value, or a double precision value). |
| - 8 target registers |
| - add 1 entry for a delimiter. */ |
| #define MAX_SAVED_REGS (62+32+8) |
| |
| typedef struct save_entry_s |
| { |
| unsigned char reg; |
| unsigned char mode; |
| short offset; |
| } save_entry; |
| |
| #define MAX_TEMPS 4 |
| |
| /* There will be a delimiter entry with VOIDmode both at the start and the |
| end of a filled in schedule. The end delimiter has the offset of the |
| save with the smallest (i.e. most negative) offset. */ |
| typedef struct save_schedule_s |
| { |
| save_entry entries[MAX_SAVED_REGS + 2]; |
| int temps[MAX_TEMPS+1]; |
| } save_schedule; |
| |
| /* Fill in SCHEDULE according to LIVE_REGS_MASK. If RESTORE is nonzero, |
| use reverse order. Returns the last entry written to (not counting |
| the delimiter). OFFSET_BASE is a number to be added to all offset |
| entries. */ |
| |
| static save_entry * |
| sh5_schedule_saves (HARD_REG_SET *live_regs_mask, save_schedule *schedule, |
| int offset_base) |
| { |
| int align, i; |
| save_entry *entry = schedule->entries; |
| int tmpx = 0; |
| int offset; |
| |
| if (! current_function_interrupt) |
| for (i = FIRST_GENERAL_REG; tmpx < MAX_TEMPS && i <= LAST_GENERAL_REG; i++) |
| if (call_really_used_regs[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && i != PR_MEDIA_REG |
| && ! FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (i) |
| && i != FIRST_RET_REG |
| && ! (cfun->static_chain_decl != NULL && i == STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM) |
| && ! (crtl->calls_eh_return |
| && (i == EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_REGNO |
| || ((unsigned) i >= EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (0) |
| && (unsigned) i <= EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (3))))) |
| schedule->temps[tmpx++] = i; |
| entry->reg = -1; |
| entry->mode = VOIDmode; |
| entry->offset = offset_base; |
| entry++; |
| /* We loop twice: first, we save 8-byte aligned registers in the |
| higher addresses, that are known to be aligned. Then, we |
| proceed to saving 32-bit registers that don't need 8-byte |
| alignment. |
| If this is an interrupt function, all registers that need saving |
| need to be saved in full. moreover, we need to postpone saving |
| target registers till we have saved some general purpose registers |
| we can then use as scratch registers. */ |
| offset = offset_base; |
| for (align = 1; align >= 0; align--) |
| { |
| for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - 1; i >= 0; i--) |
| if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*live_regs_mask, i)) |
| { |
| enum machine_mode mode = REGISTER_NATURAL_MODE (i); |
| int reg = i; |
| |
| if (current_function_interrupt) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_REGISTER_P (i)) |
| continue; |
| if (GENERAL_REGISTER_P (i)) |
| mode = DImode; |
| } |
| if (mode == SFmode && (i % 2) == 1 |
| && ! TARGET_FPU_SINGLE && FP_REGISTER_P (i) |
| && (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*live_regs_mask, (i ^ 1)))) |
| { |
| mode = DFmode; |
| i--; |
| reg--; |
| } |
| |
| /* If we're doing the aligned pass and this is not aligned, |
| or we're doing the unaligned pass and this is aligned, |
| skip it. */ |
| if ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) % (STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0) |
| != align) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (current_function_interrupt |
| && GENERAL_REGISTER_P (i) |
| && tmpx < MAX_TEMPS) |
| schedule->temps[tmpx++] = i; |
| |
| offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode); |
| entry->reg = i; |
| entry->mode = mode; |
| entry->offset = offset; |
| entry++; |
| } |
| if (align && current_function_interrupt) |
| for (i = LAST_TARGET_REG; i >= FIRST_TARGET_REG; i--) |
| if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*live_regs_mask, i)) |
| { |
| offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (DImode); |
| entry->reg = i; |
| entry->mode = DImode; |
| entry->offset = offset; |
| entry++; |
| } |
| } |
| entry->reg = -1; |
| entry->mode = VOIDmode; |
| entry->offset = offset; |
| schedule->temps[tmpx] = -1; |
| return entry - 1; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| sh_expand_prologue (void) |
| { |
| HARD_REG_SET live_regs_mask; |
| int d, i; |
| int d_rounding = 0; |
| int save_flags = target_flags; |
| int pretend_args; |
| int stack_usage; |
| tree sp_switch_attr |
| = lookup_attribute ("sp_switch", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (current_function_decl)); |
| |
| current_function_interrupt = sh_cfun_interrupt_handler_p (); |
| |
| /* We have pretend args if we had an object sent partially in registers |
| and partially on the stack, e.g. a large structure. */ |
| pretend_args = crtl->args.pretend_args_size; |
| if (TARGET_VARARGS_PRETEND_ARGS (current_function_decl) |
| && (NPARM_REGS(SImode) |
| > crtl->args.info.arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_INT])) |
| pretend_args = 0; |
| |
| output_stack_adjust (-pretend_args |
| - crtl->args.info.stack_regs * 8, |
| stack_pointer_rtx, 0, NULL, true); |
| stack_usage = pretend_args + crtl->args.info.stack_regs * 8; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT && flag_pic && crtl->args.info.call_cookie) |
| /* We're going to use the PIC register to load the address of the |
| incoming-argument decoder and/or of the return trampoline from |
| the GOT, so make sure the PIC register is preserved and |
| initialized. */ |
| df_set_regs_ever_live (PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM, true); |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && (crtl->args.info.call_cookie & ~ CALL_COOKIE_RET_TRAMP(1))) |
| { |
| int reg; |
| |
| /* First, make all registers with incoming arguments that will |
| be pushed onto the stack live, so that register renaming |
| doesn't overwrite them. */ |
| for (reg = 0; reg < NPARM_REGS (SImode); reg++) |
| if (CALL_COOKIE_STACKSEQ_GET (crtl->args.info.call_cookie) |
| >= NPARM_REGS (SImode) - reg) |
| for (; reg < NPARM_REGS (SImode); reg++) |
| emit_insn (gen_shcompact_preserve_incoming_args |
| (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, FIRST_PARM_REG + reg))); |
| else if (CALL_COOKIE_INT_REG_GET |
| (crtl->args.info.call_cookie, reg) == 1) |
| emit_insn (gen_shcompact_preserve_incoming_args |
| (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, FIRST_PARM_REG + reg))); |
| |
| emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, MACL_REG), |
| stack_pointer_rtx); |
| emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, R0_REG), |
| GEN_INT (crtl->args.info.call_cookie)); |
| emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, MACH_REG), |
| gen_rtx_REG (SImode, R0_REG)); |
| } |
| else if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| int tr = sh_media_register_for_return (); |
| |
| if (tr >= 0) |
| emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, tr), |
| gen_rtx_REG (DImode, PR_MEDIA_REG)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Emit the code for SETUP_VARARGS. */ |
| if (cfun->stdarg) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_VARARGS_PRETEND_ARGS (current_function_decl)) |
| { |
| /* Push arg regs as if they'd been provided by caller in stack. */ |
| for (i = 0; i < NPARM_REGS(SImode); i++) |
| { |
| int rn = NPARM_REGS(SImode) + FIRST_PARM_REG - i - 1; |
| |
| if (i >= (NPARM_REGS(SImode) |
| - crtl->args.info.arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_INT] |
| )) |
| break; |
| push (rn); |
| stack_usage += GET_MODE_SIZE (SImode); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* If we're supposed to switch stacks at function entry, do so now. */ |
| if (sp_switch_attr) |
| { |
| rtx lab, newsrc; |
| /* The argument specifies a variable holding the address of the |
| stack the interrupt function should switch to/from at entry/exit. */ |
| tree arg = TREE_VALUE ( TREE_VALUE (sp_switch_attr)); |
| const char *s |
| = ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (arg)); |
| rtx sp_switch = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, s); |
| |
| lab = add_constant (sp_switch, SImode, 0); |
| newsrc = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, lab); |
| newsrc = gen_const_mem (SImode, newsrc); |
| |
| emit_insn (gen_sp_switch_1 (newsrc)); |
| } |
| |
| d = calc_live_regs (&live_regs_mask); |
| /* ??? Maybe we could save some switching if we can move a mode switch |
| that already happens to be at the function start into the prologue. */ |
| if (target_flags != save_flags && ! current_function_interrupt) |
| emit_insn (gen_toggle_sz ()); |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| int offset_base, offset; |
| rtx r0 = NULL_RTX; |
| int offset_in_r0 = -1; |
| int sp_in_r0 = 0; |
| int tregs_space = shmedia_target_regs_stack_adjust (&live_regs_mask); |
| int total_size, save_size; |
| save_schedule schedule; |
| save_entry *entry; |
| int *tmp_pnt; |
| |
| if (call_really_used_regs[R0_REG] && ! fixed_regs[R0_REG] |
| && ! current_function_interrupt) |
| r0 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, R0_REG); |
| |
| /* D is the actual number of bytes that we need for saving registers, |
| however, in initial_elimination_offset we have committed to using |
| an additional TREGS_SPACE amount of bytes - in order to keep both |
| addresses to arguments supplied by the caller and local variables |
| valid, we must keep this gap. Place it between the incoming |
| arguments and the actually saved registers in a bid to optimize |
| locality of reference. */ |
| total_size = d + tregs_space; |
| total_size += rounded_frame_size (total_size); |
| save_size = total_size - rounded_frame_size (d); |
| if (save_size % (STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)) |
| d_rounding = ((STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT) |
| - save_size % (STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)); |
| |
| /* If adjusting the stack in a single step costs nothing extra, do so. |
| I.e. either if a single addi is enough, or we need a movi anyway, |
| and we don't exceed the maximum offset range (the test for the |
| latter is conservative for simplicity). */ |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && (CONST_OK_FOR_I10 (-total_size) |
| || (! CONST_OK_FOR_I10 (-(save_size + d_rounding)) |
| && total_size <= 2044))) |
| d_rounding = total_size - save_size; |
| |
| offset_base = d + d_rounding; |
| |
| output_stack_adjust (-(save_size + d_rounding), stack_pointer_rtx, |
| 0, NULL, true); |
| stack_usage += save_size + d_rounding; |
| |
| sh5_schedule_saves (&live_regs_mask, &schedule, offset_base); |
| tmp_pnt = schedule.temps; |
| for (entry = &schedule.entries[1]; entry->mode != VOIDmode; entry++) |
| { |
| enum machine_mode mode = (enum machine_mode) entry->mode; |
| unsigned int reg = entry->reg; |
| rtx reg_rtx, mem_rtx, pre_dec = NULL_RTX; |
| rtx orig_reg_rtx; |
| |
| offset = entry->offset; |
| |
| reg_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (mode, reg); |
| |
| mem_rtx = gen_frame_mem (mode, |
| gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, |
| stack_pointer_rtx, |
| GEN_INT (offset))); |
| |
| if (!memory_address_p (mode, XEXP (mem_rtx, 0))) |
| { |
| gcc_assert (r0); |
| mem_rtx = NULL_RTX; |
| } |
| |
| if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT |
| && (offset_in_r0 - offset == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) |
| || mem_rtx == NULL_RTX |
| || reg == PR_REG || SPECIAL_REGISTER_P (reg))) |
| { |
| pre_dec = gen_frame_mem (mode, gen_rtx_PRE_DEC (Pmode, r0)); |
| |
| if (!memory_address_p (mode, XEXP (pre_dec, 0))) |
| pre_dec = NULL_RTX; |
| else |
| { |
| mem_rtx = NULL_RTX; |
| offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (mode); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (mem_rtx != NULL_RTX) |
| goto addr_ok; |
| |
| if (offset_in_r0 == -1) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (r0, GEN_INT (offset)); |
| offset_in_r0 = offset; |
| } |
| else if (offset != offset_in_r0) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (r0, |
| gen_rtx_PLUS |
| (Pmode, r0, |
| GEN_INT (offset - offset_in_r0))); |
| offset_in_r0 += offset - offset_in_r0; |
| } |
| |
| if (pre_dec != NULL_RTX) |
| { |
| if (! sp_in_r0) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (r0, |
| gen_rtx_PLUS |
| (Pmode, r0, stack_pointer_rtx)); |
| sp_in_r0 = 1; |
| } |
| |
| offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode); |
| offset_in_r0 -= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode); |
| |
| mem_rtx = pre_dec; |
| } |
| else if (sp_in_r0) |
| mem_rtx = gen_frame_mem (mode, r0); |
| else |
| mem_rtx = gen_frame_mem (mode, |
| gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, |
| stack_pointer_rtx, |
| r0)); |
| |
| /* We must not use an r0-based address for target-branch |
| registers or for special registers without pre-dec |
| memory addresses, since we store their values in r0 |
| first. */ |
| gcc_assert (!TARGET_REGISTER_P (reg) |
| && ((reg != PR_REG && !SPECIAL_REGISTER_P (reg)) |
| || mem_rtx == pre_dec)); |
| |
| addr_ok: |
| orig_reg_rtx = reg_rtx; |
| if (TARGET_REGISTER_P (reg) |
| || ((reg == PR_REG || SPECIAL_REGISTER_P (reg)) |
| && mem_rtx != pre_dec)) |
| { |
| rtx tmp_reg = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (reg_rtx), *tmp_pnt); |
| |
| emit_move_insn (tmp_reg, reg_rtx); |
| |
| if (REGNO (tmp_reg) == R0_REG) |
| { |
| offset_in_r0 = -1; |
| sp_in_r0 = 0; |
| gcc_assert (!refers_to_regno_p |
| (R0_REG, R0_REG+1, mem_rtx, (rtx *) 0)); |
| } |
| |
| if (*++tmp_pnt <= 0) |
| tmp_pnt = schedule.temps; |
| |
| reg_rtx = tmp_reg; |
| } |
| { |
| rtx insn; |
| |
| /* Mark as interesting for dwarf cfi generator */ |
| insn = emit_move_insn (mem_rtx, reg_rtx); |
| RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1; |
| /* If we use an intermediate register for the save, we can't |
| describe this exactly in cfi as a copy of the to-be-saved |
| register into the temporary register and then the temporary |
| register on the stack, because the temporary register can |
| have a different natural size than the to-be-saved register. |
| Thus, we gloss over the intermediate copy and pretend we do |
| a direct save from the to-be-saved register. */ |
| if (REGNO (reg_rtx) != reg) |
| { |
| rtx set; |
| |
| set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, mem_rtx, orig_reg_rtx); |
| add_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, set); |
| } |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT && (offset_in_r0 != -1)) |
| { |
| rtx reg_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (mode, reg); |
| rtx set; |
| rtx mem_rtx = gen_frame_mem (mode, |
| gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, |
| stack_pointer_rtx, |
| GEN_INT (offset))); |
| |
| set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, mem_rtx, reg_rtx); |
| add_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, set); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| gcc_assert (entry->offset == d_rounding); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| push_regs (&live_regs_mask, current_function_interrupt); |
| stack_usage += d; |
| } |
| |
| if (flag_pic && df_regs_ever_live_p (PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM)) |
| emit_insn (gen_GOTaddr2picreg ()); |
| |
| if (SHMEDIA_REGS_STACK_ADJUST ()) |
| { |
| /* This must NOT go through the PLT, otherwise mach and macl |
| may be clobbered. */ |
| function_symbol (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, R0_REG), |
| (TARGET_FPU_ANY |
| ? "__GCC_push_shmedia_regs" |
| : "__GCC_push_shmedia_regs_nofpu"), SFUNC_GOT); |
| emit_insn (gen_shmedia_save_restore_regs_compact |
| (GEN_INT (-SHMEDIA_REGS_STACK_ADJUST ()))); |
| } |
| |
| if (target_flags != save_flags && ! current_function_interrupt) |
| emit_insn (gen_toggle_sz ()); |
| |
| target_flags = save_flags; |
| |
| output_stack_adjust (-rounded_frame_size (d) + d_rounding, |
| stack_pointer_rtx, 0, NULL, true); |
| stack_usage += rounded_frame_size (d) - d_rounding; |
| |
| if (frame_pointer_needed) |
| frame_insn (GEN_MOV (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx)); |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && (crtl->args.info.call_cookie & ~ CALL_COOKIE_RET_TRAMP(1))) |
| { |
| /* This must NOT go through the PLT, otherwise mach and macl |
| may be clobbered. */ |
| function_symbol (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, R0_REG), |
| "__GCC_shcompact_incoming_args", SFUNC_GOT); |
| emit_insn (gen_shcompact_incoming_args ()); |
| } |
| |
| if (flag_stack_usage_info) |
| current_function_static_stack_size = stack_usage; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| sh_expand_epilogue (bool sibcall_p) |
| { |
| HARD_REG_SET live_regs_mask; |
| int d, i; |
| int d_rounding = 0; |
| |
| int save_flags = target_flags; |
| int frame_size, save_size; |
| int fpscr_deferred = 0; |
| int e = sibcall_p ? -1 : 1; |
| |
| d = calc_live_regs (&live_regs_mask); |
| |
| save_size = d; |
| frame_size = rounded_frame_size (d); |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| int tregs_space = shmedia_target_regs_stack_adjust (&live_regs_mask); |
| int total_size; |
| if (d % (STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)) |
| d_rounding = ((STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT) |
| - d % (STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)); |
| |
| total_size = d + tregs_space; |
| total_size += rounded_frame_size (total_size); |
| save_size = total_size - frame_size; |
| |
| /* If adjusting the stack in a single step costs nothing extra, do so. |
| I.e. either if a single addi is enough, or we need a movi anyway, |
| and we don't exceed the maximum offset range (the test for the |
| latter is conservative for simplicity). */ |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && ! frame_pointer_needed |
| && (CONST_OK_FOR_I10 (total_size) |
| || (! CONST_OK_FOR_I10 (save_size + d_rounding) |
| && total_size <= 2044))) |
| d_rounding = frame_size; |
| |
| frame_size -= d_rounding; |
| } |
| |
| if (frame_pointer_needed) |
| { |
| /* We must avoid scheduling the epilogue with previous basic blocks. |
| See PR/18032 and PR/40313. */ |
| emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); |
| output_stack_adjust (frame_size, hard_frame_pointer_rtx, e, |
| &live_regs_mask, false); |
| |
| /* We must avoid moving the stack pointer adjustment past code |
| which reads from the local frame, else an interrupt could |
| occur after the SP adjustment and clobber data in the local |
| frame. */ |
| emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); |
| emit_insn (GEN_MOV (stack_pointer_rtx, hard_frame_pointer_rtx)); |
| } |
| else if (frame_size) |
| { |
| /* We must avoid moving the stack pointer adjustment past code |
| which reads from the local frame, else an interrupt could |
| occur after the SP adjustment and clobber data in the local |
| frame. */ |
| emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); |
| output_stack_adjust (frame_size, stack_pointer_rtx, e, |
| &live_regs_mask, false); |
| } |
| |
| if (SHMEDIA_REGS_STACK_ADJUST ()) |
| { |
| function_symbol (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, R0_REG), |
| (TARGET_FPU_ANY |
| ? "__GCC_pop_shmedia_regs" |
| : "__GCC_pop_shmedia_regs_nofpu"), SFUNC_GOT); |
| /* This must NOT go through the PLT, otherwise mach and macl |
| may be clobbered. */ |
| emit_insn (gen_shmedia_save_restore_regs_compact |
| (GEN_INT (SHMEDIA_REGS_STACK_ADJUST ()))); |
| } |
| |
| /* Pop all the registers. */ |
| |
| if (target_flags != save_flags && ! current_function_interrupt) |
| emit_insn (gen_toggle_sz ()); |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| int offset_base, offset; |
| int offset_in_r0 = -1; |
| int sp_in_r0 = 0; |
| rtx r0 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, R0_REG); |
| save_schedule schedule; |
| save_entry *entry; |
| int *tmp_pnt; |
| |
| entry = sh5_schedule_saves (&live_regs_mask, &schedule, d_rounding); |
| offset_base = -entry[1].offset + d_rounding; |
| tmp_pnt = schedule.temps; |
| for (; entry->mode != VOIDmode; entry--) |
| { |
| enum machine_mode mode = (enum machine_mode) entry->mode; |
| int reg = entry->reg; |
| rtx reg_rtx, mem_rtx, post_inc = NULL_RTX; |
| |
| offset = offset_base + entry->offset; |
| reg_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (mode, reg); |
| |
| mem_rtx = gen_frame_mem (mode, |
| gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, |
| stack_pointer_rtx, |
| GEN_INT (offset))); |
| |
| if (!memory_address_p (mode, XEXP (mem_rtx, 0))) |
| mem_rtx = NULL_RTX; |
| |
| if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT |
| && (offset == offset_in_r0 |
| || (offset + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != d + d_rounding |
| && mem_rtx == NULL_RTX) |
| || reg == PR_REG || SPECIAL_REGISTER_P (reg))) |
| { |
| post_inc = gen_frame_mem (mode, gen_rtx_POST_INC (Pmode, r0)); |
| |
| if (!memory_address_p (mode, XEXP (post_inc, 0))) |
| post_inc = NULL_RTX; |
| else |
| mem_rtx = NULL_RTX; |
| } |
| |
| if (mem_rtx != NULL_RTX) |
| goto addr_ok; |
| |
| if (offset_in_r0 == -1) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (r0, GEN_INT (offset)); |
| offset_in_r0 = offset; |
| } |
| else if (offset != offset_in_r0) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (r0, |
| gen_rtx_PLUS |
| (Pmode, r0, |
| GEN_INT (offset - offset_in_r0))); |
| offset_in_r0 += offset - offset_in_r0; |
| } |
| |
| if (post_inc != NULL_RTX) |
| { |
| if (! sp_in_r0) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (r0, |
| gen_rtx_PLUS |
| (Pmode, r0, stack_pointer_rtx)); |
| sp_in_r0 = 1; |
| } |
| |
| mem_rtx = post_inc; |
| |
| offset_in_r0 += GET_MODE_SIZE (mode); |
| } |
| else if (sp_in_r0) |
| mem_rtx = gen_frame_mem (mode, r0); |
| else |
| mem_rtx = gen_frame_mem (mode, |
| gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, |
| stack_pointer_rtx, |
| r0)); |
| |
| gcc_assert ((reg != PR_REG && !SPECIAL_REGISTER_P (reg)) |
| || mem_rtx == post_inc); |
| |
| addr_ok: |
| if ((reg == PR_REG || SPECIAL_REGISTER_P (reg)) |
| && mem_rtx != post_inc) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (r0, mem_rtx); |
| mem_rtx = r0; |
| } |
| else if (TARGET_REGISTER_P (reg)) |
| { |
| rtx tmp_reg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, *tmp_pnt); |
| |
| /* Give the scheduler a bit of freedom by using up to |
| MAX_TEMPS registers in a round-robin fashion. */ |
| emit_move_insn (tmp_reg, mem_rtx); |
| mem_rtx = tmp_reg; |
| if (*++tmp_pnt < 0) |
| tmp_pnt = schedule.temps; |
| } |
| |
| emit_move_insn (reg_rtx, mem_rtx); |
| } |
| |
| gcc_assert (entry->offset + offset_base == d + d_rounding); |
| } |
| else /* ! TARGET_SH5 */ |
| { |
| int last_reg; |
| |
| save_size = 0; |
| /* For an ISR with RESBANK attribute assigned, don't pop PR |
| register. */ |
| if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (live_regs_mask, PR_REG) |
| && !sh_cfun_resbank_handler_p ()) |
| { |
| if (!frame_pointer_needed) |
| emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); |
| pop (PR_REG); |
| } |
| |
| /* Banked registers are popped first to avoid being scheduled in the |
| delay slot. RTE switches banks before the ds instruction. */ |
| if (current_function_interrupt) |
| { |
| bool use_movml = false; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH2A) |
| { |
| unsigned int count = 0; |
| |
| for (i = FIRST_BANKED_REG; i <= LAST_BANKED_REG; i++) |
| if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (live_regs_mask, i)) |
| count++; |
| else |
| break; |
| |
| /* Use movml when all banked register are poped. */ |
| if (count == LAST_BANKED_REG - FIRST_BANKED_REG + 1) |
| use_movml = true; |
| } |
| |
| if (use_movml) |
| { |
| rtx sp_reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM); |
| |
| /* We must avoid scheduling multiple load insn with another |
| insns. */ |
| emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); |
| emit_insn (gen_movml_pop_banked (sp_reg)); |
| emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); |
| } |
| else |
| for (i = LAST_BANKED_REG; i >= FIRST_BANKED_REG; i--) |
| if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (live_regs_mask, i)) |
| pop (i); |
| |
| last_reg = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - LAST_BANKED_REG - 1; |
| } |
| else |
| last_reg = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < last_reg; i++) |
| { |
| int j = (FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - 1) - i; |
| |
| if (j == FPSCR_REG && current_function_interrupt && TARGET_FMOVD |
| && hard_reg_set_intersect_p (live_regs_mask, |
| reg_class_contents[DF_REGS])) |
| fpscr_deferred = 1; |
| /* For an ISR with RESBANK attribute assigned, don't pop |
| following registers, R0-R14, MACH, MACL and GBR. */ |
| else if (j != PR_REG && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (live_regs_mask, j) |
| && ! (sh_cfun_resbank_handler_p () |
| && ((j >= FIRST_GENERAL_REG |
| && j < LAST_GENERAL_REG) |
| || j == MACH_REG |
| || j == MACL_REG |
| || j == GBR_REG))) |
| pop (j); |
| |
| if (j == FIRST_FP_REG && fpscr_deferred) |
| pop (FPSCR_REG); |
| } |
| } |
| if (target_flags != save_flags && ! current_function_interrupt) |
| emit_insn (gen_toggle_sz ()); |
| target_flags = save_flags; |
| |
| output_stack_adjust (crtl->args.pretend_args_size |
| + save_size + d_rounding |
| + crtl->args.info.stack_regs * 8, |
| stack_pointer_rtx, e, NULL, false); |
| |
| if (crtl->calls_eh_return) |
| emit_insn (GEN_ADD3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx, |
| EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX)); |
| |
| /* Switch back to the normal stack if necessary. */ |
| if (lookup_attribute ("sp_switch", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (current_function_decl))) |
| emit_insn (gen_sp_switch_2 ()); |
| |
| /* Tell flow the insn that pops PR isn't dead. */ |
| /* PR_REG will never be live in SHmedia mode, and we don't need to |
| USE PR_MEDIA_REG, since it will be explicitly copied to TR0_REG |
| by the return pattern. */ |
| if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (live_regs_mask, PR_REG)) |
| emit_use (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, PR_REG)); |
| } |
| |
| static int sh_need_epilogue_known = 0; |
| |
| int |
| sh_need_epilogue (void) |
| { |
| if (! sh_need_epilogue_known) |
| { |
| rtx epilogue; |
| |
| start_sequence (); |
| sh_expand_epilogue (0); |
| epilogue = get_insns (); |
| end_sequence (); |
| sh_need_epilogue_known = (epilogue == NULL ? -1 : 1); |
| } |
| return sh_need_epilogue_known > 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Emit code to change the current function's return address to RA. |
| TEMP is available as a scratch register, if needed. */ |
| |
| void |
| sh_set_return_address (rtx ra, rtx tmp) |
| { |
| HARD_REG_SET live_regs_mask; |
| int d; |
| int pr_reg = TARGET_SHMEDIA ? PR_MEDIA_REG : PR_REG; |
| int pr_offset; |
| |
| d = calc_live_regs (&live_regs_mask); |
| |
| /* If pr_reg isn't life, we can set it (or the register given in |
| sh_media_register_for_return) directly. */ |
| if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (live_regs_mask, pr_reg)) |
| { |
| rtx rr; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| int rr_regno = sh_media_register_for_return (); |
| |
| if (rr_regno < 0) |
| rr_regno = pr_reg; |
| |
| rr = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, rr_regno); |
| } |
| else |
| rr = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, pr_reg); |
| |
| emit_insn (GEN_MOV (rr, ra)); |
| /* Tell flow the register for return isn't dead. */ |
| emit_use (rr); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| int offset; |
| save_schedule schedule; |
| save_entry *entry; |
| |
| entry = sh5_schedule_saves (&live_regs_mask, &schedule, 0); |
| offset = entry[1].offset; |
| for (; entry->mode != VOIDmode; entry--) |
| if (entry->reg == pr_reg) |
| goto found; |
| |
| /* We can't find pr register. */ |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| |
| found: |
| offset = entry->offset - offset; |
| pr_offset = (rounded_frame_size (d) + offset |
| + SHMEDIA_REGS_STACK_ADJUST ()); |
| } |
| else |
| pr_offset = rounded_frame_size (d); |
| |
| emit_insn (GEN_MOV (tmp, GEN_INT (pr_offset))); |
| |
| if (frame_pointer_needed) |
| emit_insn (GEN_ADD3 (tmp, tmp, hard_frame_pointer_rtx)); |
| else |
| emit_insn (GEN_ADD3 (tmp, tmp, stack_pointer_rtx)); |
| |
| tmp = gen_frame_mem (Pmode, tmp); |
| emit_insn (GEN_MOV (tmp, ra)); |
| /* Tell this store isn't dead. */ |
| emit_use (tmp); |
| } |
| |
| /* Clear variables at function end. */ |
| |
| static void |
| sh_output_function_epilogue (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| sh_need_epilogue_known = 0; |
| } |
| |
| static rtx |
| sh_builtin_saveregs (void) |
| { |
| /* First unnamed integer register. */ |
| int first_intreg = crtl->args.info.arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_INT]; |
| /* Number of integer registers we need to save. */ |
| int n_intregs = MAX (0, NPARM_REGS (SImode) - first_intreg); |
| /* First unnamed SFmode float reg */ |
| int first_floatreg = crtl->args.info.arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_FLOAT]; |
| /* Number of SFmode float regs to save. */ |
| int n_floatregs = MAX (0, NPARM_REGS (SFmode) - first_floatreg); |
| rtx regbuf, fpregs; |
| int bufsize, regno; |
| alias_set_type alias_set; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| if (n_intregs) |
| { |
| int pushregs = n_intregs; |
| |
| while (pushregs < NPARM_REGS (SImode) - 1 |
| && (CALL_COOKIE_INT_REG_GET |
| (crtl->args.info.call_cookie, |
| NPARM_REGS (SImode) - pushregs) |
| == 1)) |
| { |
| crtl->args.info.call_cookie |
| &= ~ CALL_COOKIE_INT_REG (NPARM_REGS (SImode) |
| - pushregs, 1); |
| pushregs++; |
| } |
| |
| if (pushregs == NPARM_REGS (SImode)) |
| crtl->args.info.call_cookie |
| |= (CALL_COOKIE_INT_REG (0, 1) |
| | CALL_COOKIE_STACKSEQ (pushregs - 1)); |
| else |
| crtl->args.info.call_cookie |
| |= CALL_COOKIE_STACKSEQ (pushregs); |
| |
| crtl->args.pretend_args_size += 8 * n_intregs; |
| } |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT) |
| return const0_rtx; |
| } |
| |
| if (! TARGET_SH2E && ! TARGET_SH4 && ! TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| error ("__builtin_saveregs not supported by this subtarget"); |
| return const0_rtx; |
| } |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| n_floatregs = 0; |
| |
| /* Allocate block of memory for the regs. */ |
| /* ??? If n_intregs + n_floatregs == 0, should we allocate at least 1 byte? |
| Or can assign_stack_local accept a 0 SIZE argument? */ |
| bufsize = (n_intregs * UNITS_PER_WORD) + (n_floatregs * UNITS_PER_WORD); |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| regbuf = gen_frame_mem (BLKmode, gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)); |
| else if (n_floatregs & 1) |
| { |
| rtx addr; |
| |
| regbuf = assign_stack_local (BLKmode, bufsize + UNITS_PER_WORD, 0); |
| addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (regbuf, 0)); |
| emit_insn (gen_iorsi3 (addr, addr, GEN_INT (UNITS_PER_WORD))); |
| regbuf = change_address (regbuf, BLKmode, addr); |
| } |
| else if (STACK_BOUNDARY < 64 && TARGET_FPU_DOUBLE && n_floatregs) |
| { |
| rtx addr, mask; |
| |
| regbuf = assign_stack_local (BLKmode, bufsize + UNITS_PER_WORD, 0); |
| addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, plus_constant (XEXP (regbuf, 0), 4)); |
| mask = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, GEN_INT (-8)); |
| emit_insn (gen_andsi3 (addr, addr, mask)); |
| regbuf = change_address (regbuf, BLKmode, addr); |
| } |
| else |
| regbuf = assign_stack_local (BLKmode, bufsize, TARGET_FPU_DOUBLE ? 64 : 0); |
| alias_set = get_varargs_alias_set (); |
| set_mem_alias_set (regbuf, alias_set); |
| |
| /* Save int args. |
| This is optimized to only save the regs that are necessary. Explicitly |
| named args need not be saved. */ |
| if (n_intregs > 0) |
| move_block_from_reg (BASE_ARG_REG (SImode) + first_intreg, |
| adjust_address (regbuf, BLKmode, |
| n_floatregs * UNITS_PER_WORD), |
| n_intregs); |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| /* Return the address of the regbuf. */ |
| return XEXP (regbuf, 0); |
| |
| /* Save float args. |
| This is optimized to only save the regs that are necessary. Explicitly |
| named args need not be saved. |
| We explicitly build a pointer to the buffer because it halves the insn |
| count when not optimizing (otherwise the pointer is built for each reg |
| saved). |
| We emit the moves in reverse order so that we can use predecrement. */ |
| |
| fpregs = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, |
| plus_constant (XEXP (regbuf, 0), |
| n_floatregs * UNITS_PER_WORD)); |
| if (TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE) |
| { |
| rtx mem; |
| for (regno = NPARM_REGS (DFmode) - 2; regno >= first_floatreg; regno -= 2) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (fpregs, fpregs, |
| GEN_INT (-2 * UNITS_PER_WORD))); |
| mem = change_address (regbuf, DFmode, fpregs); |
| emit_move_insn (mem, |
| gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, BASE_ARG_REG (DFmode) + regno)); |
| } |
| regno = first_floatreg; |
| if (regno & 1) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (fpregs, fpregs, GEN_INT (-UNITS_PER_WORD))); |
| mem = change_address (regbuf, SFmode, fpregs); |
| emit_move_insn (mem, |
| gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, BASE_ARG_REG (SFmode) + regno |
| - (TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN != 0))); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| for (regno = NPARM_REGS (SFmode) - 1; regno >= first_floatreg; regno--) |
| { |
| rtx mem; |
| |
| emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (fpregs, fpregs, GEN_INT (-UNITS_PER_WORD))); |
| mem = change_address (regbuf, SFmode, fpregs); |
| emit_move_insn (mem, |
| gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, BASE_ARG_REG (SFmode) + regno)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return the address of the regbuf. */ |
| return XEXP (regbuf, 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* Define the `__builtin_va_list' type for the ABI. */ |
| |
| static tree |
| sh_build_builtin_va_list (void) |
| { |
| tree f_next_o, f_next_o_limit, f_next_fp, f_next_fp_limit, f_next_stack; |
| tree record, type_decl; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH5 || (! TARGET_SH2E && ! TARGET_SH4) |
| || TARGET_HITACHI || sh_cfun_attr_renesas_p ()) |
| return ptr_type_node; |
| |
| record = (*lang_hooks.types.make_type) (RECORD_TYPE); |
| type_decl = build_decl (BUILTINS_LOCATION, |
| TYPE_DECL, get_identifier ("__va_list_tag"), record); |
| |
| f_next_o = build_decl (BUILTINS_LOCATION, |
| FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__va_next_o"), |
| ptr_type_node); |
| f_next_o_limit = build_decl (BUILTINS_LOCATION, |
| FIELD_DECL, |
| get_identifier ("__va_next_o_limit"), |
| ptr_type_node); |
| f_next_fp = build_decl (BUILTINS_LOCATION, |
| FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__va_next_fp"), |
| ptr_type_node); |
| f_next_fp_limit = build_decl (BUILTINS_LOCATION, |
| FIELD_DECL, |
| get_identifier ("__va_next_fp_limit"), |
| ptr_type_node); |
| f_next_stack = build_decl (BUILTINS_LOCATION, |
| FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__va_next_stack"), |
| ptr_type_node); |
| |
| DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_next_o) = record; |
| DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_next_o_limit) = record; |
| DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_next_fp) = record; |
| DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_next_fp_limit) = record; |
| DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_next_stack) = record; |
| |
| TYPE_STUB_DECL (record) = type_decl; |
| TYPE_NAME (record) = type_decl; |
| TYPE_FIELDS (record) = f_next_o; |
| DECL_CHAIN (f_next_o) = f_next_o_limit; |
| DECL_CHAIN (f_next_o_limit) = f_next_fp; |
| DECL_CHAIN (f_next_fp) = f_next_fp_limit; |
| DECL_CHAIN (f_next_fp_limit) = f_next_stack; |
| |
| layout_type (record); |
| |
| return record; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement `va_start' for varargs and stdarg. */ |
| |
| static void |
| sh_va_start (tree valist, rtx nextarg) |
| { |
| tree f_next_o, f_next_o_limit, f_next_fp, f_next_fp_limit, f_next_stack; |
| tree next_o, next_o_limit, next_fp, next_fp_limit, next_stack; |
| tree t, u; |
| int nfp, nint; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| expand_builtin_saveregs (); |
| std_expand_builtin_va_start (valist, nextarg); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| if ((! TARGET_SH2E && ! TARGET_SH4) |
| || TARGET_HITACHI || sh_cfun_attr_renesas_p ()) |
| { |
| std_expand_builtin_va_start (valist, nextarg); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| f_next_o = TYPE_FIELDS (va_list_type_node); |
| f_next_o_limit = DECL_CHAIN (f_next_o); |
| f_next_fp = DECL_CHAIN (f_next_o_limit); |
| f_next_fp_limit = DECL_CHAIN (f_next_fp); |
| f_next_stack = DECL_CHAIN (f_next_fp_limit); |
| |
| next_o = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_next_o), valist, f_next_o, |
| NULL_TREE); |
| next_o_limit = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_next_o_limit), |
| valist, f_next_o_limit, NULL_TREE); |
| next_fp = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_next_fp), valist, f_next_fp, |
| NULL_TREE); |
| next_fp_limit = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_next_fp_limit), |
| valist, f_next_fp_limit, NULL_TREE); |
| next_stack = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_next_stack), |
| valist, f_next_stack, NULL_TREE); |
| |
| /* Call __builtin_saveregs. */ |
| u = make_tree (sizetype, expand_builtin_saveregs ()); |
| u = fold_convert (ptr_type_node, u); |
| t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, ptr_type_node, next_fp, u); |
| TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1; |
| expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); |
| |
| nfp = crtl->args.info.arg_count[SH_ARG_FLOAT]; |
| if (nfp < 8) |
| nfp = 8 - nfp; |
| else |
| nfp = 0; |
| u = fold_build2 (POINTER_PLUS_EXPR, ptr_type_node, u, |
| size_int (UNITS_PER_WORD * nfp)); |
| t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, ptr_type_node, next_fp_limit, u); |
| TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1; |
| expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); |
| |
| t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, ptr_type_node, next_o, u); |
| TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1; |
| expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); |
| |
| nint = crtl->args.info.arg_count[SH_ARG_INT]; |
| if (nint < 4) |
| nint = 4 - nint; |
| else |
| nint = 0; |
| u = fold_build2 (POINTER_PLUS_EXPR, ptr_type_node, u, |
| size_int (UNITS_PER_WORD * nint)); |
| t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, ptr_type_node, next_o_limit, u); |
| TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1; |
| expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); |
| |
| u = make_tree (ptr_type_node, nextarg); |
| t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, ptr_type_node, next_stack, u); |
| TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1; |
| expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); |
| } |
| |
| /* TYPE is a RECORD_TYPE. If there is only a single nonzero-sized |
| member, return it. */ |
| static tree |
| find_sole_member (tree type) |
| { |
| tree field, member = NULL_TREE; |
| |
| for (field = TYPE_FIELDS (type); field; field = DECL_CHAIN (field)) |
| { |
| if (TREE_CODE (field) != FIELD_DECL) |
| continue; |
| if (!DECL_SIZE (field)) |
| return NULL_TREE; |
| if (integer_zerop (DECL_SIZE (field))) |
| continue; |
| if (member) |
| return NULL_TREE; |
| member = field; |
| } |
| return member; |
| } |
| /* Implement `va_arg'. */ |
| |
| static tree |
| sh_gimplify_va_arg_expr (tree valist, tree type, gimple_seq *pre_p, |
| gimple_seq *post_p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| HOST_WIDE_INT size, rsize; |
| tree tmp, pptr_type_node; |
| tree addr, lab_over = NULL, result = NULL; |
| bool pass_by_ref; |
| tree eff_type; |
| |
| if (!VOID_TYPE_P (type)) |
| pass_by_ref = targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack (TYPE_MODE (type), type); |
| else |
| pass_by_ref = false; |
| |
| if (pass_by_ref) |
| type = build_pointer_type (type); |
| |
| size = int_size_in_bytes (type); |
| rsize = (size + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) & -UNITS_PER_WORD; |
| pptr_type_node = build_pointer_type (ptr_type_node); |
| |
| if (! TARGET_SH5 && (TARGET_SH2E || TARGET_SH4) |
| && ! (TARGET_HITACHI || sh_cfun_attr_renesas_p ())) |
| { |
| tree f_next_o, f_next_o_limit, f_next_fp, f_next_fp_limit, f_next_stack; |
| tree next_o, next_o_limit, next_fp, next_fp_limit, next_stack; |
| int pass_as_float; |
| tree lab_false; |
| tree member; |
| |
| f_next_o = TYPE_FIELDS (va_list_type_node); |
| f_next_o_limit = DECL_CHAIN (f_next_o); |
| f_next_fp = DECL_CHAIN (f_next_o_limit); |
| f_next_fp_limit = DECL_CHAIN (f_next_fp); |
| f_next_stack = DECL_CHAIN (f_next_fp_limit); |
| |
| next_o = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_next_o), valist, f_next_o, |
| NULL_TREE); |
| next_o_limit = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_next_o_limit), |
| valist, f_next_o_limit, NULL_TREE); |
| next_fp = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_next_fp), |
| valist, f_next_fp, NULL_TREE); |
| next_fp_limit = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_next_fp_limit), |
| valist, f_next_fp_limit, NULL_TREE); |
| next_stack = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_next_stack), |
| valist, f_next_stack, NULL_TREE); |
| |
| /* Structures with a single member with a distinct mode are passed |
| like their member. This is relevant if the latter has a REAL_TYPE |
| or COMPLEX_TYPE type. */ |
| eff_type = type; |
| while (TREE_CODE (eff_type) == RECORD_TYPE |
| && (member = find_sole_member (eff_type)) |
| && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == REAL_TYPE |
| || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == COMPLEX_TYPE |
| || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)) |
| { |
| tree field_type = TREE_TYPE (member); |
| |
| if (TYPE_MODE (eff_type) == TYPE_MODE (field_type)) |
| eff_type = field_type; |
| else |
| { |
| gcc_assert ((TYPE_ALIGN (eff_type) |
| < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (TYPE_MODE (field_type))) |
| || (TYPE_ALIGN (eff_type) |
| > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (field_type)))); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE) |
| { |
| pass_as_float = ((TREE_CODE (eff_type) == REAL_TYPE && size <= 8) |
| || (TREE_CODE (eff_type) == COMPLEX_TYPE |
| && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (eff_type)) == REAL_TYPE |
| && size <= 16)); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| pass_as_float = (TREE_CODE (eff_type) == REAL_TYPE && size == 4); |
| } |
| |
| addr = create_tmp_var (pptr_type_node, NULL); |
| lab_false = create_artificial_label (UNKNOWN_LOCATION); |
| lab_over = create_artificial_label (UNKNOWN_LOCATION); |
| |
| valist = build_simple_mem_ref (addr); |
| |
| if (pass_as_float) |
| { |
| tree next_fp_tmp = create_tmp_var (TREE_TYPE (f_next_fp), NULL); |
| tree cmp; |
| bool is_double = size == 8 && TREE_CODE (eff_type) == REAL_TYPE; |
| |
| tmp = build1 (ADDR_EXPR, pptr_type_node, unshare_expr (next_fp)); |
| gimplify_assign (unshare_expr (addr), tmp, pre_p); |
| |
| gimplify_assign (unshare_expr (next_fp_tmp), valist, pre_p); |
| tmp = next_fp_limit; |
| if (size > 4 && !is_double) |
| tmp = build2 (POINTER_PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (tmp), |
| unshare_expr (tmp), size_int (4 - size)); |
| tmp = build2 (GE_EXPR, boolean_type_node, |
| unshare_expr (next_fp_tmp), unshare_expr (tmp)); |
| cmp = build3 (COND_EXPR, void_type_node, tmp, |
| build1 (GOTO_EXPR, void_type_node, |
| unshare_expr (lab_false)), NULL_TREE); |
| if (!is_double) |
| gimplify_and_add (cmp, pre_p); |
| |
| if (TYPE_ALIGN (eff_type) > BITS_PER_WORD |
| || (is_double || size == 16)) |
| { |
| tmp = fold_convert (sizetype, next_fp_tmp); |
| tmp = build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, sizetype, tmp, |
| size_int (UNITS_PER_WORD)); |
| tmp = build2 (POINTER_PLUS_EXPR, ptr_type_node, |
| unshare_expr (next_fp_tmp), tmp); |
| gimplify_assign (unshare_expr (next_fp_tmp), tmp, pre_p); |
| } |
| if (is_double) |
| gimplify_and_add (cmp, pre_p); |
| |
| #ifdef FUNCTION_ARG_SCmode_WART |
| if (TYPE_MODE (eff_type) == SCmode |
| && TARGET_SH4 && TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN) |
| { |
| tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (eff_type); |
| tree real, imag; |
| |
| imag |
| = std_gimplify_va_arg_expr (next_fp_tmp, subtype, pre_p, NULL); |
| imag = get_initialized_tmp_var (imag, pre_p, NULL); |
| |
| real |
| = std_gimplify_va_arg_expr (next_fp_tmp, subtype, pre_p, NULL); |
| real = get_initialized_tmp_var (real, pre_p, NULL); |
| |
| result = build2 (COMPLEX_EXPR, eff_type, real, imag); |
| if (type != eff_type) |
| result = build1 (VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, type, result); |
| result = get_initialized_tmp_var (result, pre_p, NULL); |
| } |
| #endif /* FUNCTION_ARG_SCmode_WART */ |
| |
| tmp = build1 (GOTO_EXPR, void_type_node, unshare_expr (lab_over)); |
| gimplify_and_add (tmp, pre_p); |
| |
| tmp = build1 (LABEL_EXPR, void_type_node, unshare_expr (lab_false)); |
| gimplify_and_add (tmp, pre_p); |
| |
| tmp = build1 (ADDR_EXPR, pptr_type_node, unshare_expr (next_stack)); |
| gimplify_assign (unshare_expr (addr), tmp, pre_p); |
| gimplify_assign (unshare_expr (next_fp_tmp), |
| unshare_expr (valist), pre_p); |
| |
| gimplify_assign (unshare_expr (valist), |
| unshare_expr (next_fp_tmp), post_p); |
| valist = next_fp_tmp; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| tmp = build2 (POINTER_PLUS_EXPR, ptr_type_node, |
| unshare_expr (next_o), size_int (rsize)); |
| tmp = build2 (GT_EXPR, boolean_type_node, tmp, |
| unshare_expr (next_o_limit)); |
| tmp = build3 (COND_EXPR, void_type_node, tmp, |
| build1 (GOTO_EXPR, void_type_node, |
| unshare_expr (lab_false)), |
| NULL_TREE); |
| gimplify_and_add (tmp, pre_p); |
| |
| tmp = build1 (ADDR_EXPR, pptr_type_node, unshare_expr (next_o)); |
| gimplify_assign (unshare_expr (addr), tmp, pre_p); |
| |
| tmp = build1 (GOTO_EXPR, void_type_node, unshare_expr (lab_over)); |
| gimplify_and_add (tmp, pre_p); |
| |
| tmp = build1 (LABEL_EXPR, void_type_node, unshare_expr (lab_false)); |
| gimplify_and_add (tmp, pre_p); |
| |
| if (size > 4 && ! (TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A)) |
| gimplify_assign (unshare_expr (next_o), |
| unshare_expr (next_o_limit), pre_p); |
| |
| tmp = build1 (ADDR_EXPR, pptr_type_node, unshare_expr (next_stack)); |
| gimplify_assign (unshare_expr (addr), tmp, pre_p); |
| } |
| |
| if (!result) |
| { |
| tmp = build1 (LABEL_EXPR, void_type_node, unshare_expr (lab_over)); |
| gimplify_and_add (tmp, pre_p); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* ??? In va-sh.h, there had been code to make values larger than |
| size 8 indirect. This does not match the FUNCTION_ARG macros. */ |
| |
| tmp = std_gimplify_va_arg_expr (valist, type, pre_p, NULL); |
| if (result) |
| { |
| gimplify_assign (result, tmp, pre_p); |
| result = build1 (NOP_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (result), result); |
| tmp = build1 (LABEL_EXPR, void_type_node, unshare_expr (lab_over)); |
| gimplify_and_add (tmp, pre_p); |
| } |
| else |
| result = tmp; |
| |
| if (pass_by_ref) |
| result = build_va_arg_indirect_ref (result); |
| |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| /* 64 bit floating points memory transfers are paired single precision loads |
| or store. So DWARF information needs fixing in little endian (unless |
| PR=SZ=1 in FPSCR). */ |
| rtx |
| sh_dwarf_register_span (rtx reg) |
| { |
| unsigned regno = REGNO (reg); |
| |
| if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN || GET_MODE (reg) != DFmode) |
| return NULL_RTX; |
| |
| return |
| gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, |
| gen_rtvec (2, |
| gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, |
| DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno+1)), |
| gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, |
| DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno)))); |
| } |
| |
| static enum machine_mode |
| sh_promote_function_mode (const_tree type, enum machine_mode mode, |
| int *punsignedp, const_tree funtype, |
| int for_return) |
| { |
| if (sh_promote_prototypes (funtype)) |
| return promote_mode (type, mode, punsignedp); |
| else |
| return default_promote_function_mode (type, mode, punsignedp, funtype, |
| for_return); |
| } |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_promote_prototypes (const_tree type) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_HITACHI) |
| return 0; |
| if (! type) |
| return 1; |
| return ! sh_attr_renesas_p (type); |
| } |
| |
| /* Whether an argument must be passed by reference. On SHcompact, we |
| pretend arguments wider than 32-bits that would have been passed in |
| registers are passed by reference, so that an SHmedia trampoline |
| loads them into the full 64-bits registers. */ |
| |
| static int |
| shcompact_byref (const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum, enum machine_mode mode, |
| const_tree type, bool named) |
| { |
| unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size; |
| |
| if (type) |
| size = int_size_in_bytes (type); |
| else |
| size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode); |
| |
| if (cum->arg_count[SH_ARG_INT] < NPARM_REGS (SImode) |
| && (!named |
| || GET_SH_ARG_CLASS (mode) == SH_ARG_INT |
| || (GET_SH_ARG_CLASS (mode) == SH_ARG_FLOAT |
| && cum->arg_count[SH_ARG_FLOAT] >= NPARM_REGS (SFmode))) |
| && size > 4 |
| && !SHCOMPACT_FORCE_ON_STACK (mode, type) |
| && !SH5_WOULD_BE_PARTIAL_NREGS (*cum, mode, type, named)) |
| return size; |
| else |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_pass_by_reference (cumulative_args_t cum_v, enum machine_mode mode, |
| const_tree type, bool named) |
| { |
| CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v); |
| |
| if (targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack (mode, type)) |
| return true; |
| |
| /* ??? std_gimplify_va_arg_expr passes NULL for cum. That function |
| wants to know about pass-by-reference semantics for incoming |
| arguments. */ |
| if (! cum) |
| return false; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT) |
| { |
| cum->byref = shcompact_byref (cum, mode, type, named); |
| return cum->byref != 0; |
| } |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_callee_copies (cumulative_args_t cum, enum machine_mode mode, |
| const_tree type, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| /* ??? How can it possibly be correct to return true only on the |
| caller side of the equation? Is there someplace else in the |
| sh backend that's magically producing the copies? */ |
| return (get_cumulative_args (cum)->outgoing |
| && ((mode == BLKmode ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)) |
| % SH_MIN_ALIGN_FOR_CALLEE_COPY == 0)); |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| sh_arg_partial_bytes (cumulative_args_t cum_v, enum machine_mode mode, |
| tree type, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v); |
| int words = 0; |
| |
| if (!TARGET_SH5 |
| && PASS_IN_REG_P (*cum, mode, type) |
| && !(TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE) |
| && (ROUND_REG (*cum, mode) |
| + (mode != BLKmode |
| ? ROUND_ADVANCE (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)) |
| : ROUND_ADVANCE (int_size_in_bytes (type))) |
| > NPARM_REGS (mode))) |
| words = NPARM_REGS (mode) - ROUND_REG (*cum, mode); |
| |
| else if (!TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && SH5_WOULD_BE_PARTIAL_NREGS (*cum, mode, type, named)) |
| words = NPARM_REGS (SImode) - cum->arg_count[SH_ARG_INT]; |
| |
| return words * UNITS_PER_WORD; |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Define where to put the arguments to a function. |
| Value is zero to push the argument on the stack, |
| or a hard register in which to store the argument. |
| |
| MODE is the argument's machine mode. |
| TYPE is the data type of the argument (as a tree). |
| This is null for libcalls where that information may |
| not be available. |
| CUM is a variable of type CUMULATIVE_ARGS which gives info about |
| the preceding args and about the function being called. |
| NAMED is nonzero if this argument is a named parameter |
| (otherwise it is an extra parameter matching an ellipsis). |
| |
| On SH the first args are normally in registers |
| and the rest are pushed. Any arg that starts within the first |
| NPARM_REGS words is at least partially passed in a register unless |
| its data type forbids. */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| sh_function_arg (cumulative_args_t ca_v, enum machine_mode mode, |
| const_tree type, bool named) |
| { |
| CUMULATIVE_ARGS *ca = get_cumulative_args (ca_v); |
| |
| if (! TARGET_SH5 && mode == VOIDmode) |
| return GEN_INT (ca->renesas_abi ? 1 : 0); |
| |
| if (! TARGET_SH5 |
| && PASS_IN_REG_P (*ca, mode, type) |
| && (named || ! (TARGET_HITACHI || ca->renesas_abi))) |
| { |
| int regno; |
| |
| if (mode == SCmode && TARGET_SH4 && TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN |
| && (! FUNCTION_ARG_SCmode_WART || (ROUND_REG (*ca, mode) & 1))) |
| { |
| rtx r1 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, |
| gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, |
| BASE_ARG_REG (mode) |
| + (ROUND_REG (*ca, mode) ^ 1)), |
| const0_rtx); |
| rtx r2 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, |
| gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, |
| BASE_ARG_REG (mode) |
| + ((ROUND_REG (*ca, mode) + 1) ^ 1)), |
| GEN_INT (4)); |
| return gen_rtx_PARALLEL(SCmode, gen_rtvec(2, r1, r2)); |
| } |
| |
| /* If the alignment of a DF value causes an SF register to be |
| skipped, we will use that skipped register for the next SF |
| value. */ |
| if ((TARGET_HITACHI || ca->renesas_abi) |
| && ca->free_single_fp_reg |
| && mode == SFmode) |
| return gen_rtx_REG (mode, ca->free_single_fp_reg); |
| |
| regno = (BASE_ARG_REG (mode) + ROUND_REG (*ca, mode)) |
| ^ (mode == SFmode && TARGET_SH4 |
| && TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN != 0 |
| && ! TARGET_HITACHI && ! ca->renesas_abi); |
| return gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno); |
| |
| } |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| if (mode == VOIDmode && TARGET_SHCOMPACT) |
| return GEN_INT (ca->call_cookie); |
| |
| /* The following test assumes unnamed arguments are promoted to |
| DFmode. */ |
| if (mode == SFmode && ca->free_single_fp_reg) |
| return SH5_PROTOTYPED_FLOAT_ARG (*ca, mode, ca->free_single_fp_reg); |
| |
| if ((GET_SH_ARG_CLASS (mode) == SH_ARG_FLOAT) |
| && (named || ! ca->prototype_p) |
| && ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_FLOAT] < NPARM_REGS (SFmode)) |
| { |
| if (! ca->prototype_p && TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| return SH5_PROTOTYPELESS_FLOAT_ARG (*ca, mode); |
| |
| return SH5_PROTOTYPED_FLOAT_ARG (*ca, mode, |
| FIRST_FP_PARM_REG |
| + ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_FLOAT]); |
| } |
| |
| if (ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_INT] < NPARM_REGS (SImode) |
| && (! TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| || (! SHCOMPACT_FORCE_ON_STACK (mode, type) |
| && ! SH5_WOULD_BE_PARTIAL_NREGS (*ca, mode, |
| type, named)))) |
| { |
| return gen_rtx_REG (mode, (FIRST_PARM_REG |
| + ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_INT])); |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Update the data in CUM to advance over an argument |
| of mode MODE and data type TYPE. |
| (TYPE is null for libcalls where that information may not be |
| available.) */ |
| |
| static void |
| sh_function_arg_advance (cumulative_args_t ca_v, enum machine_mode mode, |
| const_tree type, bool named) |
| { |
| CUMULATIVE_ARGS *ca = get_cumulative_args (ca_v); |
| |
| if (ca->force_mem) |
| ca->force_mem = 0; |
| else if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| const_tree type2 = (ca->byref && type |
| ? TREE_TYPE (type) |
| : type); |
| enum machine_mode mode2 = (ca->byref && type |
| ? TYPE_MODE (type2) |
| : mode); |
| int dwords = ((ca->byref |
| ? ca->byref |
| : mode2 == BLKmode |
| ? int_size_in_bytes (type2) |
| : GET_MODE_SIZE (mode2)) + 7) / 8; |
| int numregs = MIN (dwords, NPARM_REGS (SImode) |
| - ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_INT]); |
| |
| if (numregs) |
| { |
| ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_INT] += numregs; |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && SHCOMPACT_FORCE_ON_STACK (mode2, type2)) |
| { |
| ca->call_cookie |
| |= CALL_COOKIE_INT_REG (ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_INT] |
| - numregs, 1); |
| /* N.B. We want this also for outgoing. */ |
| ca->stack_regs += numregs; |
| } |
| else if (ca->byref) |
| { |
| if (! ca->outgoing) |
| ca->stack_regs += numregs; |
| ca->byref_regs += numregs; |
| ca->byref = 0; |
| do |
| ca->call_cookie |
| |= CALL_COOKIE_INT_REG (ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_INT] |
| - numregs, 2); |
| while (--numregs); |
| ca->call_cookie |
| |= CALL_COOKIE_INT_REG (ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_INT] |
| - 1, 1); |
| } |
| else if (dwords > numregs) |
| { |
| int pushregs = numregs; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT) |
| ca->stack_regs += numregs; |
| while (pushregs < NPARM_REGS (SImode) - 1 |
| && (CALL_COOKIE_INT_REG_GET |
| (ca->call_cookie, |
| NPARM_REGS (SImode) - pushregs) |
| == 1)) |
| { |
| ca->call_cookie |
| &= ~ CALL_COOKIE_INT_REG (NPARM_REGS (SImode) |
| - pushregs, 1); |
| pushregs++; |
| } |
| if (numregs == NPARM_REGS (SImode)) |
| ca->call_cookie |
| |= CALL_COOKIE_INT_REG (0, 1) |
| | CALL_COOKIE_STACKSEQ (numregs - 1); |
| else |
| ca->call_cookie |
| |= CALL_COOKIE_STACKSEQ (numregs); |
| } |
| } |
| if (GET_SH_ARG_CLASS (mode2) == SH_ARG_FLOAT |
| && (named || ! ca->prototype_p)) |
| { |
| if (mode2 == SFmode && ca->free_single_fp_reg) |
| ca->free_single_fp_reg = 0; |
| else if (ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_FLOAT] |
| < NPARM_REGS (SFmode)) |
| { |
| int numfpregs |
| = MIN ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode2) + 7) / 8 * 2, |
| NPARM_REGS (SFmode) |
| - ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_FLOAT]); |
| |
| ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_FLOAT] += numfpregs; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT && ! ca->prototype_p) |
| { |
| if (ca->outgoing && numregs > 0) |
| do |
| { |
| ca->call_cookie |
| |= (CALL_COOKIE_INT_REG |
| (ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_INT] |
| - numregs + ((numfpregs - 2) / 2), |
| 4 + (ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_FLOAT] |
| - numfpregs) / 2)); |
| } |
| while (numfpregs -= 2); |
| } |
| else if (mode2 == SFmode && (named) |
| && (ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_FLOAT] |
| < NPARM_REGS (SFmode))) |
| ca->free_single_fp_reg |
| = FIRST_FP_PARM_REG - numfpregs |
| + ca->arg_count[(int) SH_ARG_FLOAT] + 1; |
| } |
| } |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| if ((TARGET_HITACHI || ca->renesas_abi) && TARGET_FPU_DOUBLE) |
| { |
| /* Note that we've used the skipped register. */ |
| if (mode == SFmode && ca->free_single_fp_reg) |
| { |
| ca->free_single_fp_reg = 0; |
| return; |
| } |
| /* When we have a DF after an SF, there's an SF register that get |
| skipped in order to align the DF value. We note this skipped |
| register, because the next SF value will use it, and not the |
| SF that follows the DF. */ |
| if (mode == DFmode |
| && ROUND_REG (*ca, DFmode) != ROUND_REG (*ca, SFmode)) |
| { |
| ca->free_single_fp_reg = (ROUND_REG (*ca, SFmode) |
| + BASE_ARG_REG (mode)); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (! ((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A) || ca->renesas_abi) |
| || PASS_IN_REG_P (*ca, mode, type)) |
| (ca->arg_count[(int) GET_SH_ARG_CLASS (mode)] |
| = (ROUND_REG (*ca, mode) |
| + (mode == BLKmode |
| ? ROUND_ADVANCE (int_size_in_bytes (type)) |
| : ROUND_ADVANCE (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))))); |
| } |
| |
| /* The Renesas calling convention doesn't quite fit into this scheme since |
| the address is passed like an invisible argument, but one that is always |
| passed in memory. */ |
| static rtx |
| sh_struct_value_rtx (tree fndecl, int incoming ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_HITACHI || sh_attr_renesas_p (fndecl)) |
| return 0; |
| return gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 2); |
| } |
| |
| /* Worker function for TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE. |
| |
| For the SH, this is like LIBCALL_VALUE, except that we must change the |
| mode like PROMOTE_MODE does. |
| ??? PROMOTE_MODE is ignored for non-scalar types. The set of types |
| tested here has to be kept in sync with the one in explow.c:promote_mode. |
| */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| sh_function_value (const_tree valtype, |
| const_tree fn_decl_or_type, |
| bool outgoing ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| if (fn_decl_or_type |
| && !DECL_P (fn_decl_or_type)) |
| fn_decl_or_type = NULL; |
| |
| return gen_rtx_REG ( |
| ((GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (valtype)) == MODE_INT |
| && GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (valtype)) < 4 |
| && (TREE_CODE (valtype) == INTEGER_TYPE |
| || TREE_CODE (valtype) == ENUMERAL_TYPE |
| || TREE_CODE (valtype) == BOOLEAN_TYPE |
| || TREE_CODE (valtype) == REAL_TYPE |
| || TREE_CODE (valtype) == OFFSET_TYPE)) |
| && sh_promote_prototypes (fn_decl_or_type) |
| ? (TARGET_SHMEDIA64 ? DImode : SImode) : TYPE_MODE (valtype)), |
| BASE_RETURN_VALUE_REG (TYPE_MODE (valtype))); |
| } |
| |
| /* Worker function for TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE. */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| sh_libcall_value (enum machine_mode mode, const_rtx fun ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| return gen_rtx_REG (mode, BASE_RETURN_VALUE_REG (mode)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return true if N is a possible register number of function value. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_function_value_regno_p (const unsigned int regno) |
| { |
| return ((regno) == FIRST_RET_REG |
| || (TARGET_SH2E && (regno) == FIRST_FP_RET_REG) |
| || (TARGET_SHMEDIA_FPU && (regno) == FIRST_FP_RET_REG)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Worker function for TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_return_in_memory (const_tree type, const_tree fndecl) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| if (TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode) |
| return ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) int_size_in_bytes (type)) > 8; |
| else |
| return GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type)) > 8; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| return (TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode |
| || ((TARGET_HITACHI || sh_attr_renesas_p (fndecl)) |
| && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* We actually emit the code in sh_expand_prologue. We used to use |
| a static variable to flag that we need to emit this code, but that |
| doesn't when inlining, when functions are deferred and then emitted |
| later. Fortunately, we already have two flags that are part of struct |
| function that tell if a function uses varargs or stdarg. */ |
| static void |
| sh_setup_incoming_varargs (cumulative_args_t ca, |
| enum machine_mode mode, |
| tree type, |
| int *pretend_arg_size, |
| int second_time ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| gcc_assert (cfun->stdarg); |
| if (TARGET_VARARGS_PRETEND_ARGS (current_function_decl)) |
| { |
| int named_parm_regs, anon_parm_regs; |
| |
| named_parm_regs = (ROUND_REG (*get_cumulative_args (ca), mode) |
| + (mode == BLKmode |
| ? ROUND_ADVANCE (int_size_in_bytes (type)) |
| : ROUND_ADVANCE (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))); |
| anon_parm_regs = NPARM_REGS (SImode) - named_parm_regs; |
| if (anon_parm_regs > 0) |
| *pretend_arg_size = anon_parm_regs * 4; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_strict_argument_naming (cumulative_args_t ca ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| return TARGET_SH5; |
| } |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_pretend_outgoing_varargs_named (cumulative_args_t ca_v) |
| { |
| CUMULATIVE_ARGS *ca = get_cumulative_args (ca_v); |
| |
| return ! (TARGET_HITACHI || ca->renesas_abi) && ! TARGET_SH5; |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Define the offset between two registers, one to be eliminated, and |
| the other its replacement, at the start of a routine. */ |
| |
| int |
| initial_elimination_offset (int from, int to) |
| { |
| int regs_saved; |
| int regs_saved_rounding = 0; |
| int total_saved_regs_space; |
| int total_auto_space; |
| int save_flags = target_flags; |
| int copy_flags; |
| HARD_REG_SET live_regs_mask; |
| |
| shmedia_space_reserved_for_target_registers = false; |
| regs_saved = calc_live_regs (&live_regs_mask); |
| regs_saved += SHMEDIA_REGS_STACK_ADJUST (); |
| |
| if (shmedia_reserve_space_for_target_registers_p (regs_saved, &live_regs_mask)) |
| { |
| shmedia_space_reserved_for_target_registers = true; |
| regs_saved += shmedia_target_regs_stack_adjust (&live_regs_mask); |
| } |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH5 && regs_saved % (STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)) |
| regs_saved_rounding = ((STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT) |
| - regs_saved % (STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)); |
| |
| total_auto_space = rounded_frame_size (regs_saved) - regs_saved_rounding; |
| copy_flags = target_flags; |
| target_flags = save_flags; |
| |
| total_saved_regs_space = regs_saved + regs_saved_rounding; |
| |
| if (from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) |
| return total_saved_regs_space + total_auto_space |
| + crtl->args.info.byref_regs * 8; |
| |
| if (from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) |
| return total_saved_regs_space + total_auto_space |
| + crtl->args.info.byref_regs * 8; |
| |
| /* Initial gap between fp and sp is 0. */ |
| if (from == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) |
| return rounded_frame_size (0); |
| |
| if (from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) |
| return rounded_frame_size (0); |
| |
| gcc_assert (from == RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM |
| && (to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM |
| || to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)); |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| int n = total_saved_regs_space; |
| int pr_reg = TARGET_SHMEDIA ? PR_MEDIA_REG : PR_REG; |
| save_schedule schedule; |
| save_entry *entry; |
| |
| n += total_auto_space; |
| |
| /* If it wasn't saved, there's not much we can do. */ |
| if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (live_regs_mask, pr_reg)) |
| return n; |
| |
| target_flags = copy_flags; |
| |
| sh5_schedule_saves (&live_regs_mask, &schedule, n); |
| for (entry = &schedule.entries[1]; entry->mode != VOIDmode; entry++) |
| if (entry->reg == pr_reg) |
| { |
| target_flags = save_flags; |
| return entry->offset; |
| } |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| else |
| return total_auto_space; |
| } |
| |
| /* Parse the -mfixed-range= option string. */ |
| void |
| sh_fix_range (const char *const_str) |
| { |
| int i, first, last; |
| char *str, *dash, *comma; |
| |
| /* str must be of the form REG1'-'REG2{,REG1'-'REG} where REG1 and |
| REG2 are either register names or register numbers. The effect |
| of this option is to mark the registers in the range from REG1 to |
| REG2 as ``fixed'' so they won't be used by the compiler. */ |
| |
| i = strlen (const_str); |
| str = (char *) alloca (i + 1); |
| memcpy (str, const_str, i + 1); |
| |
| while (1) |
| { |
| dash = strchr (str, '-'); |
| if (!dash) |
| { |
| warning (0, "value of -mfixed-range must have form REG1-REG2"); |
| return; |
| } |
| *dash = '\0'; |
| comma = strchr (dash + 1, ','); |
| if (comma) |
| *comma = '\0'; |
| |
| first = decode_reg_name (str); |
| if (first < 0) |
| { |
| warning (0, "unknown register name: %s", str); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| last = decode_reg_name (dash + 1); |
| if (last < 0) |
| { |
| warning (0, "unknown register name: %s", dash + 1); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| *dash = '-'; |
| |
| if (first > last) |
| { |
| warning (0, "%s-%s is an empty range", str, dash + 1); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| for (i = first; i <= last; ++i) |
| fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1; |
| |
| if (!comma) |
| break; |
| |
| *comma = ','; |
| str = comma + 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Insert any deferred function attributes from earlier pragmas. */ |
| static void |
| sh_insert_attributes (tree node, tree *attributes) |
| { |
| tree attrs; |
| |
| if (TREE_CODE (node) != FUNCTION_DECL) |
| return; |
| |
| /* We are only interested in fields. */ |
| if (!DECL_P (node)) |
| return; |
| |
| /* Append the attributes to the deferred attributes. */ |
| *sh_deferred_function_attributes_tail = *attributes; |
| attrs = sh_deferred_function_attributes; |
| if (!attrs) |
| return; |
| |
| /* Some attributes imply or require the interrupt attribute. */ |
| if (!lookup_attribute ("interrupt_handler", attrs) |
| && !lookup_attribute ("interrupt_handler", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (node))) |
| { |
| /* If we have a trapa_handler, but no interrupt_handler attribute, |
| insert an interrupt_handler attribute. */ |
| if (lookup_attribute ("trapa_handler", attrs) != NULL_TREE) |
| /* We can't use sh_pr_interrupt here because that's not in the |
| java frontend. */ |
| attrs |
| = tree_cons (get_identifier("interrupt_handler"), NULL_TREE, attrs); |
| /* However, for sp_switch, trap_exit, nosave_low_regs and resbank, |
| if the interrupt attribute is missing, we ignore the attribute |
| and warn. */ |
| else if (lookup_attribute ("sp_switch", attrs) |
| || lookup_attribute ("trap_exit", attrs) |
| || lookup_attribute ("nosave_low_regs", attrs) |
| || lookup_attribute ("resbank", attrs)) |
| { |
| tree *tail; |
| |
| for (tail = attributes; attrs; attrs = TREE_CHAIN (attrs)) |
| { |
| if (is_attribute_p ("sp_switch", TREE_PURPOSE (attrs)) |
| || is_attribute_p ("trap_exit", TREE_PURPOSE (attrs)) |
| || is_attribute_p ("nosave_low_regs", TREE_PURPOSE (attrs)) |
| || is_attribute_p ("resbank", TREE_PURPOSE (attrs))) |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, |
| "%qE attribute only applies to interrupt functions", |
| TREE_PURPOSE (attrs)); |
| else |
| { |
| *tail = tree_cons (TREE_PURPOSE (attrs), NULL_TREE, |
| NULL_TREE); |
| tail = &TREE_CHAIN (*tail); |
| } |
| } |
| attrs = *attributes; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Install the processed list. */ |
| *attributes = attrs; |
| |
| /* Clear deferred attributes. */ |
| sh_deferred_function_attributes = NULL_TREE; |
| sh_deferred_function_attributes_tail = &sh_deferred_function_attributes; |
| |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* Supported attributes: |
| |
| interrupt_handler -- specifies this function is an interrupt handler. |
| |
| trapa_handler - like above, but don't save all registers. |
| |
| sp_switch -- specifies an alternate stack for an interrupt handler |
| to run on. |
| |
| trap_exit -- use a trapa to exit an interrupt function instead of |
| an rte instruction. |
| |
| nosave_low_regs - don't save r0..r7 in an interrupt handler. |
| This is useful on the SH3 and upwards, |
| which has a separate set of low regs for User and Supervisor modes. |
| This should only be used for the lowest level of interrupts. Higher levels |
| of interrupts must save the registers in case they themselves are |
| interrupted. |
| |
| renesas -- use Renesas calling/layout conventions (functions and |
| structures). |
| |
| resbank -- In case of an ISR, use a register bank to save registers |
| R0-R14, MACH, MACL, GBR and PR. This is useful only on SH2A targets. |
| */ |
| |
| /* Handle a 'resbank' attribute. */ |
| static tree |
| sh_handle_resbank_handler_attribute (tree * node, tree name, |
| tree args ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| bool * no_add_attrs) |
| { |
| if (!TARGET_SH2A) |
| { |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qE attribute is supported only for SH2A", |
| name); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| if (TREE_CODE (*node) != FUNCTION_DECL) |
| { |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qE attribute only applies to functions", |
| name); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| |
| return NULL_TREE; |
| } |
| |
| /* Handle an "interrupt_handler" attribute; arguments as in |
| struct attribute_spec.handler. */ |
| static tree |
| sh_handle_interrupt_handler_attribute (tree *node, tree name, |
| tree args ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| bool *no_add_attrs) |
| { |
| if (TREE_CODE (*node) != FUNCTION_DECL) |
| { |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qE attribute only applies to functions", |
| name); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| else if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT) |
| { |
| error ("attribute interrupt_handler is not compatible with -m5-compact"); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| |
| return NULL_TREE; |
| } |
| |
| /* Handle an 'function_vector' attribute; arguments as in |
| struct attribute_spec.handler. */ |
| static tree |
| sh2a_handle_function_vector_handler_attribute (tree * node, tree name, |
| tree args ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| bool * no_add_attrs) |
| { |
| if (!TARGET_SH2A) |
| { |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qE attribute only applies to SH2A", |
| name); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| else if (TREE_CODE (*node) != FUNCTION_DECL) |
| { |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qE attribute only applies to functions", |
| name); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_VALUE (args)) != INTEGER_CST) |
| { |
| /* The argument must be a constant integer. */ |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, |
| "%qE attribute argument not an integer constant", |
| name); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| else if (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_VALUE (args)) > 255) |
| { |
| /* The argument value must be between 0 to 255. */ |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, |
| "%qE attribute argument should be between 0 to 255", |
| name); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| return NULL_TREE; |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns 1 if current function has been assigned the attribute |
| 'function_vector'. */ |
| int |
| sh2a_is_function_vector_call (rtx x) |
| { |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF |
| && (SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (x) & SYMBOL_FLAG_FUNCVEC_FUNCTION)) |
| { |
| tree tr = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (x); |
| |
| if (sh2a_function_vector_p (tr)) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns the function vector number, if the attribute |
| 'function_vector' is assigned, otherwise returns zero. */ |
| int |
| sh2a_get_function_vector_number (rtx x) |
| { |
| int num; |
| tree list, t; |
| |
| if ((GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF) |
| && (SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (x) & SYMBOL_FLAG_FUNCVEC_FUNCTION)) |
| { |
| t = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (x); |
| |
| if (TREE_CODE (t) != FUNCTION_DECL) |
| return 0; |
| |
| list = SH_ATTRIBUTES (t); |
| while (list) |
| { |
| if (is_attribute_p ("function_vector", TREE_PURPOSE (list))) |
| { |
| num = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (list))); |
| return num; |
| } |
| |
| list = TREE_CHAIN (list); |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| else |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Handle an "sp_switch" attribute; arguments as in |
| struct attribute_spec.handler. */ |
| static tree |
| sh_handle_sp_switch_attribute (tree *node, tree name, tree args, |
| int flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, bool *no_add_attrs) |
| { |
| if (TREE_CODE (*node) != FUNCTION_DECL) |
| { |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qE attribute only applies to functions", |
| name); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_VALUE (args)) != STRING_CST) |
| { |
| /* The argument must be a constant string. */ |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qE attribute argument not a string constant", |
| name); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| |
| return NULL_TREE; |
| } |
| |
| /* Handle an "trap_exit" attribute; arguments as in |
| struct attribute_spec.handler. */ |
| static tree |
| sh_handle_trap_exit_attribute (tree *node, tree name, tree args, |
| int flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, bool *no_add_attrs) |
| { |
| if (TREE_CODE (*node) != FUNCTION_DECL) |
| { |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qE attribute only applies to functions", |
| name); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| /* The argument specifies a trap number to be used in a trapa instruction |
| at function exit (instead of an rte instruction). */ |
| else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_VALUE (args)) != INTEGER_CST) |
| { |
| /* The argument must be a constant integer. */ |
| warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qE attribute argument not an " |
| "integer constant", name); |
| *no_add_attrs = true; |
| } |
| |
| return NULL_TREE; |
| } |
| |
| static tree |
| sh_handle_renesas_attribute (tree *node ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| tree name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| tree args ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| bool *no_add_attrs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| return NULL_TREE; |
| } |
| |
| /* True if __attribute__((renesas)) or -mrenesas. */ |
| int |
| sh_attr_renesas_p (const_tree td) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_HITACHI) |
| return 1; |
| if (td == 0) |
| return 0; |
| if (DECL_P (td)) |
| td = TREE_TYPE (td); |
| if (td == error_mark_node) |
| return 0; |
| return (lookup_attribute ("renesas", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (td)) |
| != NULL_TREE); |
| } |
| |
| /* True if __attribute__((renesas)) or -mrenesas, for the current |
| function. */ |
| int |
| sh_cfun_attr_renesas_p (void) |
| { |
| return sh_attr_renesas_p (current_function_decl); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| sh_cfun_interrupt_handler_p (void) |
| { |
| return (lookup_attribute ("interrupt_handler", |
| DECL_ATTRIBUTES (current_function_decl)) |
| != NULL_TREE); |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns 1 if FUNC has been assigned the attribute |
| "function_vector". */ |
| int |
| sh2a_function_vector_p (tree func) |
| { |
| tree list; |
| if (TREE_CODE (func) != FUNCTION_DECL) |
| return 0; |
| |
| list = SH_ATTRIBUTES (func); |
| while (list) |
| { |
| if (is_attribute_p ("function_vector", TREE_PURPOSE (list))) |
| return 1; |
| |
| list = TREE_CHAIN (list); |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns TRUE if given tree has the "resbank" attribute. */ |
| |
| int |
| sh_cfun_resbank_handler_p (void) |
| { |
| return ((lookup_attribute ("resbank", |
| DECL_ATTRIBUTES (current_function_decl)) |
| != NULL_TREE) |
| && (lookup_attribute ("interrupt_handler", |
| DECL_ATTRIBUTES (current_function_decl)) |
| != NULL_TREE) && TARGET_SH2A); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS. */ |
| |
| static const char * |
| sh_check_pch_target_flags (int old_flags) |
| { |
| if ((old_flags ^ target_flags) & (MASK_SH1 | MASK_SH2 | MASK_SH3 |
| | MASK_SH_E | MASK_HARD_SH4 |
| | MASK_FPU_SINGLE | MASK_SH4)) |
| return _("created and used with different architectures / ABIs"); |
| if ((old_flags ^ target_flags) & MASK_HITACHI) |
| return _("created and used with different ABIs"); |
| if ((old_flags ^ target_flags) & MASK_LITTLE_ENDIAN) |
| return _("created and used with different endianness"); |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* Predicates used by the templates. */ |
| |
| /* Returns 1 if OP is MACL, MACH or PR. The input must be a REG rtx. |
| Used only in general_movsrc_operand. */ |
| |
| int |
| system_reg_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| switch (REGNO (op)) |
| { |
| case PR_REG: |
| case MACL_REG: |
| case MACH_REG: |
| return 1; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Nonzero if OP is a floating point value with value 0.0. */ |
| |
| int |
| fp_zero_operand (rtx op) |
| { |
| REAL_VALUE_TYPE r; |
| |
| if (GET_MODE (op) != SFmode) |
| return 0; |
| |
| REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, op); |
| return REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (r, dconst0) && ! REAL_VALUE_MINUS_ZERO (r); |
| } |
| |
| /* Nonzero if OP is a floating point value with value 1.0. */ |
| |
| int |
| fp_one_operand (rtx op) |
| { |
| REAL_VALUE_TYPE r; |
| |
| if (GET_MODE (op) != SFmode) |
| return 0; |
| |
| REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, op); |
| return REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (r, dconst1); |
| } |
| |
| /* In general mode switching is used. If we are |
| compiling without -mfmovd, movsf_ie isn't taken into account for |
| mode switching. We could check in machine_dependent_reorg for |
| cases where we know we are in single precision mode, but there is |
| interface to find that out during reload, so we must avoid |
| choosing an fldi alternative during reload and thus failing to |
| allocate a scratch register for the constant loading. */ |
| int |
| fldi_ok (void) |
| { |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| tertiary_reload_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op); |
| return code == MEM || (TARGET_SH4 && code == CONST_DOUBLE); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return the TLS type for TLS symbols, 0 for otherwise. */ |
| enum tls_model |
| tls_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF) |
| return TLS_MODEL_NONE; |
| return SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (op); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return the destination address of a branch. */ |
| |
| static int |
| branch_dest (rtx branch) |
| { |
| rtx dest = SET_SRC (PATTERN (branch)); |
| int dest_uid; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (dest) == IF_THEN_ELSE) |
| dest = XEXP (dest, 1); |
| dest = XEXP (dest, 0); |
| dest_uid = INSN_UID (dest); |
| return INSN_ADDRESSES (dest_uid); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return nonzero if REG is not used after INSN. |
| We assume REG is a reload reg, and therefore does |
| not live past labels. It may live past calls or jumps though. */ |
| int |
| reg_unused_after (rtx reg, rtx insn) |
| { |
| enum rtx_code code; |
| rtx set; |
| |
| /* If the reg is set by this instruction, then it is safe for our |
| case. Disregard the case where this is a store to memory, since |
| we are checking a register used in the store address. */ |
| set = single_set (insn); |
| if (set && !MEM_P (SET_DEST (set)) |
| && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reg, SET_DEST (set))) |
| return 1; |
| |
| while ((insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))) |
| { |
| rtx set; |
| if (!INSN_P (insn)) |
| continue; |
| |
| code = GET_CODE (insn); |
| |
| #if 0 |
| /* If this is a label that existed before reload, then the register |
| if dead here. However, if this is a label added by reorg, then |
| the register may still be live here. We can't tell the difference, |
| so we just ignore labels completely. */ |
| if (code == CODE_LABEL) |
| return 1; |
| /* else */ |
| #endif |
| |
| if (code == JUMP_INSN) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* If this is a sequence, we must handle them all at once. |
| We could have for instance a call that sets the target register, |
| and an insn in a delay slot that uses the register. In this case, |
| we must return 0. */ |
| else if (code == INSN && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE) |
| { |
| int i; |
| int retval = 0; |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0); i++) |
| { |
| rtx this_insn = XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i); |
| rtx set = single_set (this_insn); |
| |
| if (CALL_P (this_insn)) |
| code = CALL_INSN; |
| else if (JUMP_P (this_insn)) |
| { |
| if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (this_insn)) |
| return 0; |
| code = JUMP_INSN; |
| } |
| |
| if (set && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reg, SET_SRC (set))) |
| return 0; |
| if (set && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reg, SET_DEST (set))) |
| { |
| if (!MEM_P (SET_DEST (set))) |
| retval = 1; |
| else |
| return 0; |
| } |
| if (set == 0 |
| && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (this_insn))) |
| return 0; |
| } |
| if (retval == 1) |
| return 1; |
| else if (code == JUMP_INSN) |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| set = single_set (insn); |
| if (set && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reg, SET_SRC (set))) |
| return 0; |
| if (set && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reg, SET_DEST (set))) |
| return !MEM_P (SET_DEST (set)); |
| if (set == 0 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (insn))) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (code == CALL_INSN && call_really_used_regs[REGNO (reg)]) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| #include "ggc.h" |
| |
| static GTY(()) rtx fpscr_rtx; |
| rtx |
| get_fpscr_rtx (void) |
| { |
| if (! fpscr_rtx) |
| { |
| fpscr_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (PSImode, FPSCR_REG); |
| REG_USERVAR_P (fpscr_rtx) = 1; |
| mark_user_reg (fpscr_rtx); |
| } |
| if (! reload_completed || mdep_reorg_phase != SH_AFTER_MDEP_REORG) |
| mark_user_reg (fpscr_rtx); |
| return fpscr_rtx; |
| } |
| |
| static GTY(()) tree fpscr_values; |
| |
| static void |
| emit_fpu_switch (rtx scratch, int index) |
| { |
| rtx dst, src; |
| |
| if (fpscr_values == NULL) |
| { |
| tree t; |
| |
| t = build_index_type (integer_one_node); |
| t = build_array_type (integer_type_node, t); |
| t = build_decl (BUILTINS_LOCATION, |
| VAR_DECL, get_identifier ("__fpscr_values"), t); |
| DECL_ARTIFICIAL (t) = 1; |
| DECL_IGNORED_P (t) = 1; |
| DECL_EXTERNAL (t) = 1; |
| TREE_STATIC (t) = 1; |
| TREE_PUBLIC (t) = 1; |
| TREE_USED (t) = 1; |
| |
| fpscr_values = t; |
| } |
| |
| src = DECL_RTL (fpscr_values); |
| if (!can_create_pseudo_p ()) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (scratch, XEXP (src, 0)); |
| if (index != 0) |
| emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (scratch, scratch, GEN_INT (index * 4))); |
| src = adjust_automodify_address (src, PSImode, scratch, index * 4); |
| } |
| else |
| src = adjust_address (src, PSImode, index * 4); |
| |
| dst = get_fpscr_rtx (); |
| emit_move_insn (dst, src); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| emit_sf_insn (rtx pat) |
| { |
| emit_insn (pat); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| emit_df_insn (rtx pat) |
| { |
| emit_insn (pat); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| expand_sf_unop (rtx (*fun) (rtx, rtx, rtx), rtx *operands) |
| { |
| emit_sf_insn ((*fun) (operands[0], operands[1], get_fpscr_rtx ())); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| expand_sf_binop (rtx (*fun) (rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx), rtx *operands) |
| { |
| emit_sf_insn ((*fun) (operands[0], operands[1], operands[2], |
| get_fpscr_rtx ())); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| expand_df_unop (rtx (*fun) (rtx, rtx, rtx), rtx *operands) |
| { |
| emit_df_insn ((*fun) (operands[0], operands[1], get_fpscr_rtx ())); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| expand_df_binop (rtx (*fun) (rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx), rtx *operands) |
| { |
| emit_df_insn ((*fun) (operands[0], operands[1], operands[2], |
| get_fpscr_rtx ())); |
| } |
| |
| static rtx get_free_reg (HARD_REG_SET); |
| |
| /* This function returns a register to use to load the address to load |
| the fpscr from. Currently it always returns r1 or r7, but when we are |
| able to use pseudo registers after combine, or have a better mechanism |
| for choosing a register, it should be done here. */ |
| /* REGS_LIVE is the liveness information for the point for which we |
| need this allocation. In some bare-bones exit blocks, r1 is live at the |
| start. We can even have all of r0..r3 being live: |
| __complex__ long long f (double d) { if (d == 0) return 2; else return 3; } |
| INSN before which new insns are placed with will clobber the register |
| we return. If a basic block consists only of setting the return value |
| register to a pseudo and using that register, the return value is not |
| live before or after this block, yet we we'll insert our insns right in |
| the middle. */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| get_free_reg (HARD_REG_SET regs_live) |
| { |
| if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (regs_live, 1)) |
| return gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 1); |
| |
| /* Hard reg 1 is live; since this is a small register classes target, |
| there shouldn't be anything but a jump before the function end. */ |
| gcc_assert (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (regs_live, 7)); |
| return gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 7); |
| } |
| |
| /* This function will set the fpscr from memory. |
| MODE is the mode we are setting it to. */ |
| void |
| fpscr_set_from_mem (int mode, HARD_REG_SET regs_live) |
| { |
| enum attr_fp_mode fp_mode = (enum attr_fp_mode) mode; |
| enum attr_fp_mode norm_mode = ACTUAL_NORMAL_MODE (FP_MODE); |
| rtx addr_reg; |
| |
| addr_reg = !can_create_pseudo_p () ? get_free_reg (regs_live) : NULL_RTX; |
| emit_fpu_switch (addr_reg, fp_mode == norm_mode); |
| } |
| |
| /* Is the given character a logical line separator for the assembler? */ |
| #ifndef IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR |
| #define IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR(C, STR) ((C) == ';') |
| #endif |
| |
| int |
| sh_insn_length_adjustment (rtx insn) |
| { |
| /* Instructions with unfilled delay slots take up an extra two bytes for |
| the nop in the delay slot. */ |
| if (((NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != CLOBBER) |
| || CALL_P (insn) |
| || (JUMP_P (insn) && !JUMP_TABLE_DATA_P (insn))) |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)))) != SEQUENCE |
| && get_attr_needs_delay_slot (insn) == NEEDS_DELAY_SLOT_YES) |
| return 2; |
| |
| /* SH2e has a bug that prevents the use of annulled branches, so if |
| the delay slot is not filled, we'll have to put a NOP in it. */ |
| if (sh_cpu_attr == CPU_SH2E |
| && JUMP_P (insn) && !JUMP_TABLE_DATA_P (insn) |
| && get_attr_type (insn) == TYPE_CBRANCH |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)))) != SEQUENCE) |
| return 2; |
| |
| /* sh-dsp parallel processing insn take four bytes instead of two. */ |
| |
| if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)) |
| { |
| int sum = 0; |
| rtx body = PATTERN (insn); |
| const char *templ; |
| char c; |
| int maybe_label = 1; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (body) == ASM_INPUT) |
| templ = XSTR (body, 0); |
| else if (asm_noperands (body) >= 0) |
| templ |
| = decode_asm_operands (body, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL); |
| else |
| return 0; |
| do |
| { |
| int ppi_adjust = 0; |
| |
| do |
| c = *templ++; |
| while (c == ' ' || c == '\t'); |
| /* all sh-dsp parallel-processing insns start with p. |
| The only non-ppi sh insn starting with p is pref. |
| The only ppi starting with pr is prnd. */ |
| if ((c == 'p' || c == 'P') && strncasecmp ("re", templ, 2)) |
| ppi_adjust = 2; |
| /* The repeat pseudo-insn expands two three insns, a total of |
| six bytes in size. */ |
| else if ((c == 'r' || c == 'R') |
| && ! strncasecmp ("epeat", templ, 5)) |
| ppi_adjust = 4; |
| while (c && c != '\n' |
| && ! IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (c, templ)) |
| { |
| /* If this is a label, it is obviously not a ppi insn. */ |
| if (c == ':' && maybe_label) |
| { |
| ppi_adjust = 0; |
| break; |
| } |
| else if (c == '\'' || c == '"') |
| maybe_label = 0; |
| c = *templ++; |
| } |
| sum += ppi_adjust; |
| maybe_label = c != ':'; |
| } |
| while (c); |
| return sum; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return TRUE for a valid displacement for the REG+disp addressing |
| with MODE. */ |
| |
| /* ??? The SH2e does not have the REG+disp addressing mode when loading values |
| into the FRx registers. We implement this by setting the maximum offset |
| to zero when the value is SFmode. This also restricts loading of SFmode |
| values into the integer registers, but that can't be helped. */ |
| |
| /* The SH allows a displacement in a QI or HI amode, but only when the |
| other operand is R0. GCC doesn't handle this very well, so we forgot |
| all of that. |
| |
| A legitimate index for a QI or HI is 0, SI can be any number 0..63, |
| DI can be any number 0..60. */ |
| |
| bool |
| sh_legitimate_index_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx op) |
| { |
| if (CONST_INT_P (op)) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| int size; |
| |
| /* Check if this the address of an unaligned load / store. */ |
| if (mode == VOIDmode) |
| return CONST_OK_FOR_I06 (INTVAL (op)); |
| |
| size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode); |
| return (!(INTVAL (op) & (size - 1)) |
| && INTVAL (op) >= -512 * size |
| && INTVAL (op) < 512 * size); |
| } |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH2A) |
| { |
| if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1 |
| && (unsigned) INTVAL (op) < 4096) |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| if ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4 |
| && (unsigned) INTVAL (op) < 64 |
| && !(INTVAL (op) & 3) |
| && !(TARGET_SH2E && mode == SFmode)) |
| || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4 |
| && (unsigned) INTVAL (op) < 16383 |
| && !(INTVAL (op) & 3) && TARGET_SH2A)) |
| return true; |
| |
| if ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 8 |
| && (unsigned) INTVAL (op) < 60 |
| && !(INTVAL (op) & 3) |
| && !((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A) && mode == DFmode)) |
| || ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)==8) |
| && (unsigned) INTVAL (op) < 8192 |
| && !(INTVAL (op) & (TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE ? 7 : 3)) |
| && (TARGET_SH2A && mode == DFmode))) |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* Recognize an RTL expression that is a valid memory address for |
| an instruction. |
| The MODE argument is the machine mode for the MEM expression |
| that wants to use this address. |
| Allow REG |
| REG+disp |
| REG+r0 |
| REG++ |
| --REG */ |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, bool strict) |
| { |
| if (MAYBE_BASE_REGISTER_RTX_P (x, strict)) |
| return true; |
| else if ((GET_CODE (x) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (x) == PRE_DEC) |
| && ! TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && MAYBE_BASE_REGISTER_RTX_P (XEXP (x, 0), strict)) |
| return true; |
| else if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS |
| && (mode != PSImode || reload_completed)) |
| { |
| rtx xop0 = XEXP (x, 0); |
| rtx xop1 = XEXP (x, 1); |
| |
| if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= 8 |
| && MAYBE_BASE_REGISTER_RTX_P (xop0, strict) |
| && sh_legitimate_index_p (mode, xop1)) |
| return true; |
| |
| if ((ALLOW_INDEXED_ADDRESS || GET_MODE (x) == DImode |
| || ((xop0 == stack_pointer_rtx |
| || xop0 == hard_frame_pointer_rtx) |
| && REG_P (xop1) && REGNO (xop1) == R0_REG) |
| || ((xop1 == stack_pointer_rtx |
| || xop1 == hard_frame_pointer_rtx) |
| && REG_P (xop0) && REGNO (xop0) == R0_REG)) |
| && ((!TARGET_SHMEDIA && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= 4) |
| || (TARGET_SHMEDIA && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= 8) |
| || ((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE) |
| && TARGET_FMOVD && mode == DFmode))) |
| { |
| if (MAYBE_BASE_REGISTER_RTX_P (xop1, strict) |
| && MAYBE_INDEX_REGISTER_RTX_P (xop0, strict)) |
| return true; |
| if (MAYBE_INDEX_REGISTER_RTX_P (xop1, strict) |
| && MAYBE_BASE_REGISTER_RTX_P (xop0, strict)) |
| return true; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return TRUE if X references a SYMBOL_REF or LABEL_REF whose symbol |
| isn't protected by a PIC unspec. */ |
| int |
| nonpic_symbol_mentioned_p (rtx x) |
| { |
| register const char *fmt; |
| register int i; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF || GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF |
| || GET_CODE (x) == PC) |
| return 1; |
| |
| /* We don't want to look into the possible MEM location of a |
| CONST_DOUBLE, since we're not going to use it, in general. */ |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC |
| && (XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_PIC |
| || XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_GOT |
| || XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_GOTOFF |
| || XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_GOTPLT |
| || XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_GOTTPOFF |
| || XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_DTPOFF |
| || XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_TPOFF |
| || XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_PLT |
| || XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_SYMOFF |
| || XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_PCREL_SYMOFF)) |
| return 0; |
| |
| fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x)); |
| for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x)) - 1; i >= 0; i--) |
| { |
| if (fmt[i] == 'E') |
| { |
| register int j; |
| |
| for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--) |
| if (nonpic_symbol_mentioned_p (XVECEXP (x, i, j))) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| else if (fmt[i] == 'e' && nonpic_symbol_mentioned_p (XEXP (x, i))) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Convert a non-PIC address in `orig' to a PIC address using @GOT or |
| @GOTOFF in `reg'. */ |
| rtx |
| legitimize_pic_address (rtx orig, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| rtx reg) |
| { |
| if (tls_symbolic_operand (orig, Pmode) != TLS_MODEL_NONE) |
| return orig; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (orig) == LABEL_REF |
| || (GET_CODE (orig) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (orig))) |
| { |
| if (reg == 0) |
| reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| |
| emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg (reg, orig)); |
| return reg; |
| } |
| else if (GET_CODE (orig) == SYMBOL_REF) |
| { |
| if (reg == 0) |
| reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| |
| emit_insn (gen_symGOT2reg (reg, orig)); |
| return reg; |
| } |
| return orig; |
| } |
| |
| /* Try machine-dependent ways of modifying an illegitimate address |
| to be legitimate. If we find one, return the new, valid address. |
| Otherwise, return X. |
| |
| For the SH, if X is almost suitable for indexing, but the offset is |
| out of range, convert it into a normal form so that CSE has a chance |
| of reducing the number of address registers used. */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| sh_legitimize_address (rtx x, rtx oldx, enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| if (flag_pic) |
| x = legitimize_pic_address (oldx, mode, NULL_RTX); |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS |
| && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4 |
| || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 8) |
| && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1)) |
| && BASE_REGISTER_RTX_P (XEXP (x, 0)) |
| && ! TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && ! ((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE) && mode == DFmode) |
| && ! (TARGET_SH2E && mode == SFmode)) |
| { |
| rtx index_rtx = XEXP (x, 1); |
| HOST_WIDE_INT offset = INTVAL (index_rtx), offset_base; |
| rtx sum; |
| |
| /* On rare occasions, we might get an unaligned pointer |
| that is indexed in a way to give an aligned address. |
| Therefore, keep the lower two bits in offset_base. */ |
| /* Instead of offset_base 128..131 use 124..127, so that |
| simple add suffices. */ |
| if (offset > 127) |
| offset_base = ((offset + 4) & ~60) - 4; |
| else |
| offset_base = offset & ~60; |
| |
| /* Sometimes the normal form does not suit DImode. We |
| could avoid that by using smaller ranges, but that |
| would give less optimized code when SImode is |
| prevalent. */ |
| if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + offset - offset_base <= 64) |
| { |
| sum = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, XEXP (x, 0), |
| GEN_INT (offset_base), NULL_RTX, 0, |
| OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN); |
| |
| return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, sum, GEN_INT (offset - offset_base)); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return x; |
| } |
| |
| /* Attempt to replace *P, which is an address that needs reloading, with |
| a valid memory address for an operand of mode MODE. |
| Like for sh_legitimize_address, for the SH we try to get a normal form |
| of the address. That will allow inheritance of the address reloads. */ |
| |
| bool |
| sh_legitimize_reload_address (rtx *p, enum machine_mode mode, int opnum, |
| int itype) |
| { |
| enum reload_type type = (enum reload_type) itype; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (*p) == PLUS |
| && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 8) |
| && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (*p, 1)) |
| && MAYBE_BASE_REGISTER_RTX_P (XEXP (*p, 0), true) |
| && ! TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && ! (TARGET_SH4 && mode == DFmode) |
| && ! (mode == PSImode && type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS) |
| && (ALLOW_INDEXED_ADDRESS |
| || XEXP (*p, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx |
| || XEXP (*p, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)) |
| { |
| rtx index_rtx = XEXP (*p, 1); |
| HOST_WIDE_INT offset = INTVAL (index_rtx), offset_base; |
| rtx sum; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SH2A && mode == DFmode && (offset & 0x7)) |
| { |
| push_reload (*p, NULL_RTX, p, NULL, |
| BASE_REG_CLASS, Pmode, VOIDmode, 0, 0, opnum, type); |
| goto win; |
| } |
| if (TARGET_SH2E && mode == SFmode) |
| { |
| *p = copy_rtx (*p); |
| push_reload (*p, NULL_RTX, p, NULL, |
| BASE_REG_CLASS, Pmode, VOIDmode, 0, 0, opnum, type); |
| goto win; |
| } |
| /* Instead of offset_base 128..131 use 124..127, so that |
| simple add suffices. */ |
| if (offset > 127) |
| offset_base = ((offset + 4) & ~60) - 4; |
| else |
| offset_base = offset & ~60; |
| /* Sometimes the normal form does not suit DImode. We could avoid |
| that by using smaller ranges, but that would give less optimized |
| code when SImode is prevalent. */ |
| if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + offset - offset_base <= 64) |
| { |
| sum = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, XEXP (*p, 0), GEN_INT (offset_base)); |
| *p = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, sum, GEN_INT (offset - offset_base)); |
| push_reload (sum, NULL_RTX, &XEXP (*p, 0), NULL, |
| BASE_REG_CLASS, Pmode, VOIDmode, 0, 0, opnum, type); |
| goto win; |
| } |
| } |
| /* We must re-recognize what we created before. */ |
| else if (GET_CODE (*p) == PLUS |
| && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 8) |
| && GET_CODE (XEXP (*p, 0)) == PLUS |
| && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 1)) |
| && MAYBE_BASE_REGISTER_RTX_P (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 0), true) |
| && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (*p, 1)) |
| && ! TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && ! (TARGET_SH2E && mode == SFmode)) |
| { |
| /* Because this address is so complex, we know it must have |
| been created by LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS before; thus, |
| it is already unshared, and needs no further unsharing. */ |
| push_reload (XEXP (*p, 0), NULL_RTX, &XEXP (*p, 0), NULL, |
| BASE_REG_CLASS, Pmode, VOIDmode, 0, 0, opnum, type); |
| goto win; |
| } |
| |
| return false; |
| |
| win: |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* In the name of slightly smaller debug output, and to cater to |
| general assembler lossage, recognize various UNSPEC sequences |
| and turn them back into a direct symbol reference. */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| sh_delegitimize_address (rtx orig_x) |
| { |
| rtx x, y; |
| |
| orig_x = delegitimize_mem_from_attrs (orig_x); |
| |
| x = orig_x; |
| if (MEM_P (x)) |
| x = XEXP (x, 0); |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST) |
| { |
| y = XEXP (x, 0); |
| if (GET_CODE (y) == UNSPEC) |
| { |
| if (XINT (y, 1) == UNSPEC_GOT |
| || XINT (y, 1) == UNSPEC_GOTOFF |
| || XINT (y, 1) == UNSPEC_SYMOFF) |
| return XVECEXP (y, 0, 0); |
| else if (XINT (y, 1) == UNSPEC_PCREL_SYMOFF) |
| { |
| if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (y, 0, 0)) == CONST) |
| { |
| rtx symplt = XEXP (XVECEXP (y, 0, 0), 0); |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (symplt) == UNSPEC |
| && XINT (symplt, 1) == UNSPEC_PLT) |
| return XVECEXP (symplt, 0, 0); |
| } |
| } |
| else if (TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && (XINT (y, 1) == UNSPEC_EXTRACT_S16 |
| || XINT (y, 1) == UNSPEC_EXTRACT_U16)) |
| { |
| rtx offset = XVECEXP (y, 0, 1); |
| |
| x = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, XVECEXP (y, 0, 0), offset); |
| if (MEM_P (orig_x)) |
| x = replace_equiv_address_nv (orig_x, x); |
| return x; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return orig_x; |
| } |
| |
| /* Mark the use of a constant in the literal table. If the constant |
| has multiple labels, make it unique. */ |
| static rtx |
| mark_constant_pool_use (rtx x) |
| { |
| rtx insn, lab, pattern; |
| |
| if (x == NULL) |
| return x; |
| |
| switch (GET_CODE (x)) |
| { |
| case LABEL_REF: |
| x = XEXP (x, 0); |
| case CODE_LABEL: |
| break; |
| default: |
| return x; |
| } |
| |
| /* Get the first label in the list of labels for the same constant |
| and delete another labels in the list. */ |
| lab = x; |
| for (insn = PREV_INSN (x); insn; insn = PREV_INSN (insn)) |
| { |
| if (!LABEL_P (insn) |
| || LABEL_REFS (insn) != NEXT_INSN (insn)) |
| break; |
| lab = insn; |
| } |
| |
| for (insn = LABEL_REFS (lab); insn; insn = LABEL_REFS (insn)) |
| INSN_DELETED_P (insn) = 1; |
| |
| /* Mark constants in a window. */ |
| for (insn = NEXT_INSN (x); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) |
| { |
| if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)) |
| continue; |
| |
| pattern = PATTERN (insn); |
| if (GET_CODE (pattern) != UNSPEC_VOLATILE) |
| continue; |
| |
| switch (XINT (pattern, 1)) |
| { |
| case UNSPECV_CONST2: |
| case UNSPECV_CONST4: |
| case UNSPECV_CONST8: |
| XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 1) = const1_rtx; |
| break; |
| case UNSPECV_WINDOW_END: |
| if (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 0) == x) |
| return lab; |
| break; |
| case UNSPECV_CONST_END: |
| return lab; |
| default: |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return lab; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return true if it's possible to redirect BRANCH1 to the destination |
| of an unconditional jump BRANCH2. We only want to do this if the |
| resulting branch will have a short displacement. */ |
| int |
| sh_can_redirect_branch (rtx branch1, rtx branch2) |
| { |
| if (flag_expensive_optimizations && simplejump_p (branch2)) |
| { |
| rtx dest = XEXP (SET_SRC (single_set (branch2)), 0); |
| rtx insn; |
| int distance; |
| |
| for (distance = 0, insn = NEXT_INSN (branch1); |
| insn && distance < 256; |
| insn = PREV_INSN (insn)) |
| { |
| if (insn == dest) |
| return 1; |
| else |
| distance += get_attr_length (insn); |
| } |
| for (distance = 0, insn = NEXT_INSN (branch1); |
| insn && distance < 256; |
| insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) |
| { |
| if (insn == dest) |
| return 1; |
| else |
| distance += get_attr_length (insn); |
| } |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return nonzero if register old_reg can be renamed to register new_reg. */ |
| int |
| sh_hard_regno_rename_ok (unsigned int old_reg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| unsigned int new_reg) |
| { |
| /* Interrupt functions can only use registers that have already been |
| saved by the prologue, even if they would normally be |
| call-clobbered. */ |
| |
| if (sh_cfun_interrupt_handler_p () && !df_regs_ever_live_p (new_reg)) |
| return 0; |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Function to update the integer COST |
| based on the relationship between INSN that is dependent on |
| DEP_INSN through the dependence LINK. The default is to make no |
| adjustment to COST. This can be used for example to specify to |
| the scheduler that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur |
| the same cost as a data-dependence. The return value should be |
| the new value for COST. */ |
| static int |
| sh_adjust_cost (rtx insn, rtx link ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx dep_insn, int cost) |
| { |
| rtx reg, use_pat; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| /* On SHmedia, if the dependence is an anti-dependence or |
| output-dependence, there is no cost. */ |
| if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) != 0) |
| { |
| /* However, dependencies between target register loads and |
| uses of the register in a subsequent block that are separated |
| by a conditional branch are not modelled - we have to do with |
| the anti-dependency between the target register load and the |
| conditional branch that ends the current block. */ |
| if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == REG_DEP_ANTI |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (dep_insn)) == SET |
| && (get_attr_type (dep_insn) == TYPE_PT_MEDIA |
| || get_attr_type (dep_insn) == TYPE_PTABS_MEDIA) |
| && get_attr_type (insn) == TYPE_CBRANCH_MEDIA) |
| { |
| int orig_cost = cost; |
| rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_BR_PROB, 0); |
| rtx target = ((! note |
| || INTVAL (XEXP (note, 0)) * 2 < REG_BR_PROB_BASE) |
| ? insn : JUMP_LABEL (insn)); |
| /* On the likely path, the branch costs 1, on the unlikely path, |
| it costs 3. */ |
| cost--; |
| do |
| target = next_active_insn (target); |
| while (target && ! flow_dependent_p (target, dep_insn) |
| && --cost > 0); |
| /* If two branches are executed in immediate succession, with the |
| first branch properly predicted, this causes a stall at the |
| second branch, hence we won't need the target for the |
| second branch for two cycles after the launch of the first |
| branch. */ |
| if (cost > orig_cost - 2) |
| cost = orig_cost - 2; |
| } |
| else |
| cost = 0; |
| } |
| |
| else if (get_attr_is_mac_media (insn) |
| && get_attr_is_mac_media (dep_insn)) |
| cost = 1; |
| |
| else if (! reload_completed |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET |
| && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn))) == FLOAT |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (dep_insn)) == SET |
| && fp_arith_reg_operand (SET_SRC (PATTERN (dep_insn)), VOIDmode) |
| && cost < 4) |
| cost = 4; |
| /* Schedule the ptabs for a casesi_jump_media in preference to stuff |
| that is needed at the target. */ |
| else if (get_attr_type (insn) == TYPE_JUMP_MEDIA |
| && ! flow_dependent_p (insn, dep_insn)) |
| cost--; |
| } |
| else if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == 0) |
| { |
| enum attr_type type; |
| rtx dep_set; |
| |
| if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0 |
| || recog_memoized (dep_insn) < 0) |
| return cost; |
| |
| dep_set = single_set (dep_insn); |
| |
| /* The latency that we specify in the scheduling description refers |
| to the actual output, not to an auto-increment register; for that, |
| the latency is one. */ |
| if (dep_set && MEM_P (SET_SRC (dep_set)) && cost > 1) |
| { |
| rtx set = single_set (insn); |
| |
| if (set |
| && !reg_mentioned_p (SET_DEST (dep_set), SET_SRC (set)) |
| && (!MEM_P (SET_DEST (set)) |
| || !reg_mentioned_p (SET_DEST (dep_set), |
| XEXP (SET_DEST (set), 0)))) |
| cost = 1; |
| } |
| /* The only input for a call that is timing-critical is the |
| function's address. */ |
| if (CALL_P (insn)) |
| { |
| rtx call = PATTERN (insn); |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (call) == PARALLEL) |
| call = XVECEXP (call, 0 ,0); |
| if (GET_CODE (call) == SET) |
| call = SET_SRC (call); |
| if (GET_CODE (call) == CALL && MEM_P (XEXP (call, 0)) |
| /* sibcalli_thunk uses a symbol_ref in an unspec. */ |
| && (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (call, 0), 0)) == UNSPEC |
| || ! reg_set_p (XEXP (XEXP (call, 0), 0), dep_insn))) |
| cost -= TARGET_SH4_300 ? 3 : 6; |
| } |
| /* Likewise, the most timing critical input for an sfuncs call |
| is the function address. However, sfuncs typically start |
| using their arguments pretty quickly. |
| Assume a four cycle delay for SH4 before they are needed. |
| Cached ST40-300 calls are quicker, so assume only a one |
| cycle delay there. |
| ??? Maybe we should encode the delays till input registers |
| are needed by sfuncs into the sfunc call insn. */ |
| /* All sfunc calls are parallels with at least four components. |
| Exploit this to avoid unnecessary calls to sfunc_uses_reg. */ |
| else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL |
| && XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) >= 4 |
| && (reg = sfunc_uses_reg (insn))) |
| { |
| if (! reg_set_p (reg, dep_insn)) |
| cost -= TARGET_SH4_300 ? 1 : 4; |
| } |
| if (TARGET_HARD_SH4 && !TARGET_SH4_300) |
| { |
| enum attr_type dep_type = get_attr_type (dep_insn); |
| |
| if (dep_type == TYPE_FLOAD || dep_type == TYPE_PCFLOAD) |
| cost--; |
| else if ((dep_type == TYPE_LOAD_SI || dep_type == TYPE_PCLOAD_SI) |
| && (type = get_attr_type (insn)) != TYPE_CALL |
| && type != TYPE_SFUNC) |
| cost--; |
| /* When the preceding instruction loads the shift amount of |
| the following SHAD/SHLD, the latency of the load is increased |
| by 1 cycle. */ |
| if (get_attr_type (insn) == TYPE_DYN_SHIFT |
| && get_attr_any_int_load (dep_insn) == ANY_INT_LOAD_YES |
| && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (SET_DEST (dep_set), |
| XEXP (SET_SRC (single_set (insn)), |
| 1))) |
| cost++; |
| /* When an LS group instruction with a latency of less than |
| 3 cycles is followed by a double-precision floating-point |
| instruction, FIPR, or FTRV, the latency of the first |
| instruction is increased to 3 cycles. */ |
| else if (cost < 3 |
| && get_attr_insn_class (dep_insn) == INSN_CLASS_LS_GROUP |
| && get_attr_dfp_comp (insn) == DFP_COMP_YES) |
| cost = 3; |
| /* The lsw register of a double-precision computation is ready one |
| cycle earlier. */ |
| else if (reload_completed |
| && get_attr_dfp_comp (dep_insn) == DFP_COMP_YES |
| && (use_pat = single_set (insn)) |
| && ! regno_use_in (REGNO (SET_DEST (single_set (dep_insn))), |
| SET_SRC (use_pat))) |
| cost -= 1; |
| |
| if (get_attr_any_fp_comp (dep_insn) == ANY_FP_COMP_YES |
| && get_attr_late_fp_use (insn) == LATE_FP_USE_YES) |
| cost -= 1; |
| } |
| else if (TARGET_SH4_300) |
| { |
| /* Stores need their input register two cycles later. */ |
| if (dep_set && cost >= 1 |
| && ((type = get_attr_type (insn)) == TYPE_STORE |
| || type == TYPE_PSTORE |
| || type == TYPE_FSTORE || type == TYPE_MAC_MEM)) |
| { |
| rtx set = single_set (insn); |
| |
| if (!reg_mentioned_p (SET_SRC (set), XEXP (SET_DEST (set), 0)) |
| && rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (set), SET_DEST (dep_set))) |
| { |
| cost -= 2; |
| /* But don't reduce the cost below 1 if the address depends |
| on a side effect of dep_insn. */ |
| if (cost < 1 |
| && modified_in_p (XEXP (SET_DEST (set), 0), dep_insn)) |
| cost = 1; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| /* An anti-dependence penalty of two applies if the first insn is a double |
| precision fadd / fsub / fmul. */ |
| else if (!TARGET_SH4_300 |
| && REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == REG_DEP_ANTI |
| && recog_memoized (dep_insn) >= 0 |
| && (get_attr_type (dep_insn) == TYPE_DFP_ARITH |
| || get_attr_type (dep_insn) == TYPE_DFP_MUL) |
| /* A lot of alleged anti-flow dependences are fake, |
| so check this one is real. */ |
| && flow_dependent_p (dep_insn, insn)) |
| cost = 2; |
| |
| return cost; |
| } |
| |
| /* Check if INSN is flow-dependent on DEP_INSN. Can also be used to check |
| if DEP_INSN is anti-flow dependent on INSN. */ |
| static int |
| flow_dependent_p (rtx insn, rtx dep_insn) |
| { |
| rtx tmp = PATTERN (insn); |
| |
| note_stores (PATTERN (dep_insn), flow_dependent_p_1, &tmp); |
| return tmp == NULL_RTX; |
| } |
| |
| /* A helper function for flow_dependent_p called through note_stores. */ |
| static void |
| flow_dependent_p_1 (rtx x, const_rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data) |
| { |
| rtx * pinsn = (rtx *) data; |
| |
| if (*pinsn && reg_referenced_p (x, *pinsn)) |
| *pinsn = NULL_RTX; |
| } |
| |
| /* For use by sh_allocate_initial_value. Note that sh.md contains some |
| 'special function' patterns (type sfunc) that clobber pr, but that |
| do not look like function calls to leaf_function_p. Hence we must |
| do this extra check. */ |
| static int |
| sh_pr_n_sets (void) |
| { |
| return DF_REG_DEF_COUNT (TARGET_SHMEDIA ? PR_MEDIA_REG : PR_REG); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return where to allocate pseudo for a given hard register initial |
| value. */ |
| static rtx |
| sh_allocate_initial_value (rtx hard_reg) |
| { |
| rtx x; |
| |
| if (REGNO (hard_reg) == (TARGET_SHMEDIA ? PR_MEDIA_REG : PR_REG)) |
| { |
| if (current_function_is_leaf |
| && ! sh_pr_n_sets () |
| && ! (TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && ((crtl->args.info.call_cookie |
| & ~ CALL_COOKIE_RET_TRAMP (1)) |
| || crtl->saves_all_registers))) |
| x = hard_reg; |
| else |
| x = gen_frame_mem (Pmode, return_address_pointer_rtx); |
| } |
| else |
| x = NULL_RTX; |
| |
| return x; |
| } |
| |
| /* This function returns "2" to indicate dual issue for the SH4 |
| processor. To be used by the DFA pipeline description. */ |
| static int |
| sh_issue_rate (void) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SUPERSCALAR) |
| return 2; |
| else |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Functions for ready queue reordering for sched1. */ |
| |
| /* Get weight for mode for a set x. */ |
| static short |
| find_set_regmode_weight (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == CLOBBER && register_operand (SET_DEST (x), mode)) |
| return 1; |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == SET && register_operand (SET_DEST (x), mode)) |
| { |
| if (REG_P (SET_DEST (x))) |
| { |
| if (!reg_mentioned_p (SET_DEST (x), SET_SRC (x))) |
| return 1; |
| else |
| return 0; |
| } |
| return 1; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Get regmode weight for insn. */ |
| static short |
| find_insn_regmode_weight (rtx insn, enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| short reg_weight = 0; |
| rtx x; |
| |
| /* Increment weight for each register born here. */ |
| x = PATTERN (insn); |
| reg_weight += find_set_regmode_weight (x, mode); |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL) |
| { |
| int j; |
| for (j = XVECLEN (x, 0) - 1; j >= 0; j--) |
| { |
| x = XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, j); |
| reg_weight += find_set_regmode_weight (x, mode); |
| } |
| } |
| /* Decrement weight for each register that dies here. */ |
| for (x = REG_NOTES (insn); x; x = XEXP (x, 1)) |
| { |
| if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_DEAD || REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_UNUSED) |
| { |
| rtx note = XEXP (x, 0); |
| if (REG_P (note) && GET_MODE (note) == mode) |
| reg_weight--; |
| } |
| } |
| return reg_weight; |
| } |
| |
| /* Calculate regmode weights for all insns of a basic block. */ |
| static void |
| find_regmode_weight (basic_block b, enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| rtx insn, next_tail, head, tail; |
| |
| get_ebb_head_tail (b, b, &head, &tail); |
| next_tail = NEXT_INSN (tail); |
| |
| for (insn = head; insn != next_tail; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) |
| { |
| /* Handle register life information. */ |
| if (!INSN_P (insn)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (mode == SFmode) |
| INSN_REGMODE_WEIGHT (insn, mode) = |
| find_insn_regmode_weight (insn, mode) + 2 * find_insn_regmode_weight (insn, DFmode); |
| else if (mode == SImode) |
| INSN_REGMODE_WEIGHT (insn, mode) = |
| find_insn_regmode_weight (insn, mode) + 2 * find_insn_regmode_weight (insn, DImode); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Comparison function for ready queue sorting. */ |
| static int |
| rank_for_reorder (const void *x, const void *y) |
| { |
| rtx tmp = *(const rtx *) y; |
| rtx tmp2 = *(const rtx *) x; |
| |
| /* The insn in a schedule group should be issued the first. */ |
| if (SCHED_GROUP_P (tmp) != SCHED_GROUP_P (tmp2)) |
| return SCHED_GROUP_P (tmp2) ? 1 : -1; |
| |
| /* If insns are equally good, sort by INSN_LUID (original insn order), This |
| minimizes instruction movement, thus minimizing sched's effect on |
| register pressure. */ |
| return INSN_LUID (tmp) - INSN_LUID (tmp2); |
| } |
| |
| /* Resort the array A in which only element at index N may be out of order. */ |
| static void |
| swap_reorder (rtx *a, int n) |
| { |
| rtx insn = a[n - 1]; |
| int i = n - 2; |
| |
| while (i >= 0 && rank_for_reorder (a + i, &insn) >= 0) |
| { |
| a[i + 1] = a[i]; |
| i -= 1; |
| } |
| a[i + 1] = insn; |
| } |
| |
| #define SCHED_REORDER(READY, N_READY) \ |
| do \ |
| { \ |
| if ((N_READY) == 2) \ |
| swap_reorder (READY, N_READY); \ |
| else if ((N_READY) > 2) \ |
| qsort (READY, N_READY, sizeof (rtx), rank_for_reorder); \ |
| } \ |
| while (0) |
| |
| /* Sort the ready list READY by ascending priority, using the SCHED_REORDER |
| macro. */ |
| static void |
| ready_reorder (rtx *ready, int nready) |
| { |
| SCHED_REORDER (ready, nready); |
| } |
| |
| /* Count life regions of r0 for a block. */ |
| static int |
| find_r0_life_regions (basic_block b) |
| { |
| rtx end, insn; |
| rtx pset; |
| rtx r0_reg; |
| int live; |
| int set; |
| int death = 0; |
| |
| if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (b), R0_REG)) |
| { |
| set = 1; |
| live = 1; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| set = 0; |
| live = 0; |
| } |
| |
| insn = BB_HEAD (b); |
| end = BB_END (b); |
| r0_reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, R0_REG); |
| while (1) |
| { |
| if (INSN_P (insn)) |
| { |
| if (find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, R0_REG)) |
| { |
| death++; |
| live = 0; |
| } |
| if (!live |
| && (pset = single_set (insn)) |
| && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (r0_reg, SET_DEST (pset)) |
| && !find_regno_note (insn, REG_UNUSED, R0_REG)) |
| { |
| set++; |
| live = 1; |
| } |
| } |
| if (insn == end) |
| break; |
| insn = NEXT_INSN (insn); |
| } |
| return set - death; |
| } |
| |
| /* Calculate regmode weights for all insns of all basic block. */ |
| static void |
| sh_md_init_global (FILE *dump ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int verbose ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int old_max_uid) |
| { |
| basic_block b; |
| |
| regmode_weight[0] = (short *) xcalloc (old_max_uid, sizeof (short)); |
| regmode_weight[1] = (short *) xcalloc (old_max_uid, sizeof (short)); |
| r0_life_regions = 0; |
| |
| FOR_EACH_BB_REVERSE (b) |
| { |
| find_regmode_weight (b, SImode); |
| find_regmode_weight (b, SFmode); |
| if (!reload_completed) |
| r0_life_regions += find_r0_life_regions (b); |
| } |
| |
| CURR_REGMODE_PRESSURE (SImode) = 0; |
| CURR_REGMODE_PRESSURE (SFmode) = 0; |
| |
| } |
| |
| /* Cleanup. */ |
| static void |
| sh_md_finish_global (FILE *dump ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int verbose ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| if (regmode_weight[0]) |
| { |
| free (regmode_weight[0]); |
| regmode_weight[0] = NULL; |
| } |
| if (regmode_weight[1]) |
| { |
| free (regmode_weight[1]); |
| regmode_weight[1] = NULL; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* The scalar modes supported differs from the default version in TImode |
| for 32-bit SHMEDIA. */ |
| static bool |
| sh_scalar_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA32 && mode == TImode) |
| return false; |
| |
| return default_scalar_mode_supported_p (mode); |
| } |
| |
| /* Cache the can_issue_more so that we can return it from reorder2. Also, |
| keep count of register pressures on SImode and SFmode. */ |
| static int |
| sh_variable_issue (FILE *dump ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int sched_verbose ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| rtx insn, |
| int can_issue_more) |
| { |
| if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE |
| && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != CLOBBER) |
| cached_can_issue_more = can_issue_more - 1; |
| else |
| cached_can_issue_more = can_issue_more; |
| |
| if (reload_completed) |
| return cached_can_issue_more; |
| |
| CURR_REGMODE_PRESSURE (SImode) += INSN_REGMODE_WEIGHT (insn, SImode); |
| CURR_REGMODE_PRESSURE (SFmode) += INSN_REGMODE_WEIGHT (insn, SFmode); |
| |
| return cached_can_issue_more; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| sh_md_init (FILE *dump ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int verbose ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int veclen ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| CURR_REGMODE_PRESSURE (SImode) = 0; |
| CURR_REGMODE_PRESSURE (SFmode) = 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Some magic numbers. */ |
| /* Pressure on register r0 can lead to spill failures. so avoid sched1 for |
| functions that already have high pressure on r0. */ |
| #define R0_MAX_LIFE_REGIONS 2 |
| /* Register Pressure thresholds for SImode and SFmode registers. */ |
| #define SIMODE_MAX_WEIGHT 5 |
| #define SFMODE_MAX_WEIGHT 10 |
| |
| /* Return true if the pressure is high for MODE. */ |
| static short |
| high_pressure (enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| /* Pressure on register r0 can lead to spill failures. so avoid sched1 for |
| functions that already have high pressure on r0. */ |
| if (r0_life_regions >= R0_MAX_LIFE_REGIONS) |
| return 1; |
| |
| if (mode == SFmode) |
| return (CURR_REGMODE_PRESSURE (SFmode) > SFMODE_MAX_WEIGHT); |
| else |
| return (CURR_REGMODE_PRESSURE (SImode) > SIMODE_MAX_WEIGHT); |
| } |
| |
| /* Reorder ready queue if register pressure is high. */ |
| static int |
| sh_reorder (FILE *dump ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int sched_verbose ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| rtx *ready, |
| int *n_readyp, |
| int clock_var ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| if (reload_completed) |
| return sh_issue_rate (); |
| |
| if (high_pressure (SFmode) || high_pressure (SImode)) |
| { |
| ready_reorder (ready, *n_readyp); |
| } |
| |
| return sh_issue_rate (); |
| } |
| |
| /* Skip cycles if the current register pressure is high. */ |
| static int |
| sh_reorder2 (FILE *dump ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int sched_verbose ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| rtx *ready ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int *n_readyp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int clock_var ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| if (reload_completed) |
| return cached_can_issue_more; |
| |
| if (high_pressure(SFmode) || high_pressure (SImode)) |
| skip_cycles = 1; |
| |
| return cached_can_issue_more; |
| } |
| |
| /* Skip cycles without sorting the ready queue. This will move insn from |
| Q->R. If this is the last cycle we are skipping; allow sorting of ready |
| queue by sh_reorder. */ |
| |
| /* Generally, skipping these many cycles are sufficient for all insns to move |
| from Q -> R. */ |
| #define MAX_SKIPS 8 |
| |
| static int |
| sh_dfa_new_cycle (FILE *sched_dump ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int sched_verbose ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| rtx insn ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| int last_clock_var, |
| int clock_var, |
| int *sort_p) |
| { |
| if (reload_completed) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (skip_cycles) |
| { |
| if ((clock_var - last_clock_var) < MAX_SKIPS) |
| { |
| *sort_p = 0; |
| return 1; |
| } |
| /* If this is the last cycle we are skipping, allow reordering of R. */ |
| if ((clock_var - last_clock_var) == MAX_SKIPS) |
| { |
| *sort_p = 1; |
| return 1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| skip_cycles = 0; |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* SHmedia requires registers for branches, so we can't generate new |
| branches past reload. */ |
| static bool |
| sh_cannot_modify_jumps_p (void) |
| { |
| return (TARGET_SHMEDIA && (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)); |
| } |
| |
| static reg_class_t |
| sh_target_reg_class (void) |
| { |
| return TARGET_SHMEDIA ? TARGET_REGS : NO_REGS; |
| } |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_optimize_target_register_callee_saved (bool after_prologue_epilogue_gen) |
| { |
| HARD_REG_SET dummy; |
| #if 0 |
| rtx insn; |
| #endif |
| |
| if (! shmedia_space_reserved_for_target_registers) |
| return 0; |
| if (after_prologue_epilogue_gen && ! TARGET_SAVE_ALL_TARGET_REGS) |
| return 0; |
| if (calc_live_regs (&dummy) >= 6 * 8) |
| return 1; |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_ms_bitfield_layout_p (const_tree record_type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| return (TARGET_SH5 || TARGET_HITACHI || sh_attr_renesas_p (record_type)); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| On the SH1..SH4, the trampoline looks like |
| 2 0002 D202 mov.l l2,r2 |
| 1 0000 D301 mov.l l1,r3 |
| 3 0004 422B jmp @r2 |
| 4 0006 0009 nop |
| 5 0008 00000000 l1: .long area |
| 6 000c 00000000 l2: .long function |
| |
| SH5 (compact) uses r1 instead of r3 for the static chain. */ |
| |
| |
| /* Emit RTL insns to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline. |
| FNADDR is an RTX for the address of the function's pure code. |
| CXT is an RTX for the static chain value for the function. */ |
| |
| static void |
| sh_trampoline_init (rtx tramp_mem, tree fndecl, rtx cxt) |
| { |
| rtx fnaddr = XEXP (DECL_RTL (fndecl), 0); |
| rtx tramp = force_reg (Pmode, XEXP (tramp_mem, 0)); |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA64) |
| { |
| rtx tramp_templ; |
| int fixed_len; |
| |
| rtx movi1 = GEN_INT (0xcc000010); |
| rtx shori1 = GEN_INT (0xc8000010); |
| rtx src, dst; |
| |
| /* The following trampoline works within a +- 128 KB range for cxt: |
| ptb/u cxt,tr1; movi fnaddr >> 48,r0; shori fnaddr >> 32,r0; |
| shori fnaddr >> 16,r0; shori fnaddr,r0; ptabs/l r0,tr0 |
| gettr tr1,r1; blink tr0,r63 */ |
| /* Address rounding makes it hard to compute the exact bounds of the |
| offset for this trampoline, but we have a rather generous offset |
| range, so frame_offset should do fine as an upper bound. */ |
| if (cxt == virtual_stack_vars_rtx && frame_offset < 0x20000) |
| { |
| /* ??? could optimize this trampoline initialization |
| by writing DImode words with two insns each. */ |
| rtx mask = force_reg (DImode, GEN_INT (0x3fffc00)); |
| rtx insn = gen_rtx_MINUS (DImode, cxt, tramp); |
| insn = gen_rtx_ASHIFT (DImode, insn, GEN_INT (10-2)); |
| insn = gen_rtx_AND (DImode, insn, mask); |
| /* Or in ptb/u .,tr1 pattern */ |
| insn = gen_rtx_IOR (DImode, insn, gen_int_mode (0xec000010, SImode)); |
| insn = force_operand (insn, NULL_RTX); |
| insn = gen_lowpart (SImode, insn); |
| emit_move_insn (change_address (tramp_mem, SImode, NULL_RTX), insn); |
| insn = gen_rtx_LSHIFTRT (DImode, fnaddr, GEN_INT (38)); |
| insn = gen_rtx_AND (DImode, insn, mask); |
| insn = force_operand (gen_rtx_IOR (DImode, movi1, insn), NULL_RTX); |
| insn = gen_lowpart (SImode, insn); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, SImode, 4), insn); |
| insn = gen_rtx_LSHIFTRT (DImode, fnaddr, GEN_INT (22)); |
| insn = gen_rtx_AND (DImode, insn, mask); |
| insn = force_operand (gen_rtx_IOR (DImode, shori1, insn), NULL_RTX); |
| insn = gen_lowpart (SImode, insn); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, SImode, 8), insn); |
| insn = gen_rtx_LSHIFTRT (DImode, fnaddr, GEN_INT (6)); |
| insn = gen_rtx_AND (DImode, insn, mask); |
| insn = force_operand (gen_rtx_IOR (DImode, shori1, insn), NULL_RTX); |
| insn = gen_lowpart (SImode, insn); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, SImode, 12), insn); |
| insn = gen_rtx_ASHIFT (DImode, fnaddr, GEN_INT (10)); |
| insn = gen_rtx_AND (DImode, insn, mask); |
| insn = force_operand (gen_rtx_IOR (DImode, shori1, insn), NULL_RTX); |
| insn = gen_lowpart (SImode, insn); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, SImode, 16), insn); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, SImode, 20), |
| GEN_INT (0x6bf10600)); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, SImode, 24), |
| GEN_INT (0x4415fc10)); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, SImode, 28), |
| GEN_INT (0x4401fff0)); |
| emit_insn (gen_ic_invalidate_line (tramp)); |
| return; |
| } |
| tramp_templ = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,"__GCC_nested_trampoline"); |
| fixed_len = TRAMPOLINE_SIZE - 2 * GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode); |
| |
| tramp_templ = gen_datalabel_ref (tramp_templ); |
| dst = tramp_mem; |
| src = gen_const_mem (BLKmode, tramp_templ); |
| set_mem_align (dst, 256); |
| set_mem_align (src, 64); |
| emit_block_move (dst, src, GEN_INT (fixed_len), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL); |
| |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, Pmode, fixed_len), fnaddr); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, Pmode, |
| fixed_len + GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode)), |
| cxt); |
| emit_insn (gen_ic_invalidate_line (tramp)); |
| return; |
| } |
| else if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| /* movi fnaddr >> 16,r1; shori fnaddr,r1; ptabs/l r1,tr0 |
| movi cxt >> 16,r1; shori cxt,r1; blink tr0,r63 */ |
| rtx quad0 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode), cxtload = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); |
| rtx quad1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode), quad2 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); |
| /* movi 0,r1: 0xcc000010 shori 0,r1: c8000010 concatenated, |
| rotated 10 right, and higher 16 bit of every 32 selected. */ |
| rtx movishori |
| = force_reg (V2HImode, (simplify_gen_subreg |
| (V2HImode, GEN_INT (0x4330432), SImode, 0))); |
| rtx ptabs = force_reg (DImode, GEN_INT (0x6bf10600)); |
| rtx blink = force_reg (DImode, GEN_INT (0x4401fff0)); |
| |
| fnaddr = force_reg (SImode, fnaddr); |
| cxt = force_reg (SImode, cxt); |
| emit_insn (gen_mshflo_w_x (gen_rtx_SUBREG (V4HImode, quad0, 0), |
| gen_rtx_SUBREG (V2HImode, fnaddr, 0), |
| movishori)); |
| emit_insn (gen_rotrdi3_mextr (quad0, quad0, |
| GEN_INT (TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN ? 24 : 56))); |
| emit_insn (gen_ashldi3_media (quad0, quad0, const2_rtx)); |
| emit_move_insn (change_address (tramp_mem, DImode, NULL_RTX), quad0); |
| emit_insn (gen_mshflo_w_x (gen_rtx_SUBREG (V4HImode, cxtload, 0), |
| gen_rtx_SUBREG (V2HImode, cxt, 0), |
| movishori)); |
| emit_insn (gen_rotrdi3_mextr (cxtload, cxtload, |
| GEN_INT (TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN ? 24 : 56))); |
| emit_insn (gen_ashldi3_media (cxtload, cxtload, const2_rtx)); |
| if (TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_mshflo_l_di (quad1, ptabs, cxtload)); |
| emit_insn (gen_mextr4 (quad2, cxtload, blink)); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_mextr4 (quad1, cxtload, ptabs)); |
| emit_insn (gen_mshflo_l_di (quad2, blink, cxtload)); |
| } |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, DImode, 8), quad1); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, DImode, 16), quad2); |
| emit_insn (gen_ic_invalidate_line (tramp)); |
| return; |
| } |
| else if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_initialize_trampoline (tramp, cxt, fnaddr)); |
| return; |
| } |
| emit_move_insn (change_address (tramp_mem, SImode, NULL_RTX), |
| gen_int_mode (TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN ? 0xd301d202 : 0xd202d301, |
| SImode)); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, SImode, 4), |
| gen_int_mode (TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN ? 0x0009422b : 0x422b0009, |
| SImode)); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, SImode, 8), cxt); |
| emit_move_insn (adjust_address (tramp_mem, SImode, 12), fnaddr); |
| if (TARGET_HARVARD) |
| { |
| if (!TARGET_INLINE_IC_INVALIDATE |
| || (!(TARGET_SH4A_ARCH || TARGET_SH4_300) && TARGET_USERMODE)) |
| emit_library_call (function_symbol (NULL, "__ic_invalidate", |
| FUNCTION_ORDINARY), |
| LCT_NORMAL, VOIDmode, 1, tramp, SImode); |
| else |
| emit_insn (gen_ic_invalidate_line (tramp)); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* On SH5, trampolines are SHmedia code, so add 1 to the address. */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| sh_trampoline_adjust_address (rtx tramp) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| tramp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, tramp, const1_rtx, |
| gen_reg_rtx (Pmode), 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN); |
| return tramp; |
| } |
| |
| /* FIXME: This is overly conservative. A SHcompact function that |
| receives arguments ``by reference'' will have them stored in its |
| own stack frame, so it must not pass pointers or references to |
| these arguments to other functions by means of sibling calls. */ |
| /* If PIC, we cannot make sibling calls to global functions |
| because the PLT requires r12 to be live. */ |
| static bool |
| sh_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl, tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| return (1 |
| && (! TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| || crtl->args.info.stack_regs == 0) |
| && ! sh_cfun_interrupt_handler_p () |
| && (! flag_pic |
| || (decl && ! TREE_PUBLIC (decl)) |
| || (decl && DECL_VISIBILITY (decl) != VISIBILITY_DEFAULT))); |
| } |
| |
| /* Machine specific built-in functions. */ |
| |
| struct builtin_description |
| { |
| const enum insn_code icode; |
| const char *const name; |
| int signature; |
| tree fndecl; |
| }; |
| |
| /* describe number and signedness of arguments; arg[0] == result |
| (1: unsigned, 2: signed, 4: don't care, 8: pointer 0: no argument */ |
| /* 9: 64-bit pointer, 10: 32-bit pointer */ |
| static const char signature_args[][4] = |
| { |
| #define SH_BLTIN_V2SI2 0 |
| { 4, 4 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_V4HI2 1 |
| { 4, 4 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_V2SI3 2 |
| { 4, 4, 4 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_V4HI3 3 |
| { 4, 4, 4 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_V8QI3 4 |
| { 4, 4, 4 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_MAC_HISI 5 |
| { 1, 4, 4, 1 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_SH_HI 6 |
| { 4, 4, 1 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_SH_SI 7 |
| { 4, 4, 1 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_V4HI2V2SI 8 |
| { 4, 4, 4 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_V4HI2V8QI 9 |
| { 4, 4, 4 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_SISF 10 |
| { 4, 2 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_LDUA_L 11 |
| { 2, 10 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_LDUA_Q 12 |
| { 1, 10 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_STUA_L 13 |
| { 0, 10, 2 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_STUA_Q 14 |
| { 0, 10, 1 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_LDUA_L64 15 |
| { 2, 9 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_LDUA_Q64 16 |
| { 1, 9 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_STUA_L64 17 |
| { 0, 9, 2 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_STUA_Q64 18 |
| { 0, 9, 1 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_NUM_SHARED_SIGNATURES 19 |
| #define SH_BLTIN_2 19 |
| #define SH_BLTIN_SU 19 |
| { 1, 2 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_3 20 |
| #define SH_BLTIN_SUS 20 |
| { 2, 2, 1 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_PSSV 21 |
| { 0, 8, 2, 2 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_XXUU 22 |
| #define SH_BLTIN_UUUU 22 |
| { 1, 1, 1, 1 }, |
| #define SH_BLTIN_PV 23 |
| { 0, 8 }, |
| }; |
| /* mcmv: operands considered unsigned. */ |
| /* mmulsum_wq, msad_ubq: result considered unsigned long long. */ |
| /* mperm: control value considered unsigned int. */ |
| /* mshalds, mshard, mshards, mshlld, mshlrd: shift count is unsigned int. */ |
| /* mshards_q: returns signed short. */ |
| /* nsb: takes long long arg, returns unsigned char. */ |
| static struct builtin_description bdesc[] = |
| { |
| { CODE_FOR_absv2si2, "__builtin_absv2si2", SH_BLTIN_V2SI2, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_absv4hi2, "__builtin_absv4hi2", SH_BLTIN_V4HI2, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_addv2si3, "__builtin_addv2si3", SH_BLTIN_V2SI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_addv4hi3, "__builtin_addv4hi3", SH_BLTIN_V4HI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ssaddv2si3,"__builtin_ssaddv2si3", SH_BLTIN_V2SI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_usaddv8qi3,"__builtin_usaddv8qi3", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ssaddv4hi3,"__builtin_ssaddv4hi3", SH_BLTIN_V4HI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_alloco_i, "__builtin_sh_media_ALLOCO", SH_BLTIN_PV, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_negcmpeqv8qi,"__builtin_sh_media_MCMPEQ_B", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_negcmpeqv2si,"__builtin_sh_media_MCMPEQ_L", SH_BLTIN_V2SI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_negcmpeqv4hi,"__builtin_sh_media_MCMPEQ_W", SH_BLTIN_V4HI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_negcmpgtuv8qi,"__builtin_sh_media_MCMPGT_UB", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_negcmpgtv2si,"__builtin_sh_media_MCMPGT_L", SH_BLTIN_V2SI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_negcmpgtv4hi,"__builtin_sh_media_MCMPGT_W", SH_BLTIN_V4HI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mcmv, "__builtin_sh_media_MCMV", SH_BLTIN_UUUU, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mcnvs_lw, "__builtin_sh_media_MCNVS_LW", SH_BLTIN_3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mcnvs_wb, "__builtin_sh_media_MCNVS_WB", SH_BLTIN_V4HI2V8QI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mcnvs_wub, "__builtin_sh_media_MCNVS_WUB", SH_BLTIN_V4HI2V8QI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mextr1, "__builtin_sh_media_MEXTR1", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mextr2, "__builtin_sh_media_MEXTR2", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mextr3, "__builtin_sh_media_MEXTR3", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mextr4, "__builtin_sh_media_MEXTR4", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mextr5, "__builtin_sh_media_MEXTR5", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mextr6, "__builtin_sh_media_MEXTR6", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mextr7, "__builtin_sh_media_MEXTR7", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mmacfx_wl, "__builtin_sh_media_MMACFX_WL", SH_BLTIN_MAC_HISI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mmacnfx_wl,"__builtin_sh_media_MMACNFX_WL", SH_BLTIN_MAC_HISI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mulv2si3, "__builtin_mulv2si3", SH_BLTIN_V2SI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mulv4hi3, "__builtin_mulv4hi3", SH_BLTIN_V4HI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mmulfx_l, "__builtin_sh_media_MMULFX_L", SH_BLTIN_V2SI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mmulfx_w, "__builtin_sh_media_MMULFX_W", SH_BLTIN_V4HI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mmulfxrp_w,"__builtin_sh_media_MMULFXRP_W", SH_BLTIN_V4HI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mmulhi_wl, "__builtin_sh_media_MMULHI_WL", SH_BLTIN_V4HI2V2SI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mmullo_wl, "__builtin_sh_media_MMULLO_WL", SH_BLTIN_V4HI2V2SI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mmulsum_wq,"__builtin_sh_media_MMULSUM_WQ", SH_BLTIN_XXUU, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mperm_w, "__builtin_sh_media_MPERM_W", SH_BLTIN_SH_HI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_msad_ubq, "__builtin_sh_media_MSAD_UBQ", SH_BLTIN_XXUU, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mshalds_l, "__builtin_sh_media_MSHALDS_L", SH_BLTIN_SH_SI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mshalds_w, "__builtin_sh_media_MSHALDS_W", SH_BLTIN_SH_HI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ashrv2si3, "__builtin_ashrv2si3", SH_BLTIN_SH_SI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ashrv4hi3, "__builtin_ashrv4hi3", SH_BLTIN_SH_HI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mshards_q, "__builtin_sh_media_MSHARDS_Q", SH_BLTIN_SUS, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mshfhi_b, "__builtin_sh_media_MSHFHI_B", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mshfhi_l, "__builtin_sh_media_MSHFHI_L", SH_BLTIN_V2SI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mshfhi_w, "__builtin_sh_media_MSHFHI_W", SH_BLTIN_V4HI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mshflo_b, "__builtin_sh_media_MSHFLO_B", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mshflo_l, "__builtin_sh_media_MSHFLO_L", SH_BLTIN_V2SI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mshflo_w, "__builtin_sh_media_MSHFLO_W", SH_BLTIN_V4HI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ashlv2si3, "__builtin_ashlv2si3", SH_BLTIN_SH_SI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ashlv4hi3, "__builtin_ashlv4hi3", SH_BLTIN_SH_HI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_lshrv2si3, "__builtin_lshrv2si3", SH_BLTIN_SH_SI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_lshrv4hi3, "__builtin_lshrv4hi3", SH_BLTIN_SH_HI, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_subv2si3, "__builtin_subv2si3", SH_BLTIN_V2SI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_subv4hi3, "__builtin_subv4hi3", SH_BLTIN_V4HI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_sssubv2si3,"__builtin_sssubv2si3", SH_BLTIN_V2SI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ussubv8qi3,"__builtin_ussubv8qi3", SH_BLTIN_V8QI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_sssubv4hi3,"__builtin_sssubv4hi3", SH_BLTIN_V4HI3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_fcosa_s, "__builtin_sh_media_FCOSA_S", SH_BLTIN_SISF, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_fsina_s, "__builtin_sh_media_FSINA_S", SH_BLTIN_SISF, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_fipr, "__builtin_sh_media_FIPR_S", SH_BLTIN_3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ftrv, "__builtin_sh_media_FTRV_S", SH_BLTIN_3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_mac_media, "__builtin_sh_media_FMAC_S", SH_BLTIN_3, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_sqrtdf2, "__builtin_sh_media_FSQRT_D", SH_BLTIN_2, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_sqrtsf2, "__builtin_sh_media_FSQRT_S", SH_BLTIN_2, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_fsrra_s, "__builtin_sh_media_FSRRA_S", SH_BLTIN_2, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ldhi_l, "__builtin_sh_media_LDHI_L", SH_BLTIN_LDUA_L, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ldhi_q, "__builtin_sh_media_LDHI_Q", SH_BLTIN_LDUA_Q, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ldlo_l, "__builtin_sh_media_LDLO_L", SH_BLTIN_LDUA_L, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ldlo_q, "__builtin_sh_media_LDLO_Q", SH_BLTIN_LDUA_Q, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_sthi_l, "__builtin_sh_media_STHI_L", SH_BLTIN_STUA_L, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_sthi_q, "__builtin_sh_media_STHI_Q", SH_BLTIN_STUA_Q, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_stlo_l, "__builtin_sh_media_STLO_L", SH_BLTIN_STUA_L, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_stlo_q, "__builtin_sh_media_STLO_Q", SH_BLTIN_STUA_Q, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ldhi_l64, "__builtin_sh_media_LDHI_L", SH_BLTIN_LDUA_L64, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ldhi_q64, "__builtin_sh_media_LDHI_Q", SH_BLTIN_LDUA_Q64, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ldlo_l64, "__builtin_sh_media_LDLO_L", SH_BLTIN_LDUA_L64, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_ldlo_q64, "__builtin_sh_media_LDLO_Q", SH_BLTIN_LDUA_Q64, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_sthi_l64, "__builtin_sh_media_STHI_L", SH_BLTIN_STUA_L64, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_sthi_q64, "__builtin_sh_media_STHI_Q", SH_BLTIN_STUA_Q64, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_stlo_l64, "__builtin_sh_media_STLO_L", SH_BLTIN_STUA_L64, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_stlo_q64, "__builtin_sh_media_STLO_Q", SH_BLTIN_STUA_Q64, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_nsb, "__builtin_sh_media_NSB", SH_BLTIN_SU, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_byterev, "__builtin_sh_media_BYTEREV", SH_BLTIN_2, 0 }, |
| { CODE_FOR_prefetch, "__builtin_sh_media_PREFO", SH_BLTIN_PSSV, 0 }, |
| }; |
| |
| static void |
| sh_media_init_builtins (void) |
| { |
| tree shared[SH_BLTIN_NUM_SHARED_SIGNATURES]; |
| struct builtin_description *d; |
| |
| memset (shared, 0, sizeof shared); |
| for (d = bdesc; d - bdesc < (int) ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc); d++) |
| { |
| tree type, arg_type = 0; |
| int signature = d->signature; |
| int i; |
| |
| if (signature < SH_BLTIN_NUM_SHARED_SIGNATURES && shared[signature]) |
| type = shared[signature]; |
| else |
| { |
| int has_result = signature_args[signature][0] != 0; |
| tree args[3]; |
| |
| if ((signature_args[signature][1] & 8) |
| && (((signature_args[signature][1] & 1) && TARGET_SHMEDIA32) |
| || ((signature_args[signature][1] & 2) && TARGET_SHMEDIA64))) |
| continue; |
| if (! TARGET_FPU_ANY |
| && FLOAT_MODE_P (insn_data[d->icode].operand[0].mode)) |
| continue; |
| for (i = 0; i < (int) ARRAY_SIZE (args); i++) |
| args[i] = NULL_TREE; |
| for (i = 3; ; i--) |
| { |
| int arg = signature_args[signature][i]; |
| int opno = i - 1 + has_result; |
| |
| if (arg & 8) |
| arg_type = ptr_type_node; |
| else if (arg) |
| arg_type = (*lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode) |
| (insn_data[d->icode].operand[opno].mode, |
| (arg & 1)); |
| else if (i) |
| continue; |
| else |
| arg_type = void_type_node; |
| if (i == 0) |
| break; |
| args[i-1] = arg_type; |
| } |
| type = build_function_type_list (arg_type, args[0], args[1], |
| args[2], NULL_TREE); |
| if (signature < SH_BLTIN_NUM_SHARED_SIGNATURES) |
| shared[signature] = type; |
| } |
| d->fndecl = |
| add_builtin_function (d->name, type, d - bdesc, BUILT_IN_MD, |
| NULL, NULL_TREE); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns the shmedia builtin decl for CODE. */ |
| |
| static tree |
| sh_media_builtin_decl (unsigned code, bool initialize_p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| if (code >= ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc)) |
| return error_mark_node; |
| |
| return bdesc[code].fndecl; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implements target hook vector_mode_supported_p. */ |
| bool |
| sh_vector_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_FPU_ANY |
| && ((mode == V2SFmode) |
| || (mode == V4SFmode) |
| || (mode == V16SFmode))) |
| return true; |
| |
| else if (TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && ((mode == V8QImode) |
| || (mode == V2HImode) |
| || (mode == V4HImode) |
| || (mode == V2SImode))) |
| return true; |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| bool |
| sh_frame_pointer_required (void) |
| { |
| /* If needed override this in other tm.h files to cope with various OS |
| lossage requiring a frame pointer. */ |
| if (SUBTARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED) |
| return true; |
| |
| if (crtl->profile) |
| return true; |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implements target hook dwarf_calling_convention. Return an enum |
| of dwarf_calling_convention. */ |
| int |
| sh_dwarf_calling_convention (const_tree func) |
| { |
| if (sh_attr_renesas_p (func)) |
| return DW_CC_GNU_renesas_sh; |
| |
| return DW_CC_normal; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| sh_init_builtins (void) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| sh_media_init_builtins (); |
| } |
| |
| /* Returns the sh builtin decl for CODE. */ |
| |
| static tree |
| sh_builtin_decl (unsigned code, bool initialize_p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| return sh_media_builtin_decl (code, initialize_p); |
| |
| return error_mark_node; |
| } |
| |
| /* Expand an expression EXP that calls a built-in function, |
| with result going to TARGET if that's convenient |
| (and in mode MODE if that's convenient). |
| SUBTARGET may be used as the target for computing one of EXP's operands. |
| IGNORE is nonzero if the value is to be ignored. */ |
| |
| static rtx |
| sh_expand_builtin (tree exp, rtx target, rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int ignore) |
| { |
| tree fndecl = TREE_OPERAND (CALL_EXPR_FN (exp), 0); |
| unsigned int fcode = DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl); |
| const struct builtin_description *d = &bdesc[fcode]; |
| enum insn_code icode = d->icode; |
| int signature = d->signature; |
| enum machine_mode tmode = VOIDmode; |
| int nop = 0, i; |
| rtx op[4]; |
| rtx pat = 0; |
| |
| if (signature_args[signature][0]) |
| { |
| if (ignore) |
| return 0; |
| |
| tmode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode; |
| if (! target |
| || GET_MODE (target) != tmode |
| || ! (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, tmode)) |
| target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode); |
| op[nop++] = target; |
| } |
| else |
| target = 0; |
| |
| for (i = 1; i <= 3; i++, nop++) |
| { |
| tree arg; |
| enum machine_mode opmode, argmode; |
| tree optype; |
| |
| if (! signature_args[signature][i]) |
| break; |
| arg = CALL_EXPR_ARG (exp, i - 1); |
| if (arg == error_mark_node) |
| return const0_rtx; |
| if (signature_args[signature][i] & 8) |
| { |
| opmode = ptr_mode; |
| optype = ptr_type_node; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| opmode = insn_data[icode].operand[nop].mode; |
| optype = (*lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode) (opmode, 0); |
| } |
| argmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg)); |
| if (argmode != opmode) |
| arg = build1 (NOP_EXPR, optype, arg); |
| op[nop] = expand_expr (arg, NULL_RTX, opmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); |
| if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[nop].predicate) (op[nop], opmode)) |
| op[nop] = copy_to_mode_reg (opmode, op[nop]); |
| } |
| |
| switch (nop) |
| { |
| case 1: |
| pat = (*insn_data[d->icode].genfun) (op[0]); |
| break; |
| case 2: |
| pat = (*insn_data[d->icode].genfun) (op[0], op[1]); |
| break; |
| case 3: |
| pat = (*insn_data[d->icode].genfun) (op[0], op[1], op[2]); |
| break; |
| case 4: |
| pat = (*insn_data[d->icode].genfun) (op[0], op[1], op[2], op[3]); |
| break; |
| default: |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| if (! pat) |
| return 0; |
| emit_insn (pat); |
| return target; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| sh_expand_unop_v2sf (enum rtx_code code, rtx op0, rtx op1) |
| { |
| rtx sel0 = const0_rtx; |
| rtx sel1 = const1_rtx; |
| rtx (*fn) (rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx) = gen_unary_sf_op; |
| rtx op = gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, SFmode, op1); |
| |
| emit_insn ((*fn) (op0, op1, op, sel0, sel0)); |
| emit_insn ((*fn) (op0, op1, op, sel1, sel1)); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| sh_expand_binop_v2sf (enum rtx_code code, rtx op0, rtx op1, rtx op2) |
| { |
| rtx op = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, SFmode, op1, op2); |
| |
| emit_insn (gen_binary_sf_op0 (op0, op1, op2, op)); |
| emit_insn (gen_binary_sf_op1 (op0, op1, op2, op)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return true if hard register REGNO can hold a value of machine-mode MODE. |
| We can allow any mode in any general register. The special registers |
| only allow SImode. Don't allow any mode in the PR. |
| |
| We cannot hold DCmode values in the XD registers because alter_reg |
| handles subregs of them incorrectly. We could work around this by |
| spacing the XD registers like the DR registers, but this would require |
| additional memory in every compilation to hold larger register vectors. |
| We could hold SFmode / SCmode values in XD registers, but that |
| would require a tertiary reload when reloading from / to memory, |
| and a secondary reload to reload from / to general regs; that |
| seems to be a loosing proposition. |
| |
| We want to allow TImode FP regs so that when V4SFmode is loaded as TImode, |
| it won't be ferried through GP registers first. */ |
| |
| bool |
| sh_hard_regno_mode_ok (unsigned int regno, enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| if (SPECIAL_REGISTER_P (regno)) |
| return mode == SImode; |
| |
| if (regno == FPUL_REG) |
| return (mode == SImode || mode == SFmode); |
| |
| if (FP_REGISTER_P (regno) && mode == SFmode) |
| return true; |
| |
| if (mode == V2SFmode) |
| { |
| if (((FP_REGISTER_P (regno) && (regno - FIRST_FP_REG) % 2 == 0) |
| || GENERAL_REGISTER_P (regno))) |
| return true; |
| else |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| if (mode == V4SFmode) |
| { |
| if ((FP_REGISTER_P (regno) && (regno - FIRST_FP_REG) % 4 == 0) |
| || GENERAL_REGISTER_P (regno)) |
| return true; |
| else |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| if (mode == V16SFmode) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| if (FP_REGISTER_P (regno) && (regno - FIRST_FP_REG) % 16 == 0) |
| return true; |
| else |
| return false; |
| } |
| else |
| return regno == FIRST_XD_REG; |
| } |
| |
| if (FP_REGISTER_P (regno)) |
| { |
| if (mode == SFmode |
| || mode == SImode |
| || ((TARGET_SH2E || TARGET_SHMEDIA) && mode == SCmode) |
| || ((((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SH2A_DOUBLE) && mode == DFmode) |
| || mode == DCmode |
| || (TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && (mode == DFmode || mode == DImode |
| || mode == V2SFmode || mode == TImode))) |
| && ((regno - FIRST_FP_REG) & 1) == 0) |
| || ((TARGET_SH4 || TARGET_SHMEDIA) && mode == TImode |
| && ((regno - FIRST_FP_REG) & 3) == 0)) |
| return true; |
| else |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| if (XD_REGISTER_P (regno)) |
| return mode == DFmode; |
| |
| if (TARGET_REGISTER_P (regno)) |
| return (mode == DImode || mode == SImode || mode == PDImode); |
| |
| if (regno == PR_REG) |
| return mode == SImode; |
| |
| if (regno == FPSCR_REG) |
| return mode == PSImode; |
| |
| /* FIXME. This works around PR target/37633 for -O0. */ |
| if (!optimize && TARGET_SHMEDIA32 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > 4) |
| { |
| unsigned int n = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 8; |
| |
| if (regno >= FIRST_GENERAL_REG + 10 - n + 1 |
| && regno <= FIRST_GENERAL_REG + 14) |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return the class of registers for which a mode change from FROM to TO |
| is invalid. */ |
| bool |
| sh_cannot_change_mode_class (enum machine_mode from, enum machine_mode to, |
| enum reg_class rclass) |
| { |
| /* We want to enable the use of SUBREGs as a means to |
| VEC_SELECT a single element of a vector. */ |
| if (to == SFmode && VECTOR_MODE_P (from) && GET_MODE_INNER (from) == SFmode) |
| return (reg_classes_intersect_p (GENERAL_REGS, rclass)); |
| |
| if (GET_MODE_SIZE (from) != GET_MODE_SIZE (to)) |
| { |
| if (TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN) |
| { |
| if (GET_MODE_SIZE (to) < 8 || GET_MODE_SIZE (from) < 8) |
| return reg_classes_intersect_p (DF_REGS, rclass); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (GET_MODE_SIZE (from) < 8) |
| return reg_classes_intersect_p (DF_HI_REGS, rclass); |
| } |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Return true if registers in machine mode MODE will likely be |
| allocated to registers in small register classes. */ |
| |
| bool |
| sh_small_register_classes_for_mode_p (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| return (! TARGET_SHMEDIA); |
| } |
| |
| /* If ADDRESS refers to a CODE_LABEL, add NUSES to the number of times |
| that label is used. */ |
| |
| void |
| sh_mark_label (rtx address, int nuses) |
| { |
| if (GOTOFF_P (address)) |
| { |
| /* Extract the label or symbol. */ |
| address = XEXP (address, 0); |
| if (GET_CODE (address) == PLUS) |
| address = XEXP (address, 0); |
| address = XVECEXP (address, 0, 0); |
| } |
| if (GET_CODE (address) == LABEL_REF |
| && LABEL_P (XEXP (address, 0))) |
| LABEL_NUSES (XEXP (address, 0)) += nuses; |
| } |
| |
| /* Compute extra cost of moving data between one register class |
| and another. */ |
| |
| /* If SECONDARY*_RELOAD_CLASS says something about the src/dst pair, regclass |
| uses this information. Hence, the general register <-> floating point |
| register information here is not used for SFmode. */ |
| |
| static int |
| sh_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode mode, |
| reg_class_t srcclass, reg_class_t dstclass) |
| { |
| if (dstclass == T_REGS || dstclass == PR_REGS) |
| return 10; |
| |
| if (dstclass == MAC_REGS && srcclass == MAC_REGS) |
| return 4; |
| |
| if (mode == SImode && ! TARGET_SHMEDIA && TARGET_FMOVD |
| && REGCLASS_HAS_FP_REG (srcclass) |
| && REGCLASS_HAS_FP_REG (dstclass)) |
| return 4; |
| |
| if (REGCLASS_HAS_FP_REG (dstclass) && srcclass == T_REGS) |
| return ((TARGET_HARD_SH4 && !optimize_size) ? 10 : 7); |
| |
| if ((REGCLASS_HAS_FP_REG (dstclass) && srcclass == MAC_REGS) |
| || (dstclass == MAC_REGS && REGCLASS_HAS_FP_REG (srcclass))) |
| return 9; |
| |
| if ((REGCLASS_HAS_FP_REG (dstclass) |
| && REGCLASS_HAS_GENERAL_REG (srcclass)) |
| || (REGCLASS_HAS_GENERAL_REG (dstclass) |
| && REGCLASS_HAS_FP_REG (srcclass))) |
| return ((TARGET_SHMEDIA ? 4 : TARGET_FMOVD ? 8 : 12) |
| * ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + 7) / 8U)); |
| |
| if ((dstclass == FPUL_REGS |
| && REGCLASS_HAS_GENERAL_REG (srcclass)) |
| || (srcclass == FPUL_REGS |
| && REGCLASS_HAS_GENERAL_REG (dstclass))) |
| return 5; |
| |
| if ((dstclass == FPUL_REGS |
| && (srcclass == PR_REGS || srcclass == MAC_REGS || srcclass == T_REGS)) |
| || (srcclass == FPUL_REGS |
| && (dstclass == PR_REGS || dstclass == MAC_REGS))) |
| return 7; |
| |
| if ((srcclass == TARGET_REGS && ! REGCLASS_HAS_GENERAL_REG (dstclass)) |
| || ((dstclass) == TARGET_REGS && ! REGCLASS_HAS_GENERAL_REG (srcclass))) |
| return 20; |
| |
| /* ??? ptabs faults on (value & 0x3) == 0x3 */ |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && ((srcclass) == TARGET_REGS || (srcclass) == SIBCALL_REGS)) |
| { |
| if (sh_gettrcost >= 0) |
| return sh_gettrcost; |
| else if (!TARGET_PT_FIXED) |
| return 100; |
| } |
| |
| if ((srcclass == FPSCR_REGS && ! REGCLASS_HAS_GENERAL_REG (dstclass)) |
| || (dstclass == FPSCR_REGS && ! REGCLASS_HAS_GENERAL_REG (srcclass))) |
| return 4; |
| |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| || (TARGET_FMOVD |
| && ! REGCLASS_HAS_GENERAL_REG (srcclass) |
| && ! REGCLASS_HAS_GENERAL_REG (dstclass))) |
| return 2 * ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + 7) / 8U); |
| |
| return 2 * ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + 3) / 4U); |
| } |
| |
| static rtx emit_load_ptr (rtx, rtx); |
| |
| static rtx |
| emit_load_ptr (rtx reg, rtx addr) |
| { |
| rtx mem = gen_const_mem (ptr_mode, addr); |
| |
| if (Pmode != ptr_mode) |
| mem = gen_rtx_SIGN_EXTEND (Pmode, mem); |
| return emit_move_insn (reg, mem); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| sh_output_mi_thunk (FILE *file, tree thunk_fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| HOST_WIDE_INT delta, HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset, |
| tree function) |
| { |
| CUMULATIVE_ARGS cum; |
| int structure_value_byref = 0; |
| rtx this_rtx, this_value, sibcall, insns, funexp; |
| tree funtype = TREE_TYPE (function); |
| int simple_add = CONST_OK_FOR_ADD (delta); |
| int did_load = 0; |
| rtx scratch0, scratch1, scratch2; |
| unsigned i; |
| |
| reload_completed = 1; |
| epilogue_completed = 1; |
| current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs = 1; |
| |
| emit_note (NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END); |
| |
| /* Find the "this" pointer. We have such a wide range of ABIs for the |
| SH that it's best to do this completely machine independently. |
| "this" is passed as first argument, unless a structure return pointer |
| comes first, in which case "this" comes second. */ |
| INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, funtype, NULL_RTX, 0, 1); |
| #ifndef PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN |
| if (aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (function)), function)) |
| structure_value_byref = 1; |
| #endif /* not PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN */ |
| if (structure_value_byref && sh_struct_value_rtx (function, 0) == 0) |
| { |
| tree ptype = build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (funtype)); |
| |
| sh_function_arg_advance (pack_cumulative_args (&cum), Pmode, ptype, true); |
| } |
| this_rtx |
| = sh_function_arg (pack_cumulative_args (&cum), Pmode, ptr_type_node, true); |
| |
| /* For SHcompact, we only have r0 for a scratch register: r1 is the |
| static chain pointer (even if you can't have nested virtual functions |
| right now, someone might implement them sometime), and the rest of the |
| registers are used for argument passing, are callee-saved, or reserved. */ |
| /* We need to check call_used_regs / fixed_regs in case -fcall_saved-reg / |
| -ffixed-reg has been used. */ |
| if (! call_used_regs[0] || fixed_regs[0]) |
| error ("r0 needs to be available as a call-clobbered register"); |
| scratch0 = scratch1 = scratch2 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0); |
| if (! TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| if (call_used_regs[1] && ! fixed_regs[1]) |
| scratch1 = gen_rtx_REG (ptr_mode, 1); |
| /* N.B., if not TARGET_HITACHI, register 2 is used to pass the pointer |
| pointing where to return struct values. */ |
| if (call_used_regs[3] && ! fixed_regs[3]) |
| scratch2 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 3); |
| } |
| else if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| for (i = FIRST_GENERAL_REG; i <= LAST_GENERAL_REG; i++) |
| if (i != REGNO (scratch0) && |
| call_used_regs[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && ! FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (i)) |
| { |
| scratch1 = gen_rtx_REG (ptr_mode, i); |
| break; |
| } |
| if (scratch1 == scratch0) |
| error ("need a second call-clobbered general purpose register"); |
| for (i = FIRST_TARGET_REG; i <= LAST_TARGET_REG; i++) |
| if (call_used_regs[i] && ! fixed_regs[i]) |
| { |
| scratch2 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, i); |
| break; |
| } |
| if (scratch2 == scratch0) |
| error ("need a call-clobbered target register"); |
| } |
| |
| this_value = plus_constant (this_rtx, delta); |
| if (vcall_offset |
| && (simple_add || scratch0 != scratch1) |
| && strict_memory_address_p (ptr_mode, this_value)) |
| { |
| emit_load_ptr (scratch0, this_value); |
| did_load = 1; |
| } |
| |
| if (!delta) |
| ; /* Do nothing. */ |
| else if (simple_add) |
| emit_move_insn (this_rtx, this_value); |
| else |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (scratch1, GEN_INT (delta)); |
| emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (this_rtx, scratch1)); |
| } |
| |
| if (vcall_offset) |
| { |
| rtx offset_addr; |
| |
| if (!did_load) |
| emit_load_ptr (scratch0, this_rtx); |
| |
| offset_addr = plus_constant (scratch0, vcall_offset); |
| if (strict_memory_address_p (ptr_mode, offset_addr)) |
| ; /* Do nothing. */ |
| else if (! TARGET_SH5 && scratch0 != scratch1) |
| { |
| /* scratch0 != scratch1, and we have indexed loads. Get better |
| schedule by loading the offset into r1 and using an indexed |
| load - then the load of r1 can issue before the load from |
| (this_rtx + delta) finishes. */ |
| emit_move_insn (scratch1, GEN_INT (vcall_offset)); |
| offset_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, scratch0, scratch1); |
| } |
| else if (CONST_OK_FOR_ADD (vcall_offset)) |
| { |
| emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (scratch0, GEN_INT (vcall_offset))); |
| offset_addr = scratch0; |
| } |
| else if (scratch0 != scratch1) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (scratch1, GEN_INT (vcall_offset)); |
| emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (scratch0, scratch1)); |
| offset_addr = scratch0; |
| } |
| else |
| gcc_unreachable (); /* FIXME */ |
| emit_load_ptr (scratch0, offset_addr); |
| |
| if (Pmode != ptr_mode) |
| scratch0 = gen_rtx_TRUNCATE (ptr_mode, scratch0); |
| emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (this_rtx, scratch0)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Generate a tail call to the target function. */ |
| if (! TREE_USED (function)) |
| { |
| assemble_external (function); |
| TREE_USED (function) = 1; |
| } |
| funexp = XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0); |
| /* If the function is overridden, so is the thunk, hence we don't |
| need GOT addressing even if this is a public symbol. */ |
| #if 0 |
| if (TARGET_SH1 && ! flag_weak) |
| sibcall = gen_sibcalli_thunk (funexp, const0_rtx); |
| else |
| #endif |
| if (TARGET_SH2 && flag_pic) |
| { |
| sibcall = gen_sibcall_pcrel (funexp, const0_rtx); |
| XEXP (XVECEXP (sibcall, 0, 2), 0) = scratch2; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA && flag_pic) |
| { |
| funexp = gen_sym2PIC (funexp); |
| PUT_MODE (funexp, Pmode); |
| } |
| emit_move_insn (scratch2, funexp); |
| funexp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, scratch2); |
| sibcall = gen_sibcall (funexp, const0_rtx, NULL_RTX); |
| } |
| sibcall = emit_call_insn (sibcall); |
| SIBLING_CALL_P (sibcall) = 1; |
| use_reg (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (sibcall), this_rtx); |
| emit_barrier (); |
| |
| /* Run just enough of rest_of_compilation to do scheduling and get |
| the insns emitted. Note that use_thunk calls |
| assemble_start_function and assemble_end_function. */ |
| |
| insn_locators_alloc (); |
| insns = get_insns (); |
| |
| if (optimize > 0) |
| { |
| if (! cfun->cfg) |
| init_flow (cfun); |
| split_all_insns_noflow (); |
| } |
| |
| sh_reorg (); |
| |
| if (optimize > 0 && flag_delayed_branch) |
| dbr_schedule (insns); |
| |
| shorten_branches (insns); |
| final_start_function (insns, file, 1); |
| final (insns, file, 1); |
| final_end_function (); |
| |
| reload_completed = 0; |
| epilogue_completed = 0; |
| } |
| |
| rtx |
| function_symbol (rtx target, const char *name, enum sh_function_kind kind) |
| { |
| rtx sym; |
| |
| /* If this is not an ordinary function, the name usually comes from a |
| string literal or an sprintf buffer. Make sure we use the same |
| string consistently, so that cse will be able to unify address loads. */ |
| if (kind != FUNCTION_ORDINARY) |
| name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (get_identifier (name)); |
| sym = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, name); |
| SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym) = SYMBOL_FLAG_FUNCTION; |
| if (flag_pic) |
| switch (kind) |
| { |
| case FUNCTION_ORDINARY: |
| break; |
| case SFUNC_GOT: |
| { |
| rtx reg = target ? target : gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| |
| emit_insn (gen_symGOT2reg (reg, sym)); |
| sym = reg; |
| break; |
| } |
| case SFUNC_STATIC: |
| { |
| /* ??? To allow cse to work, we use GOTOFF relocations. |
| we could add combiner patterns to transform this into |
| straight pc-relative calls with sym2PIC / bsrf when |
| label load and function call are still 1:1 and in the |
| same basic block during combine. */ |
| rtx reg = target ? target : gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| |
| emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg (reg, sym)); |
| sym = reg; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| if (target && sym != target) |
| { |
| emit_move_insn (target, sym); |
| return target; |
| } |
| return sym; |
| } |
| |
| /* Find the number of a general purpose register in S. */ |
| static int |
| scavenge_reg (HARD_REG_SET *s) |
| { |
| int r; |
| for (r = FIRST_GENERAL_REG; r <= LAST_GENERAL_REG; r++) |
| if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*s, r)) |
| return r; |
| return -1; |
| } |
| |
| rtx |
| sh_get_pr_initial_val (void) |
| { |
| rtx val; |
| |
| /* ??? Unfortunately, get_hard_reg_initial_val doesn't always work for the |
| PR register on SHcompact, because it might be clobbered by the prologue. |
| We check first if that is known to be the case. */ |
| if (TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && ((crtl->args.info.call_cookie |
| & ~ CALL_COOKIE_RET_TRAMP (1)) |
| || crtl->saves_all_registers)) |
| return gen_frame_mem (SImode, return_address_pointer_rtx); |
| |
| /* If we haven't finished rtl generation, there might be a nonlocal label |
| that we haven't seen yet. |
| ??? get_hard_reg_initial_val fails if it is called after register |
| allocation has started, unless it has been called before for the |
| same register. And even then, we end in trouble if we didn't use |
| the register in the same basic block before. So call |
| get_hard_reg_initial_val now and wrap it in an unspec if we might |
| need to replace it. */ |
| /* ??? We also must do this for TARGET_SH1 in general, because otherwise |
| combine can put the pseudo returned by get_hard_reg_initial_val into |
| instructions that need a general purpose registers, which will fail to |
| be recognized when the pseudo becomes allocated to PR. */ |
| val |
| = get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, TARGET_SHMEDIA ? PR_MEDIA_REG : PR_REG); |
| if (TARGET_SH1) |
| return gen_rtx_UNSPEC (SImode, gen_rtvec (1, val), UNSPEC_RA); |
| return val; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| sh_expand_t_scc (rtx operands[]) |
| { |
| enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (operands[1]); |
| rtx target = operands[0]; |
| rtx op0 = operands[2]; |
| rtx op1 = operands[3]; |
| rtx result = target; |
| HOST_WIDE_INT val; |
| |
| if (!REG_P (op0) || REGNO (op0) != T_REG |
| || !CONST_INT_P (op1)) |
| return 0; |
| if (!REG_P (result)) |
| result = gen_reg_rtx (SImode); |
| val = INTVAL (op1); |
| if ((code == EQ && val == 1) || (code == NE && val == 0)) |
| emit_insn (gen_movt (result)); |
| else if (TARGET_SH2A && ((code == EQ && val == 0) |
| || (code == NE && val == 1))) |
| emit_insn (gen_xorsi3_movrt (result)); |
| else if ((code == EQ && val == 0) || (code == NE && val == 1)) |
| { |
| emit_clobber (result); |
| emit_insn (gen_subc (result, result, result)); |
| emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (result, result, const1_rtx)); |
| } |
| else if (code == EQ || code == NE) |
| emit_insn (gen_move_insn (result, GEN_INT (code == NE))); |
| else |
| return 0; |
| if (result != target) |
| emit_move_insn (target, result); |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* INSN is an sfunc; return the rtx that describes the address used. */ |
| static rtx |
| extract_sfunc_addr (rtx insn) |
| { |
| rtx pattern, part = NULL_RTX; |
| int len, i; |
| |
| pattern = PATTERN (insn); |
| len = XVECLEN (pattern, 0); |
| for (i = 0; i < len; i++) |
| { |
| part = XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i); |
| if (GET_CODE (part) == USE && GET_MODE (XEXP (part, 0)) == Pmode |
| && GENERAL_REGISTER_P (true_regnum (XEXP (part, 0)))) |
| return XEXP (part, 0); |
| } |
| gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 0)) == UNSPEC_VOLATILE); |
| return XVECEXP (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 0), 0, 1); |
| } |
| |
| /* Verify that the register in use_sfunc_addr still agrees with the address |
| used in the sfunc. This prevents fill_slots_from_thread from changing |
| use_sfunc_addr. |
| INSN is the use_sfunc_addr instruction, and REG is the register it |
| guards. */ |
| int |
| check_use_sfunc_addr (rtx insn, rtx reg) |
| { |
| /* Search for the sfunc. It should really come right after INSN. */ |
| while ((insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))) |
| { |
| if (LABEL_P (insn) || JUMP_P (insn)) |
| break; |
| if (! INSN_P (insn)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE) |
| insn = XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0); |
| if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != PARALLEL |
| || get_attr_type (insn) != TYPE_SFUNC) |
| continue; |
| return rtx_equal_p (extract_sfunc_addr (insn), reg); |
| } |
| gcc_unreachable (); |
| } |
| |
| /* This function returns a constant rtx that represents pi / 2**15 in |
| SFmode. it's used to scale SFmode angles, in radians, to a |
| fixed-point signed 16.16-bit fraction of a full circle, i.e., 2*pi |
| maps to 0x10000). */ |
| |
| static GTY(()) rtx sh_fsca_sf2int_rtx; |
| |
| rtx |
| sh_fsca_sf2int (void) |
| { |
| if (! sh_fsca_sf2int_rtx) |
| { |
| REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv; |
| |
| real_from_string (&rv, "10430.378350470453"); |
| sh_fsca_sf2int_rtx = const_double_from_real_value (rv, SFmode); |
| } |
| |
| return sh_fsca_sf2int_rtx; |
| } |
| |
| /* This function returns a constant rtx that represents pi / 2**15 in |
| DFmode. it's used to scale DFmode angles, in radians, to a |
| fixed-point signed 16.16-bit fraction of a full circle, i.e., 2*pi |
| maps to 0x10000). */ |
| |
| static GTY(()) rtx sh_fsca_df2int_rtx; |
| |
| rtx |
| sh_fsca_df2int (void) |
| { |
| if (! sh_fsca_df2int_rtx) |
| { |
| REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv; |
| |
| real_from_string (&rv, "10430.378350470453"); |
| sh_fsca_df2int_rtx = const_double_from_real_value (rv, DFmode); |
| } |
| |
| return sh_fsca_df2int_rtx; |
| } |
| |
| /* This function returns a constant rtx that represents 2**15 / pi in |
| SFmode. it's used to scale a fixed-point signed 16.16-bit fraction |
| of a full circle back to a SFmode value, i.e., 0x10000 maps to |
| 2*pi). */ |
| |
| static GTY(()) rtx sh_fsca_int2sf_rtx; |
| |
| rtx |
| sh_fsca_int2sf (void) |
| { |
| if (! sh_fsca_int2sf_rtx) |
| { |
| REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv; |
| |
| real_from_string (&rv, "9.587379924285257e-5"); |
| sh_fsca_int2sf_rtx = const_double_from_real_value (rv, SFmode); |
| } |
| |
| return sh_fsca_int2sf_rtx; |
| } |
| |
| /* Initialize the CUMULATIVE_ARGS structure. */ |
| |
| void |
| sh_init_cumulative_args (CUMULATIVE_ARGS * pcum, |
| tree fntype, |
| rtx libname ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, |
| tree fndecl, |
| signed int n_named_args, |
| enum machine_mode mode) |
| { |
| pcum->arg_count [(int) SH_ARG_FLOAT] = 0; |
| pcum->free_single_fp_reg = 0; |
| pcum->stack_regs = 0; |
| pcum->byref_regs = 0; |
| pcum->byref = 0; |
| pcum->outgoing = (n_named_args == -1) ? 0 : 1; |
| |
| /* XXX - Should we check TARGET_HITACHI here ??? */ |
| pcum->renesas_abi = sh_attr_renesas_p (fntype) ? 1 : 0; |
| |
| if (fntype) |
| { |
| pcum->force_mem = ((TARGET_HITACHI || pcum->renesas_abi) |
| && aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (fntype), fndecl)); |
| pcum->prototype_p = prototype_p (fntype); |
| pcum->arg_count [(int) SH_ARG_INT] |
| = TARGET_SH5 && aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (fntype), fndecl); |
| |
| pcum->call_cookie |
| = CALL_COOKIE_RET_TRAMP (TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && pcum->arg_count [(int) SH_ARG_INT] == 0 |
| && (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (fntype)) == BLKmode |
| ? int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (fntype)) |
| : GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (fntype)))) > 4 |
| && (BASE_RETURN_VALUE_REG (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (fntype))) |
| == FIRST_RET_REG)); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| pcum->arg_count [(int) SH_ARG_INT] = 0; |
| pcum->prototype_p = FALSE; |
| if (mode != VOIDmode) |
| { |
| pcum->call_cookie = |
| CALL_COOKIE_RET_TRAMP (TARGET_SHCOMPACT |
| && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > 4 |
| && BASE_RETURN_VALUE_REG (mode) == FIRST_RET_REG); |
| |
| /* If the default ABI is the Renesas ABI then all library |
| calls must assume that the library will be using the |
| Renesas ABI. So if the function would return its result |
| in memory then we must force the address of this memory |
| block onto the stack. Ideally we would like to call |
| targetm.calls.return_in_memory() here but we do not have |
| the TYPE or the FNDECL available so we synthesize the |
| contents of that function as best we can. */ |
| pcum->force_mem = |
| (TARGET_DEFAULT & MASK_HITACHI) |
| && (mode == BLKmode |
| || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > 4 |
| && !(mode == DFmode |
| && TARGET_FPU_DOUBLE))); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| pcum->call_cookie = 0; |
| pcum->force_mem = FALSE; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Replace any occurrence of FROM(n) in X with TO(n). The function does |
| not enter into CONST_DOUBLE for the replace. |
| |
| Note that copying is not done so X must not be shared unless all copies |
| are to be modified. |
| |
| This is like replace_rtx, except that we operate on N_REPLACEMENTS |
| replacements simultaneously - FROM(n) is replacements[n*2] and to(n) is |
| replacements[n*2+1] - and that we take mode changes into account. |
| |
| If a replacement is ambiguous, return NULL_RTX. |
| |
| If MODIFY is zero, don't modify any rtl in place, |
| just return zero or nonzero for failure / success. */ |
| |
| rtx |
| replace_n_hard_rtx (rtx x, rtx *replacements, int n_replacements, int modify) |
| { |
| int i, j; |
| const char *fmt; |
| |
| /* The following prevents loops occurrence when we change MEM in |
| CONST_DOUBLE onto the same CONST_DOUBLE. */ |
| if (x != 0 && GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE) |
| return x; |
| |
| for (i = n_replacements - 1; i >= 0 ; i--) |
| if (x == replacements[i*2] && GET_MODE (x) == GET_MODE (replacements[i*2+1])) |
| return replacements[i*2+1]; |
| |
| /* Allow this function to make replacements in EXPR_LISTs. */ |
| if (x == 0) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG) |
| { |
| rtx new_rtx = replace_n_hard_rtx (SUBREG_REG (x), replacements, |
| n_replacements, modify); |
| |
| if (CONST_INT_P (new_rtx)) |
| { |
| x = simplify_subreg (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx, |
| GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)), |
| SUBREG_BYTE (x)); |
| if (! x) |
| abort (); |
| } |
| else if (modify) |
| SUBREG_REG (x) = new_rtx; |
| |
| return x; |
| } |
| else if (REG_P (x)) |
| { |
| unsigned regno = REGNO (x); |
| unsigned nregs = (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER |
| ? HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (x)) : 1); |
| rtx result = NULL_RTX; |
| |
| for (i = n_replacements - 1; i >= 0; i--) |
| { |
| rtx from = replacements[i*2]; |
| rtx to = replacements[i*2+1]; |
| unsigned from_regno, from_nregs, to_regno, new_regno; |
| |
| if (!REG_P (from)) |
| continue; |
| from_regno = REGNO (from); |
| from_nregs = (from_regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER |
| ? HARD_REGNO_NREGS (from_regno, GET_MODE (from)) : 1); |
| if (regno < from_regno + from_nregs && regno + nregs > from_regno) |
| { |
| if (regno < from_regno |
| || regno + nregs > from_regno + nregs |
| || !REG_P (to) |
| || result) |
| return NULL_RTX; |
| to_regno = REGNO (to); |
| if (to_regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER) |
| { |
| new_regno = regno + to_regno - from_regno; |
| if ((unsigned) HARD_REGNO_NREGS (new_regno, GET_MODE (x)) |
| != nregs) |
| return NULL_RTX; |
| result = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (x), new_regno); |
| } |
| else if (GET_MODE (x) <= GET_MODE (to)) |
| result = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (x), to); |
| else |
| result = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x), to); |
| } |
| } |
| return result ? result : x; |
| } |
| else if (GET_CODE (x) == ZERO_EXTEND) |
| { |
| rtx new_rtx = replace_n_hard_rtx (XEXP (x, 0), replacements, |
| n_replacements, modify); |
| |
| if (CONST_INT_P (new_rtx)) |
| { |
| x = simplify_unary_operation (ZERO_EXTEND, GET_MODE (x), |
| new_rtx, GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))); |
| if (! x) |
| abort (); |
| } |
| else if (modify) |
| XEXP (x, 0) = new_rtx; |
| |
| return x; |
| } |
| |
| fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x)); |
| for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x)) - 1; i >= 0; i--) |
| { |
| rtx new_rtx; |
| |
| if (fmt[i] == 'e') |
| { |
| new_rtx = replace_n_hard_rtx (XEXP (x, i), replacements, |
| n_replacements, modify); |
| if (!new_rtx) |
| return NULL_RTX; |
| if (modify) |
| XEXP (x, i) = new_rtx; |
| } |
| else if (fmt[i] == 'E') |
| for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--) |
| { |
| new_rtx = replace_n_hard_rtx (XVECEXP (x, i, j), replacements, |
| n_replacements, modify); |
| if (!new_rtx) |
| return NULL_RTX; |
| if (modify) |
| XVECEXP (x, i, j) = new_rtx; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return x; |
| } |
| |
| rtx |
| sh_gen_truncate (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int need_sign_ext) |
| { |
| enum rtx_code code = TRUNCATE; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (x) == ZERO_EXTEND || GET_CODE (x) == SIGN_EXTEND) |
| { |
| rtx inner = XEXP (x, 0); |
| enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (inner); |
| |
| if (inner_mode == mode) |
| return inner; |
| else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)) |
| x = inner; |
| else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) |
| && (! need_sign_ext || GET_CODE (x) == SIGN_EXTEND)) |
| { |
| code = GET_CODE (x); |
| x = inner; |
| } |
| } |
| return gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, mode, x); |
| } |
| |
| /* called via for_each_rtx after reload, to clean up truncates of |
| registers that span multiple actual hard registers. */ |
| int |
| shmedia_cleanup_truncate (rtx *p, void *n_changes) |
| { |
| rtx x = *p, reg; |
| |
| if (GET_CODE (x) != TRUNCATE) |
| return 0; |
| reg = XEXP (x, 0); |
| if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (reg)) > 8 && REG_P (reg)) |
| { |
| enum machine_mode reg_mode = GET_MODE (reg); |
| XEXP (x, 0) = simplify_subreg (DImode, reg, reg_mode, |
| subreg_lowpart_offset (DImode, reg_mode)); |
| *(int*) n_changes += 1; |
| return -1; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* Load and store depend on the highpart of the address. However, |
| set_attr_alternative does not give well-defined results before reload, |
| so we must look at the rtl ourselves to see if any of the feeding |
| registers is used in a memref. */ |
| |
| /* Called by sh_contains_memref_p via for_each_rtx. */ |
| static int |
| sh_contains_memref_p_1 (rtx *loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) |
| { |
| return (MEM_P (*loc)); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return nonzero iff INSN contains a MEM. */ |
| int |
| sh_contains_memref_p (rtx insn) |
| { |
| return for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), &sh_contains_memref_p_1, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| /* Return nonzero iff INSN loads a banked register. */ |
| int |
| sh_loads_bankedreg_p (rtx insn) |
| { |
| if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET) |
| { |
| rtx op = SET_DEST (PATTERN(insn)); |
| if (REG_P (op) && BANKED_REGISTER_P (REGNO (op))) |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* FNADDR is the MEM expression from a call expander. Return an address |
| to use in an SHmedia insn pattern. */ |
| rtx |
| shmedia_prepare_call_address (rtx fnaddr, int is_sibcall) |
| { |
| int is_sym; |
| |
| fnaddr = XEXP (fnaddr, 0); |
| is_sym = GET_CODE (fnaddr) == SYMBOL_REF; |
| if (flag_pic && is_sym) |
| { |
| if (! SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (fnaddr)) |
| { |
| rtx reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); |
| |
| /* We must not use GOTPLT for sibcalls, because PIC_REG |
| must be restored before the PLT code gets to run. */ |
| if (is_sibcall) |
| emit_insn (gen_symGOT2reg (reg, fnaddr)); |
| else |
| emit_insn (gen_symGOTPLT2reg (reg, fnaddr)); |
| fnaddr = reg; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| fnaddr = gen_sym2PIC (fnaddr); |
| PUT_MODE (fnaddr, Pmode); |
| } |
| } |
| /* If ptabs might trap, make this visible to the rest of the compiler. |
| We generally assume that symbols pertain to valid locations, but |
| it is possible to generate invalid symbols with asm or linker tricks. |
| In a list of functions where each returns its successor, an invalid |
| symbol might denote an empty list. */ |
| if (!TARGET_PT_FIXED |
| && (!is_sym || TARGET_INVALID_SYMBOLS) |
| && (!REG_P (fnaddr) || ! TARGET_REGISTER_P (REGNO (fnaddr)))) |
| { |
| rtx tr = gen_reg_rtx (PDImode); |
| |
| emit_insn (gen_ptabs (tr, fnaddr)); |
| fnaddr = tr; |
| } |
| else if (! target_reg_operand (fnaddr, Pmode)) |
| fnaddr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, fnaddr); |
| return fnaddr; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS. */ |
| |
| static reg_class_t |
| sh_preferred_reload_class (rtx x, reg_class_t rclass) |
| { |
| if (rclass == NO_REGS |
| && TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && (CONST_DOUBLE_P (x) |
| || GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF |
| || PIC_ADDR_P (x))) |
| return GENERAL_REGS; |
| |
| return rclass; |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD. */ |
| |
| static reg_class_t |
| sh_secondary_reload (bool in_p, rtx x, reg_class_t rclass_i, |
| enum machine_mode mode, secondary_reload_info *sri) |
| { |
| enum reg_class rclass = (enum reg_class) rclass_i; |
| |
| if (in_p) |
| { |
| if (REGCLASS_HAS_FP_REG (rclass) |
| && ! TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && immediate_operand ((x), mode) |
| && ! ((fp_zero_operand (x) || fp_one_operand (x)) |
| && mode == SFmode && fldi_ok ())) |
| switch (mode) |
| { |
| case SFmode: |
| sri->icode = CODE_FOR_reload_insf__frn; |
| return NO_REGS; |
| case DFmode: |
| sri->icode = CODE_FOR_reload_indf__frn; |
| return NO_REGS; |
| case SImode: |
| /* ??? If we knew that we are in the appropriate mode - |
| single precision - we could use a reload pattern directly. */ |
| return FPUL_REGS; |
| default: |
| abort (); |
| } |
| if (rclass == FPUL_REGS |
| && ((REG_P (x) |
| && (REGNO (x) == MACL_REG || REGNO (x) == MACH_REG |
| || REGNO (x) == T_REG)) |
| || GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)) |
| return GENERAL_REGS; |
| if (rclass == FPUL_REGS && immediate_operand (x, mode)) |
| { |
| if (satisfies_constraint_I08 (x) || fp_zero_operand (x)) |
| return GENERAL_REGS; |
| else if (mode == SFmode) |
| return FP_REGS; |
| sri->icode = CODE_FOR_reload_insi__i_fpul; |
| return NO_REGS; |
| } |
| if (rclass == FPSCR_REGS |
| && ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER) |
| || (MEM_P (x) && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS))) |
| return GENERAL_REGS; |
| if (REGCLASS_HAS_FP_REG (rclass) |
| && TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && immediate_operand (x, mode) |
| && x != CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x)) |
| && GET_MODE (x) != V4SFmode) |
| return GENERAL_REGS; |
| if ((mode == QImode || mode == HImode) |
| && TARGET_SHMEDIA && inqhi_operand (x, mode)) |
| { |
| sri->icode = ((mode == QImode) |
| ? CODE_FOR_reload_inqi : CODE_FOR_reload_inhi); |
| return NO_REGS; |
| } |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA && rclass == GENERAL_REGS |
| && (GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF || PIC_ADDR_P (x))) |
| return TARGET_REGS; |
| } /* end of input-only processing. */ |
| |
| if (((REGCLASS_HAS_FP_REG (rclass) |
| && (REG_P (x) |
| && (GENERAL_OR_AP_REGISTER_P (REGNO (x)) |
| || (FP_REGISTER_P (REGNO (x)) && mode == SImode |
| && TARGET_FMOVD)))) |
| || (REGCLASS_HAS_GENERAL_REG (rclass) |
| && REG_P (x) |
| && FP_REGISTER_P (REGNO (x)))) |
| && ! TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| && (mode == SFmode || mode == SImode)) |
| return FPUL_REGS; |
| if ((rclass == FPUL_REGS |
| || (REGCLASS_HAS_FP_REG (rclass) |
| && ! TARGET_SHMEDIA && mode == SImode)) |
| && (MEM_P (x) |
| || (REG_P (x) |
| && (REGNO (x) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER |
| || REGNO (x) == T_REG |
| || system_reg_operand (x, VOIDmode))))) |
| { |
| if (rclass == FPUL_REGS) |
| return GENERAL_REGS; |
| return FPUL_REGS; |
| } |
| if ((rclass == TARGET_REGS |
| || (TARGET_SHMEDIA && rclass == SIBCALL_REGS)) |
| && !satisfies_constraint_Csy (x) |
| && (!REG_P (x) || ! GENERAL_REGISTER_P (REGNO (x)))) |
| return GENERAL_REGS; |
| if ((rclass == MAC_REGS || rclass == PR_REGS) |
| && REG_P (x) && ! GENERAL_REGISTER_P (REGNO (x)) |
| && rclass != REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (x))) |
| return GENERAL_REGS; |
| if (rclass != GENERAL_REGS && REG_P (x) |
| && TARGET_REGISTER_P (REGNO (x))) |
| return GENERAL_REGS; |
| return NO_REGS; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| sh_conditional_register_usage (void) |
| { |
| int regno; |
| for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno ++) |
| if (! VALID_REGISTER_P (regno)) |
| fixed_regs[regno] = call_used_regs[regno] = 1; |
| /* R8 and R9 are call-clobbered on SH5, but not on earlier SH ABIs. */ |
| if (TARGET_SH5) |
| { |
| call_used_regs[FIRST_GENERAL_REG + 8] |
| = call_used_regs[FIRST_GENERAL_REG + 9] = 1; |
| call_really_used_regs[FIRST_GENERAL_REG + 8] |
| = call_really_used_regs[FIRST_GENERAL_REG + 9] = 1; |
| } |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| regno_reg_class[FIRST_GENERAL_REG] = GENERAL_REGS; |
| CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_class_contents[FP0_REGS]); |
| regno_reg_class[FIRST_FP_REG] = FP_REGS; |
| } |
| if (flag_pic) |
| { |
| fixed_regs[PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM] = 1; |
| call_used_regs[PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM] = 1; |
| } |
| /* Renesas saves and restores mac registers on call. */ |
| if (TARGET_HITACHI && ! TARGET_NOMACSAVE) |
| { |
| call_really_used_regs[MACH_REG] = 0; |
| call_really_used_regs[MACL_REG] = 0; |
| } |
| for (regno = FIRST_FP_REG + (TARGET_LITTLE_ENDIAN != 0); |
| regno <= LAST_FP_REG; regno += 2) |
| SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[DF_HI_REGS], regno); |
| if (TARGET_SHMEDIA) |
| { |
| for (regno = FIRST_TARGET_REG; regno <= LAST_TARGET_REG; regno ++) |
| if (! fixed_regs[regno] && call_really_used_regs[regno]) |
| SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[SIBCALL_REGS], regno); |
| } |
| else |
| for (regno = FIRST_GENERAL_REG; regno <= LAST_GENERAL_REG; regno++) |
| if (! fixed_regs[regno] && call_really_used_regs[regno]) |
| SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[SIBCALL_REGS], regno); |
| } |
| |
| /* Implement TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P |
| |
| can_store_by_pieces constructs VOIDmode CONST_DOUBLEs. */ |
| |
| static bool |
| sh_legitimate_constant_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x) |
| { |
| return (TARGET_SHMEDIA |
| ? ((mode != DFmode && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT) |
| || x == CONST0_RTX (mode) |
| || !TARGET_SHMEDIA_FPU |
| || TARGET_SHMEDIA64) |
| : (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_DOUBLE |
| || mode == DFmode || mode == SFmode |
| || mode == DImode || GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)); |
| } |
| |
| enum sh_divide_strategy_e sh_div_strategy = SH_DIV_STRATEGY_DEFAULT; |
| |
| #include "gt-sh.h" |